gnu: hydrogen: Update to 0.9.6.1.
[jackhill/guix/guix.git] / doc / guix.texi
CommitLineData
568717fd
LC
1\input texinfo
2@c -*-texinfo-*-
3
4@c %**start of header
5@setfilename guix.info
6@documentencoding UTF-8
f8348b91 7@settitle GNU Guix Reference Manual
568717fd
LC
8@c %**end of header
9
10@include version.texi
7df7a74e
NK
11
12@copying
db5a9444 13Copyright @copyright{} 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016 Ludovic Courtès@*
f97c9175 14Copyright @copyright{} 2013, 2014, 2016 Andreas Enge@*
87eafdbd 15Copyright @copyright{} 2013 Nikita Karetnikov@*
8c01b9d0
ML
16Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Mathieu Lirzin@*
17Copyright @copyright{} 2014 Pierre-Antoine Rault@*
97d76250
LF
18Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Taylan Ulrich Bayırlı/Kammer@*
19Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Leo Famulari
7df7a74e
NK
20
21Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
22under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
23any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
24Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
25copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
26Documentation License''.
27@end copying
568717fd 28
eeaf4427 29@dircategory Package management
568717fd
LC
30@direntry
31* guix: (guix). Guix, the functional package manager.
e49951eb 32* guix package: (guix)Invoking guix package
eeaf4427 33 Managing packages with Guix.
e49951eb 34* guix build: (guix)Invoking guix build
568717fd 35 Building packages with Guix.
054e8576
LC
36* guix system: (guix)Invoking guix system
37 Managing the operating system configuration.
568717fd 38@end direntry
568717fd 39
372c4bbc
DT
40@dircategory Software development
41@direntry
42* guix environment: (guix)Invoking guix environment
43 Building development environments with Guix.
44@end direntry
45
568717fd 46@titlepage
7730d112
LC
47@title GNU Guix Reference Manual
48@subtitle Using the GNU Guix Functional Package Manager
2cbed07e 49@author The GNU Guix Developers
568717fd
LC
50
51@page
52@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
53Edition @value{EDITION} @*
54@value{UPDATED} @*
55
7df7a74e 56@insertcopying
568717fd
LC
57@end titlepage
58
568717fd
LC
59@contents
60
61@c *********************************************************************
62@node Top
f8348b91 63@top GNU Guix
568717fd 64
f8348b91
LC
65This document describes GNU Guix version @value{VERSION}, a functional
66package management tool written for the GNU system.
568717fd
LC
67
68@menu
69* Introduction:: What is Guix about?
bd5e766b 70* Installation:: Installing Guix.
eeaf4427 71* Package Management:: Package installation, upgrade, etc.
c554de89 72* Emacs Interface:: Using Guix from Emacs.
568717fd
LC
73* Programming Interface:: Using Guix in Scheme.
74* Utilities:: Package management commands.
a1ba8475 75* GNU Distribution:: Software for your friendly GNU system.
9bf3c1a7 76* Contributing:: Your help needed!
568717fd
LC
77
78* Acknowledgments:: Thanks!
79* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license of this manual.
80* Concept Index:: Concepts.
a85b83d2 81* Programming Index:: Data types, functions, and variables.
aaa3eaa9
LC
82
83@detailmenu
84 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
85
86Installation
87
1b2b8177 88* Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
aaa3eaa9 89* Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
ec0339cd 90* Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
aaa3eaa9
LC
91* Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
92* Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
0e2d0213 93* Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
aaa3eaa9
LC
94
95Setting Up the Daemon
96
97* Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
98* Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
99
100Package Management
101
102* Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
103* Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
aaa3eaa9
LC
104* Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
105* Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
106* Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
107* Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
108* Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
109
c554de89
AK
110Emacs Interface
111
112* Initial Setup: Emacs Initial Setup. Preparing @file{~/.emacs}.
113* Package Management: Emacs Package Management. Managing packages and generations.
687c9bc0 114* Licenses: Emacs Licenses. Interface for licenses of Guix packages.
9b0afb0d 115* Popup Interface: Emacs Popup Interface. Magit-like interface for guix commands.
c554de89 116* Prettify Mode: Emacs Prettify. Abbreviating @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}} file names.
34850cd5 117* Build Log Mode: Emacs Build Log. Highlighting Guix build logs.
187f80c6
AK
118* Completions: Emacs Completions. Completing @command{guix} shell command.
119* Development: Emacs Development. Tools for Guix developers.
32950fc8 120* Hydra: Emacs Hydra. Interface for Guix build farm.
c554de89 121
aaa3eaa9
LC
122Programming Interface
123
124* Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
125* Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
126* The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
127* Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
128* The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
129* G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
130
92492b23
LC
131Defining Packages
132
133* package Reference:: The package data type.
134* origin Reference:: The origin data type.
135
aaa3eaa9
LC
136Utilities
137
138* Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
fcc58db6 139* Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
aaa3eaa9
LC
140* Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
141* Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
142* Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
143* Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
144* Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
fcc58db6 145* Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
88856916 146* Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
aaa3eaa9 147* Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
aff8ce7c 148* Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
d23c20f1 149* Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
32efa254 150* Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
aaa3eaa9
LC
151
152GNU Distribution
153
154* System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
35ed9306 155* System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
aaa3eaa9
LC
156* Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
157* Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
158* Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
159* Packaging Guidelines:: Growing the distribution.
160* Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
161* Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
162
163System Configuration
164
165* Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
166* operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
167* File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
168* Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
169* User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
598e19dc 170* Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
aaa3eaa9
LC
171* Services:: Specifying system services.
172* Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
1b2b8177 173* X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
996ed739 174* Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
aaa3eaa9
LC
175* Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
176* GRUB Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
177* Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
97d76250 178* Running GuixSD in a VM:: How to run GuixSD in a virtual machine.
aaa3eaa9
LC
179* Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
180
181Services
182
183* Base Services:: Essential system services.
184* Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
185* X Window:: Graphical display.
1b2b8177
LC
186* Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
187* Database Services:: SQL databases.
d8c18af8 188* Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
cbd02397 189* Web Services:: Web servers.
aa4ed923 190* Various Services:: Other services.
aaa3eaa9 191
0adfe95a
LC
192Defining Services
193
194* Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
195* Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
196* Service Reference:: API reference.
dd17bc38 197* Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
0adfe95a 198
aaa3eaa9
LC
199Packaging Guidelines
200
ec0339cd
LC
201* Software Freedom:: What may go into the distribution.
202* Package Naming:: What's in a name?
203* Version Numbers:: When the name is not enough.
cbd02397 204* Synopses and Descriptions:: Helping users find the right package.
ec0339cd
LC
205* Python Modules:: Taming the snake.
206* Perl Modules:: Little pearls.
207* Fonts:: Fond of fonts.
aaa3eaa9 208
8c01b9d0
ML
209Contributing
210
211* Building from Git:: The latest and greatest.
212* Running Guix Before It Is Installed:: Hacker tricks.
213* The Perfect Setup:: The right tools.
214* Coding Style:: Hygiene of the contributor.
215* Submitting Patches:: Share your work.
216
217Coding Style
218
219* Programming Paradigm:: How to compose your elements.
220* Modules:: Where to store your code?
221* Data Types and Pattern Matching:: Implementing data structures.
222* Formatting Code:: Writing conventions.
223
aaa3eaa9 224@end detailmenu
568717fd
LC
225@end menu
226
227@c *********************************************************************
228@node Introduction
229@chapter Introduction
230
c80e7e55
LC
231GNU Guix@footnote{``Guix'' is pronounced like ``geeks'', or ``ɡiːks''
232using the international phonetic alphabet (IPA).} is a functional
233package management tool for the GNU system. Package management consists
4bfc4ea3
NK
234of all activities that relate to building packages from sources,
235honoring their build-time and run-time dependencies,
c80e7e55
LC
236installing packages in user environments, upgrading installed packages
237to new versions or rolling back to a previous set, removing unused
238software packages, etc.
568717fd
LC
239
240@cindex functional package management
241The term @dfn{functional} refers to a specific package management
136787cb
LC
242discipline pioneered by Nix (@pxref{Acknowledgments}).
243In Guix, the package build and installation process is seen
4bfc4ea3
NK
244as a function, in the mathematical sense. That function takes inputs,
245such as build scripts, a compiler, and libraries, and
246returns an installed package. As a pure function, its result depends
568717fd
LC
247solely on its inputs---for instance, it cannot refer to software or
248scripts that were not explicitly passed as inputs. A build function
4bfc4ea3 249always produces the same result when passed a given set of inputs. It
f97c9175 250cannot alter the environment of the running system in
568717fd
LC
251any way; for instance, it cannot create, modify, or delete files outside
252of its build and installation directories. This is achieved by running
e900c503 253build processes in isolated environments (or @dfn{containers}), where only their
4bfc4ea3 254explicit inputs are visible.
568717fd 255
e531ac2a 256@cindex store
568717fd 257The result of package build functions is @dfn{cached} in the file
e531ac2a 258system, in a special directory called @dfn{the store} (@pxref{The
f97c9175 259Store}). Each package is installed in a directory of its own in the
834129e0 260store---by default under @file{/gnu/store}. The directory name contains
568717fd
LC
261a hash of all the inputs used to build that package; thus, changing an
262input yields a different directory name.
263
f97c9175
AE
264This approach is the foundation for the salient features of Guix: support
265for transactional package upgrade and rollback, per-user installation, and
eeaf4427 266garbage collection of packages (@pxref{Features}).
568717fd 267
4bfc4ea3 268Guix has a command-line interface, which allows users to build, install,
568717fd 269upgrade, and remove packages, as well as a Scheme programming interface.
568717fd 270
3ca2731c 271@cindex Guix System Distribution
4705641f 272@cindex GuixSD
a1ba8475 273Last but not least, Guix is used to build a distribution of the GNU
3ca2731c 274system, with many GNU and non-GNU free software packages. The Guix
4705641f
LC
275System Distribution, or GNU@tie{}GuixSD, takes advantage of the core
276properties of Guix at the system level. With GuixSD, users
3ca2731c
LC
277@emph{declare} all aspects of the operating system configuration, and
278Guix takes care of instantiating that configuration in a reproducible,
279stateless fashion. @xref{GNU Distribution}.
a1ba8475 280
bd5e766b
LC
281@c *********************************************************************
282@node Installation
283@chapter Installation
284
48febeb8
LC
285GNU Guix is available for download from its website at
286@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/guix/}. This section describes the
287software requirements of Guix, as well as how to install it and get
288ready to use it.
bd5e766b 289
5af6de3e
LC
290Note that this section is concerned with the installation of the package
291manager, which can be done on top of a running GNU/Linux system. If,
292instead, you want to install the complete GNU operating system,
6621cdb6 293@pxref{System Installation}.
5af6de3e 294
bd5e766b 295@menu
09722b11 296* Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
bd5e766b 297* Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
ec0339cd 298* Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
bd5e766b
LC
299* Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
300* Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
0e2d0213 301* Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
bd5e766b
LC
302@end menu
303
09722b11
LC
304@node Binary Installation
305@section Binary Installation
306
307This section describes how to install Guix on an arbitrary system from a
308self-contained tarball providing binaries for Guix and for all its
309dependencies. This is often quicker than installing from source, which
310is described in the next sections. The only requirement is to have
311GNU@tie{}tar and Xz.
312
313Installing goes along these lines:
314
315@enumerate
316@item
317Download the binary tarball from
daa8922a
LC
318@indicateurl{ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz},
319where @var{system} is @code{x86_64-linux} for an @code{x86_64} machine
320already running the kernel Linux, and so on.
321
322Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
323authenticity of the tarball against it, along these lines:
324
325@example
326$ wget ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
327$ gpg --verify guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
328@end example
329
f97c9175 330If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
daa8922a
LC
331then run this command to import it:
332
333@example
334$ gpg --keyserver keys.gnupg.net --recv-keys 3D9AEBB5
335@end example
336
337@noindent
338and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
09722b11
LC
339
340@item
341As @code{root}, run:
342
343@example
5dc42964 344# cd /tmp
254b1c2e
LC
345# tar --warning=no-timestamp -xf \
346 guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz
5dc42964 347# mv var/guix /var/ && mv gnu /
09722b11
LC
348@end example
349
7acd3439
LC
350This creates @file{/gnu/store} (@pxref{The Store}) and @file{/var/guix}.
351The latter contains a ready-to-use profile for @code{root} (see next
352step.)
09722b11 353
5dc3ce5f
LC
354Do @emph{not} unpack the tarball on a working Guix system since that
355would overwrite its own essential files.
356
254b1c2e 357The @code{--warning=no-timestamp} option makes sure GNU@tie{}tar does
e9ba6357
LC
358not emit warnings about ``implausibly old time stamps'' (such
359warnings were triggered by GNU@tie{}tar 1.26 and older; recent
360versions are fine.)
361They stem from the fact that all the
254b1c2e
LC
362files in the archive have their modification time set to zero (which
363means January 1st, 1970.) This is done on purpose to make sure the
364archive content is independent of its creation time, thus making it
365reproducible.
366
7acd3439
LC
367@item
368Make @code{root}'s profile available under @file{~/.guix-profile}:
369
370@example
371# ln -sf /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile \
372 ~root/.guix-profile
373@end example
374
43c33047
LC
375@item
376Create the group and user accounts for build users as explained below
377(@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
378
09722b11 379@item
175ced41 380Run the daemon:
09722b11
LC
381
382@example
7acd3439 383# ~root/.guix-profile/bin/guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
09722b11
LC
384@end example
385
d2825c96
LC
386On hosts using the systemd init system, drop
387@file{~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service} in
388@file{/etc/systemd/system}.
389
ad227484
MDRS
390Likewise, on hosts using the Upstart init system, drop
391@file{~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf} in
392@file{/etc/init}.
393
09722b11
LC
394@item
395Make the @command{guix} command available to other users on the machine,
396for instance with:
397
398@example
399# mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
400# cd /usr/local/bin
d72d05f9 401# ln -s /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile/bin/guix
09722b11 402@end example
39f8ed14 403
aca738f3
LC
404It is also a good idea to make the Info version of this manual available
405there:
406
407@example
408# mkdir -p /usr/local/share/info
409# cd /usr/local/share/info
410# for i in /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/guix-profile/share/info/* ;
411 do ln -s $i ; done
412@end example
413
414That way, assuming @file{/usr/local/share/info} is in the search path,
415running @command{info guix} will open this manual (@pxref{Other Info
416Directories,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}, for more details on changing the
417Info search path.)
418
39f8ed14
LC
419@item
420To use substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org} (@pxref{Substitutes}),
421authorize them:
422
423@example
7acd3439 424# guix archive --authorize < ~root/.guix-profile/share/guix/hydra.gnu.org.pub
39f8ed14 425@end example
09722b11
LC
426@end enumerate
427
53de532f
LC
428And that's it! For additional tips and tricks, @pxref{Application
429Setup}.
09722b11 430
5dc3ce5f 431The @code{guix} package must remain available in @code{root}'s
09722b11
LC
432profile, or it would become subject to garbage collection---in which
433case you would find yourself badly handicapped by the lack of the
434@command{guix} command.
435
39f8ed14
LC
436The tarball in question can be (re)produced and verified simply by
437running the following command in the Guix source tree:
09722b11
LC
438
439@example
440make guix-binary.@var{system}.tar.xz
441@end example
442
443
bd5e766b
LC
444@node Requirements
445@section Requirements
446
09722b11
LC
447This section lists requirements when building Guix from source. The
448build procedure for Guix is the same as for other GNU software, and is
449not covered here. Please see the files @file{README} and @file{INSTALL}
450in the Guix source tree for additional details.
451
bd5e766b
LC
452GNU Guix depends on the following packages:
453
454@itemize
47c66da0 455@item @url{http://gnu.org/software/guile/, GNU Guile}, version 2.0.7 or later;
288dca55 456@item @url{http://gnupg.org/, GNU libgcrypt};
f0b98b84 457@item @url{http://www.gnu.org/software/make/, GNU Make}.
8a96bd4b
ID
458@end itemize
459
460The following dependencies are optional:
461
462@itemize
288dca55 463@item
8a96bd4b 464Installing
288dca55 465@url{http://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/guile-json/, Guile-JSON} will
2f7d2d91
LC
466allow you to use the @command{guix import pypi} command (@pxref{Invoking
467guix import}). It is of
288dca55 468interest primarily for developers and not for casual users.
8a96bd4b
ID
469@item
470Installing @uref{http://gnutls.org/, GnuTLS-Guile} will
471allow you to access @code{https} URLs with the @command{guix download}
d45dc6da
EB
472command (@pxref{Invoking guix download}), the @command{guix import pypi}
473command, and the @command{guix import cpan} command. This is primarily
474of interest to developers. @xref{Guile Preparations, how to install the
475GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile, GnuTLS-Guile}.
bd5e766b
LC
476@end itemize
477
478Unless @code{--disable-daemon} was passed to @command{configure}, the
479following packages are also needed:
480
481@itemize
368d08f7
LC
482@item @url{http://sqlite.org, SQLite 3};
483@item @url{http://www.bzip.org, libbz2};
484@item @url{http://gcc.gnu.org, GCC's g++}, with support for the
485C++11 standard.
bd5e766b
LC
486@end itemize
487
4bfc4ea3
NK
488When a working installation of @url{http://nixos.org/nix/, the Nix package
489manager} is available, you
bd5e766b 490can instead configure Guix with @code{--disable-daemon}. In that case,
4bfc4ea3 491Nix replaces the three dependencies above.
bd5e766b 492
b22a12fd
LC
493Guix is compatible with Nix, so it is possible to share the same store
494between both. To do so, you must pass @command{configure} not only the
495same @code{--with-store-dir} value, but also the same
4bfc4ea3
NK
496@code{--localstatedir} value. The latter is essential because it
497specifies where the database that stores metadata about the store is
834129e0 498located, among other things. The default values for Nix are
b22a12fd 499@code{--with-store-dir=/nix/store} and @code{--localstatedir=/nix/var}.
4bfc4ea3
NK
500Note that @code{--disable-daemon} is not required if
501your goal is to share the store with Nix.
b22a12fd 502
ec0339cd
LC
503@node Running the Test Suite
504@section Running the Test Suite
505
506After a successful @command{configure} and @code{make} run, it is a good
507idea to run the test suite. It can help catch issues with the setup or
508environment, or bugs in Guix itself---and really, reporting test
509failures is a good way to help improve the software. To run the test
510suite, type:
511
512@example
513make check
514@end example
515
516Test cases can run in parallel: you can use the @code{-j} option of
517GNU@tie{}make to speed things up. The first run may take a few minutes
518on a recent machine; subsequent runs will be faster because the store
519that is created for test purposes will already have various things in
520cache.
521
a887fd8d
LC
522It is also possible to run a subset of the tests by defining the
523@code{TESTS} makefile variable as in this example:
524
525@example
526make check TESTS="tests/store.scm tests/cpio.scm"
527@end example
528
ec0339cd
LC
529Upon failure, please email @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org} and attach the
530@file{test-suite.log} file. When @file{tests/@var{something}.scm}
531fails, please also attach the @file{@var{something}.log} file available
532in the top-level build directory. Please specify the Guix version being
533used as well as version numbers of the dependencies
534(@pxref{Requirements}) in your message.
535
bd5e766b
LC
536@node Setting Up the Daemon
537@section Setting Up the Daemon
538
539@cindex daemon
540Operations such as building a package or running the garbage collector
49e6291a 541are all performed by a specialized process, the @dfn{build daemon}, on
bd5e766b
LC
542behalf of clients. Only the daemon may access the store and its
543associated database. Thus, any operation that manipulates the store
544goes through the daemon. For instance, command-line tools such as
e49951eb 545@command{guix package} and @command{guix build} communicate with the
bd5e766b
LC
546daemon (@i{via} remote procedure calls) to instruct it what to do.
547
49e6291a 548The following sections explain how to prepare the build daemon's
f97c9175 549environment. See also @ref{Substitutes}, for information on how to allow
225dafde 550the daemon to download pre-built binaries.
49e6291a
LC
551
552@menu
553* Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
554* Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
555@end menu
556
557@node Build Environment Setup
558@subsection Build Environment Setup
559
bd5e766b
LC
560In a standard multi-user setup, Guix and its daemon---the
561@command{guix-daemon} program---are installed by the system
834129e0 562administrator; @file{/gnu/store} is owned by @code{root} and
bd5e766b
LC
563@command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}. Unprivileged users may use
564Guix tools to build packages or otherwise access the store, and the
565daemon will do it on their behalf, ensuring that the store is kept in a
566consistent state, and allowing built packages to be shared among users.
567
568@cindex build users
569When @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}, you may not want package
570build processes themselves to run as @code{root} too, for obvious
571security reasons. To avoid that, a special pool of @dfn{build users}
572should be created for use by build processes started by the daemon.
573These build users need not have a shell and a home directory: they will
574just be used when the daemon drops @code{root} privileges in build
575processes. Having several such users allows the daemon to launch
576distinct build processes under separate UIDs, which guarantees that they
577do not interfere with each other---an essential feature since builds are
578regarded as pure functions (@pxref{Introduction}).
579
580On a GNU/Linux system, a build user pool may be created like this (using
581Bash syntax and the @code{shadow} commands):
582
091196b3
LC
583@c See http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-guix/2013-01/msg00239.html
584@c for why `-G' is needed.
bd5e766b 585@example
cfc149dc
LC
586# groupadd --system guixbuild
587# for i in `seq -w 1 10`;
bd5e766b 588 do
cfc149dc
LC
589 useradd -g guixbuild -G guixbuild \
590 -d /var/empty -s `which nologin` \
591 -c "Guix build user $i" --system \
592 guixbuilder$i;
bd5e766b
LC
593 done
594@end example
595
596@noindent
54eb03ab
LC
597The number of build users determines how many build jobs may run in
598parallel, as specified by the @option{--max-jobs} option
d2825c96
LC
599(@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}). The
600@code{guix-daemon} program may then be run as @code{root} with the
601following command@footnote{If your machine uses the systemd init system,
602dropping the @file{@var{prefix}/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}
603file in @file{/etc/systemd/system} will ensure that
ad227484
MDRS
604@command{guix-daemon} is automatically started. Similarly, if your
605machine uses the Upstart init system, drop the
606@file{@var{prefix}/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf}
607file in @file{/etc/init}.}:
bd5e766b
LC
608
609@example
cfc149dc 610# guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
bd5e766b
LC
611@end example
612
e900c503 613@cindex chroot
b095792f
LC
614@noindent
615This way, the daemon starts build processes in a chroot, under one of
cfc149dc 616the @code{guixbuilder} users. On GNU/Linux, by default, the chroot
6dc99317
LC
617environment contains nothing but:
618
619@c Keep this list in sync with libstore/build.cc! -----------------------
620@itemize
621@item
4743a4da
LC
622a minimal @code{/dev} directory, created mostly independently from the
623host @code{/dev}@footnote{``Mostly'', because while the set of files
624that appear in the chroot's @code{/dev} is fixed, most of these files
625can only be created if the host has them.};
626
627@item
f97c9175 628the @code{/proc} directory; it only shows the processes of the container
4743a4da 629since a separate PID name space is used;
6dc99317
LC
630
631@item
632@file{/etc/passwd} with an entry for the current user and an entry for
633user @file{nobody};
634
635@item
636@file{/etc/group} with an entry for the user's group;
637
638@item
639@file{/etc/hosts} with an entry that maps @code{localhost} to
640@code{127.0.0.1};
641
642@item
643a writable @file{/tmp} directory.
644@end itemize
b095792f 645
cb960102
ED
646You can influence the directory where the daemon stores build trees
647@i{via} the @code{TMPDIR} environment variable. However, the build tree
f97c9175 648within the chroot is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0},
cb960102
ED
649where @var{name} is the derivation name---e.g., @code{coreutils-8.24}.
650This way, the value of @code{TMPDIR} does not leak inside build
651environments, which avoids discrepancies in cases where build processes
652capture the name of their build tree.
653
e0c941fe
LC
654@vindex http_proxy
655The daemon also honors the @code{http_proxy} environment variable for
656HTTP downloads it performs, be it for fixed-output derivations
657(@pxref{Derivations}) or for substitutes (@pxref{Substitutes}).
658
1e2644bb
LC
659If you are installing Guix as an unprivileged user, it is still possible
660to run @command{guix-daemon} provided you pass @code{--disable-chroot}.
661However, build processes will not be isolated from one another, and not
662from the rest of the system. Thus, build processes may interfere with
663each other, and may access programs, libraries, and other files
664available on the system---making it much harder to view them as
665@emph{pure} functions.
bd5e766b 666
49e6291a
LC
667
668@node Daemon Offload Setup
669@subsection Using the Offload Facility
670
671@cindex offloading
4ec2e92d
LC
672@cindex build hook
673When desired, the build daemon can @dfn{offload}
674derivation builds to other machines
49e6291a
LC
675running Guix, using the @code{offload} @dfn{build hook}. When that
676feature is enabled, a list of user-specified build machines is read from
f97c9175 677@file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}; every time a build is requested, for
49e6291a 678instance via @code{guix build}, the daemon attempts to offload it to one
f97c9175 679of the machines that satisfy the constraints of the derivation, in
49e6291a
LC
680particular its system type---e.g., @file{x86_64-linux}. Missing
681prerequisites for the build are copied over SSH to the target machine,
682which then proceeds with the build; upon success the output(s) of the
683build are copied back to the initial machine.
684
4ec2e92d 685The @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} file typically looks like this:
49e6291a
LC
686
687@example
688(list (build-machine
689 (name "eightysix.example.org")
690 (system "x86_64-linux")
691 (user "bob")
692 (speed 2.)) ; incredibly fast!
693
694 (build-machine
695 (name "meeps.example.org")
696 (system "mips64el-linux")
697 (user "alice")
698 (private-key
699 (string-append (getenv "HOME")
c4fdfd6f 700 "/.lsh/identity-for-guix"))))
49e6291a
LC
701@end example
702
703@noindent
704In the example above we specify a list of two build machines, one for
705the @code{x86_64} architecture and one for the @code{mips64el}
4ec2e92d
LC
706architecture.
707
708In fact, this file is---not surprisingly!---a Scheme file that is
709evaluated when the @code{offload} hook is started. Its return value
710must be a list of @code{build-machine} objects. While this example
711shows a fixed list of build machines, one could imagine, say, using
712DNS-SD to return a list of potential build machines discovered in the
713local network (@pxref{Introduction, Guile-Avahi,, guile-avahi, Using
c678a4ee
LC
714Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}). The @code{build-machine} data type is
715detailed below.
4ec2e92d 716
c678a4ee 717@deftp {Data Type} build-machine
f97c9175
AE
718This data type represents build machines to which the daemon may offload
719builds. The important fields are:
49e6291a
LC
720
721@table @code
722
723@item name
f97c9175 724The host name of the remote machine.
49e6291a
LC
725
726@item system
f97c9175 727The system type of the remote machine---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
49e6291a
LC
728
729@item user
730The user account to use when connecting to the remote machine over SSH.
731Note that the SSH key pair must @emph{not} be passphrase-protected, to
732allow non-interactive logins.
733
734@end table
735
4ec2e92d 736A number of optional fields may be specified:
49e6291a
LC
737
738@table @code
739
cecd72d5 740@item port
f97c9175 741Port number of SSH server on the machine (default: 22).
cecd72d5 742
49e6291a
LC
743@item private-key
744The SSH private key file to use when connecting to the machine.
745
c4fdfd6f
LC
746Currently offloading uses GNU@tie{}lsh as its SSH client
747(@pxref{Invoking lsh,,, GNU lsh Manual}). Thus, the key file here must
748be an lsh key file. This may change in the future, though.
749
49e6291a
LC
750@item parallel-builds
751The number of builds that may run in parallel on the machine (1 by
752default.)
753
754@item speed
755A ``relative speed factor''. The offload scheduler will tend to prefer
756machines with a higher speed factor.
757
758@item features
759A list of strings denoting specific features supported by the machine.
760An example is @code{"kvm"} for machines that have the KVM Linux modules
761and corresponding hardware support. Derivations can request features by
762name, and they will be scheduled on matching build machines.
763
764@end table
c678a4ee 765@end deftp
49e6291a
LC
766
767The @code{guix} command must be in the search path on the build
768machines, since offloading works by invoking the @code{guix archive} and
c4fdfd6f
LC
769@code{guix build} commands. In addition, the Guix modules must be in
770@code{$GUILE_LOAD_PATH} on the build machine---you can check whether
771this is the case by running:
772
773@example
74273b6f 774lsh build-machine guile -c "'(use-modules (guix config))'"
c4fdfd6f 775@end example
49e6291a 776
f97c9175 777There is one last thing to do once @file{machines.scm} is in place. As
49e6291a 778explained above, when offloading, files are transferred back and forth
c4fdfd6f
LC
779between the machine stores. For this to work, you first need to
780generate a key pair on each machine to allow the daemon to export signed
781archives of files from the store (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
49e6291a
LC
782
783@example
784# guix archive --generate-key
785@end example
786
787@noindent
c4fdfd6f
LC
788Each build machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that
789it accepts store items it receives from the master:
790
791@example
792# guix archive --authorize < master-public-key.txt
793@end example
794
795@noindent
796Likewise, the master machine must authorize the key of each build machine.
797
798All the fuss with keys is here to express pairwise mutual trust
799relations between the master and the build machines. Concretely, when
800the master receives files from a build machine (and @i{vice versa}), its
801build daemon can make sure they are genuine, have not been tampered
802with, and that they are signed by an authorized key.
49e6291a
LC
803
804
bd5e766b
LC
805@node Invoking guix-daemon
806@section Invoking @command{guix-daemon}
807
808The @command{guix-daemon} program implements all the functionality to
809access the store. This includes launching build processes, running the
810garbage collector, querying the availability of a build result, etc. It
811is normally run as @code{root} like this:
812
813@example
cfc149dc 814# guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
bd5e766b
LC
815@end example
816
817@noindent
081145cf 818For details on how to set it up, @pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}.
bd5e766b 819
e900c503
LC
820@cindex chroot
821@cindex container, build environment
822@cindex build environment
823@cindex reproducible builds
bd5e766b
LC
824By default, @command{guix-daemon} launches build processes under
825different UIDs, taken from the build group specified with
826@code{--build-users-group}. In addition, each build process is run in a
827chroot environment that only contains the subset of the store that the
828build process depends on, as specified by its derivation
829(@pxref{Programming Interface, derivation}), plus a set of specific
830system directories. By default, the latter contains @file{/dev} and
e900c503
LC
831@file{/dev/pts}. Furthermore, on GNU/Linux, the build environment is a
832@dfn{container}: in addition to having its own file system tree, it has
833a separate mount name space, its own PID name space, network name space,
834etc. This helps achieve reproducible builds (@pxref{Features}).
bd5e766b 835
cbc538fe
LC
836When the daemon performs a build on behalf of the user, it creates a
837build directory under @file{/tmp} or under the directory specified by
838its @code{TMPDIR} environment variable; this directory is shared with
839the container for the duration of the build. Be aware that using a
840directory other than @file{/tmp} can affect build results---for example,
841with a longer directory name, a build process that uses Unix-domain
842sockets might hit the name length limitation for @code{sun_path}, which
843it would otherwise not hit.
844
845The build directory is automatically deleted upon completion, unless the
846build failed and the client specified @option{--keep-failed}
847(@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
848
bd5e766b
LC
849The following command-line options are supported:
850
851@table @code
852@item --build-users-group=@var{group}
853Take users from @var{group} to run build processes (@pxref{Setting Up
854the Daemon, build users}).
855
6858f9d1 856@item --no-substitutes
b5385b52 857@cindex substitutes
6858f9d1 858Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
c4202d60
LC
859locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
860(@pxref{Substitutes}).
6858f9d1 861
b5385b52
LC
862By default substitutes are used, unless the client---such as the
863@command{guix package} command---is explicitly invoked with
864@code{--no-substitutes}.
865
866When the daemon runs with @code{--no-substitutes}, clients can still
867explicitly enable substitution @i{via} the @code{set-build-options}
868remote procedure call (@pxref{The Store}).
869
9176607e 870@item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
f8a8e0fe 871@anchor{daemon-substitute-urls}
9176607e 872Consider @var{urls} the default whitespace-separated list of substitute
ae806096 873source URLs. When this option is omitted, @indicateurl{http://hydra.gnu.org}
9176607e
LC
874is used.
875
876This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, as long
877as they are signed by a trusted signature (@pxref{Substitutes}).
878
4ec2e92d
LC
879@cindex build hook
880@item --no-build-hook
881Do not use the @dfn{build hook}.
882
883The build hook is a helper program that the daemon can start and to
884which it submits build requests. This mechanism is used to offload
885builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}).
886
bd5e766b
LC
887@item --cache-failures
888Cache build failures. By default, only successful builds are cached.
889
30d9aa54
LC
890When this option is used, @command{guix gc --list-failures} can be used
891to query the set of store items marked as failed; @command{guix gc
892--clear-failures} removes store items from the set of cached failures.
893@xref{Invoking guix gc}.
894
bd5e766b
LC
895@item --cores=@var{n}
896@itemx -c @var{n}
897Use @var{n} CPU cores to build each derivation; @code{0} means as many
898as available.
899
6efc160e 900The default value is @code{0}, but it may be overridden by clients, such
e49951eb
MW
901as the @code{--cores} option of @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking
902guix build}).
bd5e766b
LC
903
904The effect is to define the @code{NIX_BUILD_CORES} environment variable
905in the build process, which can then use it to exploit internal
906parallelism---for instance, by running @code{make -j$NIX_BUILD_CORES}.
907
908@item --max-jobs=@var{n}
909@itemx -M @var{n}
910Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. The default value is
f6526eb3
LC
911@code{1}. Setting it to @code{0} means that no builds will be performed
912locally; instead, the daemon will offload builds (@pxref{Daemon Offload
913Setup}), or simply fail.
bd5e766b 914
ecf84b7c
LC
915@item --rounds=@var{N}
916Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
917consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical. Note that this
918setting can be overridden by clients such as @command{guix build}
919(@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
920
bd5e766b
LC
921@item --debug
922Produce debugging output.
923
924This is useful to debug daemon start-up issues, but then it may be
925overridden by clients, for example the @code{--verbosity} option of
e49951eb 926@command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
bd5e766b
LC
927
928@item --chroot-directory=@var{dir}
929Add @var{dir} to the build chroot.
930
931Doing this may change the result of build processes---for instance if
932they use optional dependencies found in @var{dir} when it is available,
933and not otherwise. For that reason, it is not recommended to do so.
934Instead, make sure that each derivation declares all the inputs that it
935needs.
936
937@item --disable-chroot
938Disable chroot builds.
939
940Using this option is not recommended since, again, it would allow build
1e2644bb
LC
941processes to gain access to undeclared dependencies. It is necessary,
942though, when @command{guix-daemon} is running under an unprivileged user
943account.
bd5e766b
LC
944
945@item --disable-log-compression
946Disable compression of the build logs.
947
1da983b9
LC
948Unless @code{--lose-logs} is used, all the build logs are kept in the
949@var{localstatedir}. To save space, the daemon automatically compresses
950them with bzip2 by default. This option disables that.
951
ab3893d7
LC
952@item --disable-deduplication
953@cindex deduplication
bd5e766b
LC
954Disable automatic file ``deduplication'' in the store.
955
1da983b9 956By default, files added to the store are automatically ``deduplicated'':
ab3893d7
LC
957if a newly added file is identical to another one found in the store,
958the daemon makes the new file a hard link to the other file. This can
4988dd40 959noticeably reduce disk usage, at the expense of slightly increased
ab3893d7
LC
960input/output load at the end of a build process. This option disables
961this optimization.
1da983b9 962
6e37066e
LC
963@item --gc-keep-outputs[=yes|no]
964Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep outputs of live
965derivations.
966
967When set to ``yes'', the GC will keep the outputs of any live derivation
968available in the store---the @code{.drv} files. The default is ``no'',
969meaning that derivation outputs are kept only if they are GC roots.
970
971@item --gc-keep-derivations[=yes|no]
972Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep derivations
973corresponding to live outputs.
974
975When set to ``yes'', as is the case by default, the GC keeps
976derivations---i.e., @code{.drv} files---as long as at least one of their
977outputs is live. This allows users to keep track of the origins of
978items in their store. Setting it to ``no'' saves a bit of disk space.
979
980Note that when both @code{--gc-keep-derivations} and
981@code{--gc-keep-outputs} are used, the effect is to keep all the build
982prerequisites (the sources, compiler, libraries, and other build-time
983tools) of live objects in the store, regardless of whether these
984prerequisites are live. This is convenient for developers since it
985saves rebuilds or downloads.
986
bd5e766b
LC
987@item --impersonate-linux-2.6
988On Linux-based systems, impersonate Linux 2.6. This means that the
989kernel's @code{uname} system call will report 2.6 as the release number.
990
991This might be helpful to build programs that (usually wrongfully) depend
992on the kernel version number.
993
994@item --lose-logs
995Do not keep build logs. By default they are kept under
ce33631f 996@code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/log}.
bd5e766b
LC
997
998@item --system=@var{system}
999Assume @var{system} as the current system type. By default it is the
1000architecture/kernel pair found at configure time, such as
1001@code{x86_64-linux}.
b8d2aa26
LC
1002
1003@item --listen=@var{socket}
1004Listen for connections on @var{socket}, the file name of a Unix-domain
1005socket. The default socket is
1006@file{@var{localstatedir}/daemon-socket/socket}. This option is only
1007useful in exceptional circumstances, such as if you need to run several
1008daemons on the same machine.
bd5e766b
LC
1009@end table
1010
1011
0e2d0213
LC
1012@node Application Setup
1013@section Application Setup
1014
85e57214
LC
1015When using Guix on top of GNU/Linux distribution other than GuixSD---a
1016so-called @dfn{foreign distro}---a few additional steps are needed to
1017get everything in place. Here are some of them.
0e2d0213
LC
1018
1019@subsection Locales
1020
5c3c1427 1021@anchor{locales-and-locpath}
0e2d0213 1022@cindex locales, when not on GuixSD
5c3c1427 1023@vindex LOCPATH
85e57214 1024@vindex GUIX_LOCPATH
f97c9175
AE
1025Packages installed @i{via} Guix will not use the locale data of the
1026host system. Instead, you must first install one of the locale packages
85e57214
LC
1027available with Guix and then define the @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} environment
1028variable:
0e2d0213
LC
1029
1030@example
1031$ guix package -i glibc-locales
85e57214 1032$ export GUIX_LOCPATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/lib/locale
0e2d0213
LC
1033@end example
1034
1035Note that the @code{glibc-locales} package contains data for all the
1036locales supported by the GNU@tie{}libc and weighs in at around
f97c9175 1037110@tie{}MiB. Alternatively, the @code{glibc-utf8-locales} is smaller but
0e2d0213
LC
1038limited to a few UTF-8 locales.
1039
85e57214
LC
1040The @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} variable plays a role similar to @code{LOCPATH}
1041(@pxref{Locale Names, @code{LOCPATH},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
1042Manual}). There are two important differences though:
1043
1044@enumerate
1045@item
f97c9175 1046@code{GUIX_LOCPATH} is honored only by the libc in Guix, and not by the libc
85e57214 1047provided by foreign distros. Thus, using @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} allows you
f97c9175 1048to make sure the programs of the foreign distro will not end up loading
85e57214
LC
1049incompatible locale data.
1050
1051@item
1052libc suffixes each entry of @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} with @code{/X.Y}, where
1053@code{X.Y} is the libc version---e.g., @code{2.22}. This means that,
1054should your Guix profile contain a mixture of programs linked against
1055different libc version, each libc version will only try to load locale
1056data in the right format.
1057@end enumerate
1058
1059This is important because the locale data format used by different libc
1060versions may be incompatible.
1061
0e2d0213
LC
1062@subsection X11 Fonts
1063
4988dd40 1064The majority of graphical applications use Fontconfig to locate and
f97c9175
AE
1065load fonts and perform X11-client-side rendering. The @code{fontconfig}
1066package in Guix looks for fonts in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}
0e2d0213 1067by default. Thus, to allow graphical applications installed with Guix
f97c9175 1068to display fonts, you have to install fonts with Guix as well.
0e2d0213 1069Essential font packages include @code{gs-fonts}, @code{font-dejavu}, and
8fe5b1d1 1070@code{font-gnu-freefont-ttf}.
0e2d0213 1071
5c36edc8
LC
1072To display text written in Chinese languages, Japanese, or Korean in
1073graphical applications, consider installing
1074@code{font-adobe-source-han-sans} or @code{font-wqy-zenhei}. The former
1075has multiple outputs, one per language family (@pxref{Packages with
1076Multiple Outputs}). For instance, the following command installs fonts
1077for Chinese languages:
1078
1079@example
1080guix package -i font-adobe-source-han-sans:cn
1081@end example
1082
6d97319c
AK
1083@subsection Emacs Packages
1084
1085When you install Emacs packages with Guix, the elisp files may be placed
1086either in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/} or in
1087sub-directories of
1088@file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d/}. The latter
1089directory exists because potentially there may exist thousands of Emacs
1090packages and storing all their files in a single directory may be not
1091reliable (because of name conflicts). So we think using a separate
1092directory for each package is a good idea. It is very similar to how
1093the Emacs package system organizes the file structure (@pxref{Package
1094Files,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1095
1096By default, Emacs (installed with Guix) ``knows'' where these packages
f97c9175 1097are placed, so you do not need to perform any configuration. If, for
6d97319c 1098some reason, you want to avoid auto-loading Emacs packages installed
f97c9175 1099with Guix, you can do so by running Emacs with @code{--no-site-file}
6d97319c
AK
1100option (@pxref{Init File,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1101
0e2d0213
LC
1102@c TODO What else?
1103
eeaf4427
LC
1104@c *********************************************************************
1105@node Package Management
1106@chapter Package Management
1107
f8348b91 1108The purpose of GNU Guix is to allow users to easily install, upgrade, and
eeaf4427 1109remove software packages, without having to know about their build
f97c9175 1110procedures or dependencies. Guix also goes beyond this obvious set of
eeaf4427
LC
1111features.
1112
1113This chapter describes the main features of Guix, as well as the package
c1941588 1114management tools it provides. Two user interfaces are provided for
c554de89
AK
1115routine package management tasks: A command-line interface described below
1116(@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{guix package}}), as well as a visual user
1117interface in Emacs described in a subsequent chapter (@pxref{Emacs Interface}).
eeaf4427
LC
1118
1119@menu
1120* Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
e49951eb 1121* Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
c4202d60 1122* Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
760c60d6 1123* Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
e49951eb 1124* Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
f651b477 1125* Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
760c60d6 1126* Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
eeaf4427
LC
1127@end menu
1128
1129@node Features
1130@section Features
1131
1132When using Guix, each package ends up in the @dfn{package store}, in its
1133own directory---something that resembles
9a130e19
AK
1134@file{/gnu/store/xxx-package-1.2}, where @code{xxx} is a base32 string
1135(note that Guix comes with an Emacs extension to shorten those file
081145cf 1136names, @pxref{Emacs Prettify}.)
eeaf4427
LC
1137
1138Instead of referring to these directories, users have their own
1139@dfn{profile}, which points to the packages that they actually want to
821b0015
LC
1140use. These profiles are stored within each user's home directory, at
1141@code{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
eeaf4427 1142
821b0015 1143For example, @code{alice} installs GCC 4.7.2. As a result,
eeaf4427 1144@file{/home/alice/.guix-profile/bin/gcc} points to
834129e0 1145@file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2/bin/gcc}. Now, on the same machine,
821b0015
LC
1146@code{bob} had already installed GCC 4.8.0. The profile of @code{bob}
1147simply continues to point to
834129e0 1148@file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.0/bin/gcc}---i.e., both versions of GCC
821b0015 1149coexist on the same system without any interference.
eeaf4427 1150
e49951eb 1151The @command{guix package} command is the central tool to manage
f97c9175 1152packages (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). It operates on the per-user
821b0015 1153profiles, and can be used @emph{with normal user privileges}.
eeaf4427
LC
1154
1155The command provides the obvious install, remove, and upgrade
1156operations. Each invocation is actually a @emph{transaction}: either
ba55b1cb 1157the specified operation succeeds, or nothing happens. Thus, if the
e49951eb 1158@command{guix package} process is terminated during the transaction,
eeaf4427
LC
1159or if a power outage occurs during the transaction, then the user's
1160profile remains in its previous state, and remains usable.
1161
1162In addition, any package transaction may be @emph{rolled back}. So, if,
1163for example, an upgrade installs a new version of a package that turns
1164out to have a serious bug, users may roll back to the previous instance
4af2447e
LC
1165of their profile, which was known to work well. Similarly, the global
1166system configuration is subject to transactional upgrades and roll-back
1167(@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
eeaf4427 1168
f97c9175
AE
1169All packages in the package store may be @emph{garbage-collected}.
1170Guix can determine which packages are still referenced by user
fe8ff028 1171profiles, and remove those that are provably no longer referenced
e49951eb 1172(@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Users may also explicitly remove old
fe8ff028
LC
1173generations of their profile so that the packages they refer to can be
1174collected.
eeaf4427 1175
e900c503
LC
1176@cindex reproducibility
1177@cindex reproducible builds
eeaf4427
LC
1178Finally, Guix takes a @dfn{purely functional} approach to package
1179management, as described in the introduction (@pxref{Introduction}).
834129e0 1180Each @file{/gnu/store} package directory name contains a hash of all the
eeaf4427
LC
1181inputs that were used to build that package---compiler, libraries, build
1182scripts, etc. This direct correspondence allows users to make sure a
1183given package installation matches the current state of their
e900c503
LC
1184distribution. It also helps maximize @dfn{build reproducibility}:
1185thanks to the isolated build environments that are used, a given build
1186is likely to yield bit-identical files when performed on different
1187machines (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, container}).
eeaf4427 1188
c4202d60 1189@cindex substitutes
eeaf4427 1190This foundation allows Guix to support @dfn{transparent binary/source
c4202d60 1191deployment}. When a pre-built binary for a @file{/gnu/store} item is
18f2887b 1192available from an external source---a @dfn{substitute}, Guix just
c4202d60
LC
1193downloads it and unpacks it;
1194otherwise, it builds the package from source, locally
1195(@pxref{Substitutes}).
eeaf4427 1196
f5fd4fd2
LC
1197Control over the build environment is a feature that is also useful for
1198developers. The @command{guix environment} command allows developers of
1199a package to quickly set up the right development environment for their
f97c9175
AE
1200package, without having to manually install the dependencies of the
1201package into their profile (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
f5fd4fd2 1202
e49951eb
MW
1203@node Invoking guix package
1204@section Invoking @command{guix package}
eeaf4427 1205
e49951eb 1206The @command{guix package} command is the tool that allows users to
eeaf4427
LC
1207install, upgrade, and remove packages, as well as rolling back to
1208previous configurations. It operates only on the user's own profile,
1209and works with normal user privileges (@pxref{Features}). Its syntax
1210is:
1211
1212@example
e49951eb 1213guix package @var{options}
eeaf4427
LC
1214@end example
1215
ba55b1cb 1216Primarily, @var{options} specifies the operations to be performed during
eeaf4427 1217the transaction. Upon completion, a new profile is created, but
99bd74d5 1218previous @dfn{generations} of the profile remain available, should the user
eeaf4427
LC
1219want to roll back.
1220
6447738c
MW
1221For example, to remove @code{lua} and install @code{guile} and
1222@code{guile-cairo} in a single transaction:
1223
1224@example
1225guix package -r lua -i guile guile-cairo
1226@end example
1227
99bd74d5
LC
1228@command{guix package} also supports a @dfn{declarative approach}
1229whereby the user specifies the exact set of packages to be available and
1230passes it @i{via} the @option{--manifest} option
1231(@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
1232
b9e5c0a9 1233For each user, a symlink to the user's default profile is automatically
0ec1af59 1234created in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}. This symlink always points to the
b9e5c0a9
LC
1235current generation of the user's default profile. Thus, users can add
1236@file{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin} to their @code{PATH} environment
1237variable, and so on.
d664f1b4
LC
1238@cindex search paths
1239If you are not using the Guix System Distribution, consider adding the
1240following lines to your @file{~/.bash_profile} (@pxref{Bash Startup
1241Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}) so that newly-spawned
1242shells get all the right environment variable definitions:
1243
1244@example
1245GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile" \
1246source "$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/profile"
1247@end example
b9e5c0a9 1248
4379c35b
LC
1249In a multi-user setup, user profiles are stored in a place registered as
1250a @dfn{garbage-collector root}, which @file{$HOME/.guix-profile} points
1251to (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). That directory is normally
0ec1af59
LC
1252@code{@var{localstatedir}/profiles/per-user/@var{user}}, where
1253@var{localstatedir} is the value passed to @code{configure} as
4379c35b
LC
1254@code{--localstatedir}, and @var{user} is the user name. The
1255@file{per-user} directory is created when @command{guix-daemon} is
1256started, and the @var{user} sub-directory is created by @command{guix
1257package}.
0ec1af59
LC
1258
1259The @var{options} can be among the following:
1260
eeaf4427
LC
1261@table @code
1262
6447738c
MW
1263@item --install=@var{package} @dots{}
1264@itemx -i @var{package} @dots{}
1265Install the specified @var{package}s.
eeaf4427 1266
6447738c 1267Each @var{package} may specify either a simple package name, such as
eeaf4427 1268@code{guile}, or a package name followed by a hyphen and version number,
724311a2
LC
1269such as @code{guile-1.8.8} or simply @code{guile-1.8} (in the latter
1270case, the newest version prefixed by @code{1.8} is selected.)
1271
1272If no version number is specified, the
dc5669cd
MW
1273newest available version will be selected. In addition, @var{package}
1274may contain a colon, followed by the name of one of the outputs of the
6e721c4d 1275package, as in @code{gcc:doc} or @code{binutils-2.22:lib}
e7f34eb0
LC
1276(@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). Packages with a corresponding
1277name (and optionally version) are searched for among the GNU
1278distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
eeaf4427 1279
461572cc
LC
1280@cindex propagated inputs
1281Sometimes packages have @dfn{propagated inputs}: these are dependencies
21461f27
LC
1282that automatically get installed along with the required package
1283(@pxref{package-propagated-inputs, @code{propagated-inputs} in
1284@code{package} objects}, for information about propagated inputs in
1285package definitions).
461572cc 1286
21461f27 1287@anchor{package-cmd-propagated-inputs}
461572cc
LC
1288An example is the GNU MPC library: its C header files refer to those of
1289the GNU MPFR library, which in turn refer to those of the GMP library.
1290Thus, when installing MPC, the MPFR and GMP libraries also get installed
1291in the profile; removing MPC also removes MPFR and GMP---unless they had
f97c9175 1292also been explicitly installed by the user.
461572cc 1293
ba7ea5ce 1294Besides, packages sometimes rely on the definition of environment
5924080d 1295variables for their search paths (see explanation of
ba7ea5ce 1296@code{--search-paths} below). Any missing or possibly incorrect
5924080d
LC
1297environment variable definitions are reported here.
1298
ef010c0f 1299@c XXX: keep me up-to-date
5924080d 1300Finally, when installing a GNU package, the tool reports the
ef010c0f
LC
1301availability of a newer upstream version. In the future, it may provide
1302the option of installing directly from the upstream version, even if
1303that version is not yet in the distribution.
1304
5d4b411f
LC
1305@item --install-from-expression=@var{exp}
1306@itemx -e @var{exp}
1307Install the package @var{exp} evaluates to.
1308
1309@var{exp} must be a Scheme expression that evaluates to a
1310@code{<package>} object. This option is notably useful to disambiguate
1311between same-named variants of a package, with expressions such as
1312@code{(@@ (gnu packages base) guile-final)}.
1313
1314Note that this option installs the first output of the specified
1315package, which may be insufficient when needing a specific output of a
1316multiple-output package.
1317
0d279400
DT
1318@item --install-from-file=@var{file}
1319@itemx -f @var{file}
1320Install the package that the code within @var{file} evaluates to.
1321
1322As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
1323(@pxref{Defining Packages}):
1324
1325@example
1326@verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
1327@end example
1328
1329Developers may find it useful to include such a @file{package.scm} file
f97c9175 1330in the root of their project source tree that can be used to test
0d279400
DT
1331development snapshots and create reproducible development environments
1332(@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
1333
6447738c
MW
1334@item --remove=@var{package} @dots{}
1335@itemx -r @var{package} @dots{}
1336Remove the specified @var{package}s.
eeaf4427 1337
6447738c 1338As for @code{--install}, each @var{package} may specify a version number
13ed095c
LC
1339and/or output name in addition to the package name. For instance,
1340@code{-r glibc:debug} would remove the @code{debug} output of
1341@code{glibc}.
1342
6447738c
MW
1343@item --upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1344@itemx -u [@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1345Upgrade all the installed packages. If one or more @var{regexp}s are
1346specified, upgrade only installed packages whose name matches a
d5f01e48 1347@var{regexp}. Also see the @code{--do-not-upgrade} option below.
eeaf4427 1348
f651b477
LC
1349Note that this upgrades package to the latest version of packages found
1350in the distribution currently installed. To update your distribution,
1351you should regularly run @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix
1352pull}).
1353
d5f01e48
MW
1354@item --do-not-upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
1355When used together with the @code{--upgrade} option, do @emph{not}
1356upgrade any packages whose name matches a @var{regexp}. For example, to
1357upgrade all packages in the current profile except those containing the
1358substring ``emacs'':
1359
1360@example
1361$ guix package --upgrade . --do-not-upgrade emacs
1362@end example
1363
99bd74d5 1364@item @anchor{profile-manifest}--manifest=@var{file}
1b676447 1365@itemx -m @var{file}
99bd74d5
LC
1366@cindex profile declaration
1367@cindex profile manifest
1368Create a new generation of the profile from the manifest object
1b676447
DT
1369returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}.
1370
99bd74d5
LC
1371This allows you to @emph{declare} the profile's contents rather than
1372constructing it through a sequence of @code{--install} and similar
1373commands. The advantage is that @var{file} can be put under version
1374control, copied to different machines to reproduce the same profile, and
1375so on.
1376
1377@c FIXME: Add reference to (guix profile) documentation when available.
1378@var{file} must return a @dfn{manifest} object, which is roughly a list
1379of packages:
1b676447 1380
99bd74d5 1381@findex packages->manifest
1b676447 1382@example
99bd74d5 1383(use-package-modules guile emacs)
1b676447
DT
1384
1385(packages->manifest
99bd74d5
LC
1386 (list emacs
1387 guile-2.0
1b676447 1388 ;; Use a specific package output.
99bd74d5 1389 (list guile-2.0 "debug")))
1b676447
DT
1390@end example
1391
24e262f0
LC
1392@item --roll-back
1393Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of the profile---i.e., undo
1394the last transaction.
1395
1396When combined with options such as @code{--install}, roll back occurs
1397before any other actions.
1398
d9307267 1399When rolling back from the first generation that actually contains
4b2bc804 1400installed packages, the profile is made to point to the @dfn{zeroth
f97c9175 1401generation}, which contains no files apart from its own metadata.
d9307267 1402
f97c9175
AE
1403After having rolled back, installing, removing, or upgrading packages
1404overwrites previous future generations. Thus, the history of the
1405generations in a profile is always linear.
82fe08ed 1406
b3bb82f1
AK
1407@item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
1408@itemx -S @var{pattern}
1409Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
1410
1411@var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
1412with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
1413specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
1414the latest generation after @code{--roll-back}, use
1415@code{--switch-generation=+1}.
1416
1417The difference between @code{--roll-back} and
1418@code{--switch-generation=-1} is that @code{--switch-generation} will
1419not make a zeroth generation, so if a specified generation does not
1420exist, the current generation will not be changed.
1421
dbc31ab2 1422@item --search-paths[=@var{kind}]
5924080d
LC
1423@cindex search paths
1424Report environment variable definitions, in Bash syntax, that may be
1425needed in order to use the set of installed packages. These environment
1426variables are used to specify @dfn{search paths} for files used by some
1427of the installed packages.
1428
1429For example, GCC needs the @code{CPATH} and @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
1430environment variables to be defined so it can look for headers and
1431libraries in the user's profile (@pxref{Environment Variables,,, gcc,
1432Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). If GCC and, say, the C
1433library are installed in the profile, then @code{--search-paths} will
1434suggest setting these variables to @code{@var{profile}/include} and
1435@code{@var{profile}/lib}, respectively.
1436
dbc31ab2
LC
1437The typical use case is to define these environment variables in the
1438shell:
1439
1440@example
1441$ eval `guix package --search-paths`
1442@end example
1443
1444@var{kind} may be one of @code{exact}, @code{prefix}, or @code{suffix},
1445meaning that the returned environment variable definitions will either
1446be exact settings, or prefixes or suffixes of the current value of these
1447variables. When omitted, @var{kind} defaults to @code{exact}.
1448
fc2d2339
LC
1449This option can also be used to compute the @emph{combined} search paths
1450of several profiles. Consider this example:
1451
1452@example
1453$ guix package -p foo -i guile
1454$ guix package -p bar -i guile-json
1455$ guix package -p foo -p bar --search-paths
1456@end example
1457
1458The last command above reports about the @code{GUILE_LOAD_PATH}
1459variable, even though, taken individually, neither @file{foo} nor
1460@file{bar} would lead to that recommendation.
1461
1462
eeaf4427
LC
1463@item --profile=@var{profile}
1464@itemx -p @var{profile}
1465Use @var{profile} instead of the user's default profile.
1466
70915c1a 1467@item --verbose
f97c9175
AE
1468Produce verbose output. In particular, emit the build log of the
1469environment on the standard error port.
70915c1a 1470
eeaf4427
LC
1471@item --bootstrap
1472Use the bootstrap Guile to build the profile. This option is only
1473useful to distribution developers.
1474
1475@end table
1476
f97c9175 1477In addition to these actions, @command{guix package} supports the
733b4130
LC
1478following options to query the current state of a profile, or the
1479availability of packages:
eeaf4427 1480
733b4130
LC
1481@table @option
1482
acc08466
NK
1483@item --search=@var{regexp}
1484@itemx -s @var{regexp}
b110869d 1485@cindex searching for packages
5763ad92 1486List the available packages whose name, synopsis, or description matches
f97c9175 1487@var{regexp}. Print all the metadata of matching packages in
299112d3
LC
1488@code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils,
1489GNU recutils manual}).
acc08466 1490
299112d3
LC
1491This allows specific fields to be extracted using the @command{recsel}
1492command, for instance:
1493
1494@example
e49951eb 1495$ guix package -s malloc | recsel -p name,version
299112d3
LC
1496name: glibc
1497version: 2.17
1498
1499name: libgc
1500version: 7.2alpha6
1501@end example
acc08466 1502
a12d92f5
LC
1503Similarly, to show the name of all the packages available under the
1504terms of the GNU@tie{}LGPL version 3:
1505
1506@example
1507$ guix package -s "" | recsel -p name -e 'license ~ "LGPL 3"'
1508name: elfutils
1509
1510name: gmp
1511@dots{}
1512@end example
1513
db5a9444
LC
1514It is also possible to refine search results using several @code{-s}
1515flags. For example, the following command returns a list of board
1516games:
1517
1518@example
1519$ guix package -s '\<board\>' -s game | recsel -p name
1520name: gnubg
1521@dots{}
1522@end example
1523
1524If we were to omit @code{-s game}, we would also get software packages
1525that deal with printed circuit boards; removing the angle brackets
1526around @code{board} would further add packages that have to do with
1527keyboards.
1528
b110869d
LC
1529And now for a more elaborate example. The following command searches
1530for cryptographic libraries, filters out Haskell, Perl, Python, and Ruby
1531libraries, and prints the name and synopsis of the matching packages:
1532
1533@example
1534$ guix package -s crypto -s library | \
1535 recsel -e '! (name ~ "^(ghc|perl|python|ruby)")' -p name,synopsis
1536@end example
1537
1538@noindent
1539@xref{Selection Expressions,,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}, for more
1540information on @dfn{selection expressions} for @code{recsel -e}.
1541
2aa6efb0
CR
1542@item --show=@var{package}
1543Show details about @var{package}, taken from the list of available packages, in
1544@code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU
1545recutils manual}).
1546
1547@example
1548$ guix package --show=python | recsel -p name,version
1549name: python
1550version: 2.7.6
1551
1552name: python
1553version: 3.3.5
1554@end example
1555
1556You may also specify the full name of a package to only get details about a
1557specific version of it:
1558@example
1559$ guix package --show=python-3.3.5 | recsel -p name,version
1560name: python
1561version: 3.3.5
1562@end example
1563
1564
1565
733b4130
LC
1566@item --list-installed[=@var{regexp}]
1567@itemx -I [@var{regexp}]
bd9bde1c
LC
1568List the currently installed packages in the specified profile, with the
1569most recently installed packages shown last. When @var{regexp} is
1570specified, list only installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
733b4130
LC
1571
1572For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
1573tabs: the package name, its version string, the part of the package that
1574is installed (for instance, @code{out} for the default output,
1575@code{include} for its headers, etc.), and the path of this package in
1576the store.
1577
64fc89b6
LC
1578@item --list-available[=@var{regexp}]
1579@itemx -A [@var{regexp}]
5763ad92 1580List packages currently available in the distribution for this system
a1ba8475
LC
1581(@pxref{GNU Distribution}). When @var{regexp} is specified, list only
1582installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
64fc89b6
LC
1583
1584For each package, print the following items separated by tabs: its name,
6e721c4d
LC
1585its version string, the parts of the package (@pxref{Packages with
1586Multiple Outputs}), and the source location of its definition.
64fc89b6 1587
f566d765
LC
1588@item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
1589@itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
1590Return a list of generations along with their creation dates; for each
1591generation, show the installed packages, with the most recently
4b2bc804
NK
1592installed packages shown last. Note that the zeroth generation is never
1593shown.
f566d765
LC
1594
1595For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
1596tabs: the name of a package, its version string, the part of the package
1597that is installed (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}), and the
1598location of this package in the store.
1599
1600When @var{pattern} is used, the command returns only matching
1601generations. Valid patterns include:
1602
1603@itemize
1604@item @emph{Integers and comma-separated integers}. Both patterns denote
1605generation numbers. For instance, @code{--list-generations=1} returns
1606the first one.
1607
1608And @code{--list-generations=1,8,2} outputs three generations in the
1609specified order. Neither spaces nor trailing commas are allowed.
1610
1611@item @emph{Ranges}. @code{--list-generations=2..9} prints the
1612specified generations and everything in between. Note that the start of
f97c9175 1613a range must be smaller than its end.
f566d765
LC
1614
1615It is also possible to omit the endpoint. For example,
1616@code{--list-generations=2..}, returns all generations starting from the
1617second one.
1618
1619@item @emph{Durations}. You can also get the last @emph{N}@tie{}days, weeks,
1620or months by passing an integer along with the first letter of the
d7ddb257
LC
1621duration. For example, @code{--list-generations=20d} lists generations
1622that are up to 20 days old.
f566d765
LC
1623@end itemize
1624
b7884ca3
NK
1625@item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
1626@itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
d7ddb257
LC
1627When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
1628one.
b7884ca3
NK
1629
1630This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
d7ddb257
LC
1631When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
1632@var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
1633specified duration match. For instance, @code{--delete-generations=1m}
1634deletes generations that are more than one month old.
1635
391bdd8f
LC
1636If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted. Also, the
1637zeroth generation is never deleted.
b7884ca3 1638
f97c9175 1639Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
1bb9900a
LC
1640Consequently, this command must be used with care.
1641
733b4130 1642@end table
eeaf4427 1643
70ee5642 1644Finally, since @command{guix package} may actually start build
ccd7158d 1645processes, it supports all the common build options (@pxref{Common Build
f97c9175 1646Options}). It also supports package transformation options, such as
b8638f03
LC
1647@option{--with-source} (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
1648However, note that package transformations are lost when upgrading; to
f97c9175 1649preserve transformations across upgrades, you should define your own
b8638f03
LC
1650package variant in a Guile module and add it to @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
1651(@pxref{Defining Packages}).
1652
70ee5642 1653
c4202d60
LC
1654@node Substitutes
1655@section Substitutes
1656
1657@cindex substitutes
1658@cindex pre-built binaries
1659Guix supports transparent source/binary deployment, which means that it
1660can either build things locally, or download pre-built items from a
1661server. We call these pre-built items @dfn{substitutes}---they are
1662substitutes for local build results. In many cases, downloading a
1663substitute is much faster than building things locally.
1664
1665Substitutes can be anything resulting from a derivation build
1666(@pxref{Derivations}). Of course, in the common case, they are
1667pre-built package binaries, but source tarballs, for instance, which
1668also result from derivation builds, can be available as substitutes.
1669
1670The @code{hydra.gnu.org} server is a front-end to a build farm that
1671builds packages from the GNU distribution continuously for some
32950fc8
AK
1672architectures, and makes them available as substitutes (@pxref{Emacs
1673Hydra}, for information on how to query the continuous integration
1674server). This is the
f8a8e0fe
LC
1675default source of substitutes; it can be overridden by passing the
1676@option{--substitute-urls} option either to @command{guix-daemon}
1677(@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}})
1678or to client tools such as @command{guix package}
1679(@pxref{client-substitute-urls,, client @option{--substitute-urls}
1680option}).
c4202d60
LC
1681
1682@cindex security
1683@cindex digital signatures
1684To allow Guix to download substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org}, you
1685must add its public key to the access control list (ACL) of archive
1686imports, using the @command{guix archive} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
1687archive}). Doing so implies that you trust @code{hydra.gnu.org} to not
1688be compromised and to serve genuine substitutes.
1689
1690This public key is installed along with Guix, in
1691@code{@var{prefix}/share/guix/hydra.gnu.org.pub}, where @var{prefix} is
1692the installation prefix of Guix. If you installed Guix from source,
1693make sure you checked the GPG signature of
1694@file{guix-@value{VERSION}.tar.gz}, which contains this public key file.
1695Then, you can run something like this:
1696
1697@example
1698# guix archive --authorize < hydra.gnu.org.pub
1699@end example
1700
1701Once this is in place, the output of a command like @code{guix build}
1702should change from something like:
1703
1704@example
1705$ guix build emacs --dry-run
1706The following derivations would be built:
1707 /gnu/store/yr7bnx8xwcayd6j95r2clmkdl1qh688w-emacs-24.3.drv
1708 /gnu/store/x8qsh1hlhgjx6cwsjyvybnfv2i37z23w-dbus-1.6.4.tar.gz.drv
1709 /gnu/store/1ixwp12fl950d15h2cj11c73733jay0z-alsa-lib-1.0.27.1.tar.bz2.drv
1710 /gnu/store/nlma1pw0p603fpfiqy7kn4zm105r5dmw-util-linux-2.21.drv
1711@dots{}
1712@end example
1713
1714@noindent
1715to something like:
1716
1717@example
1718$ guix build emacs --dry-run
1719The following files would be downloaded:
1720 /gnu/store/pk3n22lbq6ydamyymqkkz7i69wiwjiwi-emacs-24.3
1721 /gnu/store/2ygn4ncnhrpr61rssa6z0d9x22si0va3-libjpeg-8d
1722 /gnu/store/71yz6lgx4dazma9dwn2mcjxaah9w77jq-cairo-1.12.16
1723 /gnu/store/7zdhgp0n1518lvfn8mb96sxqfmvqrl7v-libxrender-0.9.7
1724@dots{}
1725@end example
1726
1727@noindent
1728This indicates that substitutes from @code{hydra.gnu.org} are usable and
1729will be downloaded, when possible, for future builds.
1730
1731Guix ignores substitutes that are not signed, or that are not signed by
ef27aa9c 1732one of the keys listed in the ACL. It also detects and raises an error
c4202d60
LC
1733when attempting to use a substitute that has been tampered with.
1734
e0c941fe
LC
1735@vindex http_proxy
1736Substitutes are downloaded over HTTP. The @code{http_proxy} environment
1737variable can be set in the environment of @command{guix-daemon} and is
1738honored for downloads of substitutes. Note that the value of
1739@code{http_proxy} in the environment where @command{guix build},
1740@command{guix package}, and other client commands are run has
1741@emph{absolutely no effect}.
1742
c4202d60
LC
1743The substitute mechanism can be disabled globally by running
1744@code{guix-daemon} with @code{--no-substitutes} (@pxref{Invoking
1745guix-daemon}). It can also be disabled temporarily by passing the
1746@code{--no-substitutes} option to @command{guix package}, @command{guix
1747build}, and other command-line tools.
1748
1749
1750Today, each individual's control over their own computing is at the
1751mercy of institutions, corporations, and groups with enough power and
1752determination to subvert the computing infrastructure and exploit its
1753weaknesses. While using @code{hydra.gnu.org} substitutes can be
1754convenient, we encourage users to also build on their own, or even run
1755their own build farm, such that @code{hydra.gnu.org} is less of an
8ce229fc
LC
1756interesting target. One way to help is by publishing the software you
1757build using @command{guix publish} so that others have one more choice
1758of server to download substitutes from (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
c4202d60
LC
1759
1760Guix has the foundations to maximize build reproducibility
1761(@pxref{Features}). In most cases, independent builds of a given
1762package or derivation should yield bit-identical results. Thus, through
1763a diverse set of independent package builds, we can strengthen the
d23c20f1
LC
1764integrity of our systems. The @command{guix challenge} command aims to
1765help users assess substitute servers, and to assist developers in
1766finding out about non-deterministic package builds (@pxref{Invoking guix
a8d65643
LC
1767challenge}). Similarly, the @option{--check} option of @command{guix
1768build} allows users to check whether previously-installed substitutes
1769are genuine by rebuilding them locally (@pxref{build-check,
1770@command{guix build --check}}).
c4202d60
LC
1771
1772In the future, we want Guix to have support to publish and retrieve
1773binaries to/from other users, in a peer-to-peer fashion. If you would
1774like to discuss this project, join us on @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
1775
1776
6e721c4d
LC
1777@node Packages with Multiple Outputs
1778@section Packages with Multiple Outputs
1779
1780@cindex multiple-output packages
1781@cindex package outputs
1782
1783Often, packages defined in Guix have a single @dfn{output}---i.e., the
f97c9175 1784source package leads to exactly one directory in the store. When running
6e721c4d
LC
1785@command{guix package -i glibc}, one installs the default output of the
1786GNU libc package; the default output is called @code{out}, but its name
1787can be omitted as shown in this command. In this particular case, the
1788default output of @code{glibc} contains all the C header files, shared
1789libraries, static libraries, Info documentation, and other supporting
1790files.
1791
1792Sometimes it is more appropriate to separate the various types of files
1793produced from a single source package into separate outputs. For
1794instance, the GLib C library (used by GTK+ and related packages)
1795installs more than 20 MiB of reference documentation as HTML pages.
1796To save space for users who do not need it, the documentation goes to a
1797separate output, called @code{doc}. To install the main GLib output,
1798which contains everything but the documentation, one would run:
1799
1800@example
1801guix package -i glib
1802@end example
1803
1804The command to install its documentation is:
1805
1806@example
1807guix package -i glib:doc
1808@end example
1809
1810Some packages install programs with different ``dependency footprints''.
f97c9175 1811For instance, the WordNet package installs both command-line tools and
6e721c4d
LC
1812graphical user interfaces (GUIs). The former depend solely on the C
1813library, whereas the latter depend on Tcl/Tk and the underlying X
1814libraries. In this case, we leave the command-line tools in the default
1815output, whereas the GUIs are in a separate output. This allows users
fcc58db6
LC
1816who do not need the GUIs to save space. The @command{guix size} command
1817can help find out about such situations (@pxref{Invoking guix size}).
88856916 1818@command{guix graph} can also be helpful (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
6e721c4d
LC
1819
1820There are several such multiple-output packages in the GNU distribution.
91ef73d4
LC
1821Other conventional output names include @code{lib} for libraries and
1822possibly header files, @code{bin} for stand-alone programs, and
1823@code{debug} for debugging information (@pxref{Installing Debugging
1824Files}). The outputs of a packages are listed in the third column of
1825the output of @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking
1826guix package}).
6e721c4d 1827
eeaf4427 1828
e49951eb
MW
1829@node Invoking guix gc
1830@section Invoking @command{guix gc}
fe8ff028
LC
1831
1832@cindex garbage collector
f97c9175 1833Packages that are installed, but not used, may be @dfn{garbage-collected}.
e49951eb 1834The @command{guix gc} command allows users to explicitly run the garbage
c22eb992
LC
1835collector to reclaim space from the @file{/gnu/store} directory. It is
1836the @emph{only} way to remove files from @file{/gnu/store}---removing
1837files or directories manually may break it beyond repair!
fe8ff028
LC
1838
1839The garbage collector has a set of known @dfn{roots}: any file under
834129e0 1840@file{/gnu/store} reachable from a root is considered @dfn{live} and
fe8ff028
LC
1841cannot be deleted; any other file is considered @dfn{dead} and may be
1842deleted. The set of garbage collector roots includes default user
e49951eb
MW
1843profiles, and may be augmented with @command{guix build --root}, for
1844example (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
fe8ff028 1845
1bb9900a
LC
1846Prior to running @code{guix gc --collect-garbage} to make space, it is
1847often useful to remove old generations from user profiles; that way, old
1848package builds referenced by those generations can be reclaimed. This
1849is achieved by running @code{guix package --delete-generations}
1850(@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
1851
e49951eb 1852The @command{guix gc} command has three modes of operation: it can be
fe8ff028 1853used to garbage-collect any dead files (the default), to delete specific
7770aafc
LC
1854files (the @code{--delete} option), to print garbage-collector
1855information, or for more advanced queries. The garbage collection
1856options are as follows:
fe8ff028
LC
1857
1858@table @code
1859@item --collect-garbage[=@var{min}]
1860@itemx -C [@var{min}]
834129e0 1861Collect garbage---i.e., unreachable @file{/gnu/store} files and
fe8ff028
LC
1862sub-directories. This is the default operation when no option is
1863specified.
1864
1865When @var{min} is given, stop once @var{min} bytes have been collected.
1866@var{min} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
4a44d7bb
LC
1867suffix, such as @code{MiB} for mebibytes and @code{GB} for gigabytes
1868(@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
fe8ff028
LC
1869
1870When @var{min} is omitted, collect all the garbage.
1871
1872@item --delete
1873@itemx -d
1874Attempt to delete all the store files and directories specified as
1875arguments. This fails if some of the files are not in the store, or if
1876they are still live.
1877
30d9aa54
LC
1878@item --list-failures
1879List store items corresponding to cached build failures.
1880
1881This prints nothing unless the daemon was started with
1882@option{--cache-failures} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
1883@option{--cache-failures}}).
1884
1885@item --clear-failures
1886Remove the specified store items from the failed-build cache.
1887
1888Again, this option only makes sense when the daemon is started with
1889@option{--cache-failures}. Otherwise, it does nothing.
1890
fe8ff028
LC
1891@item --list-dead
1892Show the list of dead files and directories still present in the
1893store---i.e., files and directories no longer reachable from any root.
1894
1895@item --list-live
1896Show the list of live store files and directories.
ba8b732d
LC
1897
1898@end table
1899
1900In addition, the references among existing store files can be queried:
1901
1902@table @code
1903
1904@item --references
1905@itemx --referrers
1906List the references (respectively, the referrers) of store files given
1907as arguments.
1908
8e59fdd5
LC
1909@item --requisites
1910@itemx -R
fcc58db6 1911@cindex closure
8e59fdd5
LC
1912List the requisites of the store files passed as arguments. Requisites
1913include the store files themselves, their references, and the references
1914of these, recursively. In other words, the returned list is the
1915@dfn{transitive closure} of the store files.
1916
f97c9175
AE
1917@xref{Invoking guix size}, for a tool to profile the size of the closure
1918of an element. @xref{Invoking guix graph}, for a tool to visualize
88856916 1919the graph of references.
fcc58db6 1920
fe8ff028
LC
1921@end table
1922
7770aafc
LC
1923Lastly, the following options allow you to check the integrity of the
1924store and to control disk usage.
1925
1926@table @option
1927
1928@item --verify[=@var{options}]
1929@cindex integrity, of the store
1930@cindex integrity checking
1931Verify the integrity of the store.
1932
1933By default, make sure that all the store items marked as valid in the
f97c9175 1934database of the daemon actually exist in @file{/gnu/store}.
7770aafc 1935
f97c9175 1936When provided, @var{options} must be a comma-separated list containing one
7770aafc
LC
1937or more of @code{contents} and @code{repair}.
1938
f97c9175
AE
1939When passing @option{--verify=contents}, the daemon computse the
1940content hash of each store item and compares it against its hash in the
7770aafc
LC
1941database. Hash mismatches are reported as data corruptions. Because it
1942traverses @emph{all the files in the store}, this command can take a
1943long time, especially on systems with a slow disk drive.
1944
1945@cindex repairing the store
1946Using @option{--verify=repair} or @option{--verify=contents,repair}
1947causes the daemon to try to repair corrupt store items by fetching
1948substitutes for them (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because repairing is not
1949atomic, and thus potentially dangerous, it is available only to the
1950system administrator.
1951
1952@item --optimize
1953@cindex deduplication
1954Optimize the store by hard-linking identical files---this is
1955@dfn{deduplication}.
1956
1957The daemon performs deduplication after each successful build or archive
1958import, unless it was started with @code{--disable-deduplication}
1959(@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @code{--disable-deduplication}}). Thus,
1960this option is primarily useful when the daemon was running with
1961@code{--disable-deduplication}.
1962
1963@end table
eeaf4427 1964
f651b477
LC
1965@node Invoking guix pull
1966@section Invoking @command{guix pull}
1967
1968Packages are installed or upgraded to the latest version available in
1969the distribution currently available on your local machine. To update
1970that distribution, along with the Guix tools, you must run @command{guix
1971pull}: the command downloads the latest Guix source code and package
1972descriptions, and deploys it.
1973
1974On completion, @command{guix package} will use packages and package
1975versions from this just-retrieved copy of Guix. Not only that, but all
1976the Guix commands and Scheme modules will also be taken from that latest
1977version. New @command{guix} sub-commands added by the update also
ef54b61d
AV
1978become available@footnote{Under the hood, @command{guix pull} updates
1979the @file{~/.config/guix/latest} symbolic link to point to the latest
1980Guix, and the @command{guix} command loads code from there.}.
f651b477
LC
1981
1982The @command{guix pull} command is usually invoked with no arguments,
1983but it supports the following options:
1984
1985@table @code
1986@item --verbose
1987Produce verbose output, writing build logs to the standard error output.
1988
ab5d72ad
LC
1989@item --url=@var{url}
1990Download the source tarball of Guix from @var{url}.
1991
1992By default, the tarball is taken from its canonical address at
1993@code{gnu.org}, for the stable branch of Guix.
1994
f651b477
LC
1995@item --bootstrap
1996Use the bootstrap Guile to build the latest Guix. This option is only
1997useful to Guix developers.
1998@end table
1999
760c60d6
LC
2000
2001@node Invoking guix archive
2002@section Invoking @command{guix archive}
2003
2004The @command{guix archive} command allows users to @dfn{export} files
2005from the store into a single archive, and to later @dfn{import} them.
2006In particular, it allows store files to be transferred from one machine
f97c9175 2007to the store on another machine. For example, to transfer the @code{emacs}
760c60d6
LC
2008package to a machine connected over SSH, one would run:
2009
2010@example
56607088 2011guix archive --export -r emacs | ssh the-machine guix archive --import
760c60d6
LC
2012@end example
2013
87236aed 2014@noindent
56607088
LC
2015Similarly, a complete user profile may be transferred from one machine
2016to another like this:
2017
2018@example
2019guix archive --export -r $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | \
2020 ssh the-machine guix-archive --import
2021@end example
2022
2023@noindent
2024However, note that, in both examples, all of @code{emacs} and the
2025profile as well as all of their dependencies are transferred (due to
f97c9175
AE
2026@code{-r}), regardless of what is already available in the store on the
2027target machine. The @code{--missing} option can help figure out which
2028items are missing from the target store.
87236aed 2029
760c60d6 2030Archives are stored in the ``Nix archive'' or ``Nar'' format, which is
0dbd88db
LC
2031comparable in spirit to `tar', but with a few noteworthy differences
2032that make it more appropriate for our purposes. First, rather than
f97c9175 2033recording all Unix metadata for each file, the Nar format only mentions
0dbd88db
LC
2034the file type (regular, directory, or symbolic link); Unix permissions
2035and owner/group are dismissed. Second, the order in which directory
2036entries are stored always follows the order of file names according to
2037the C locale collation order. This makes archive production fully
2038deterministic.
2039
2040When exporting, the daemon digitally signs the contents of the archive,
2041and that digital signature is appended. When importing, the daemon
2042verifies the signature and rejects the import in case of an invalid
2043signature or if the signing key is not authorized.
760c60d6
LC
2044@c FIXME: Add xref to daemon doc about signatures.
2045
2046The main options are:
2047
2048@table @code
2049@item --export
2050Export the specified store files or packages (see below.) Write the
2051resulting archive to the standard output.
2052
56607088
LC
2053Dependencies are @emph{not} included in the output, unless
2054@code{--recursive} is passed.
2055
2056@item -r
2057@itemx --recursive
2058When combined with @code{--export}, this instructs @command{guix
2059archive} to include dependencies of the given items in the archive.
2060Thus, the resulting archive is self-contained: it contains the closure
2061of the exported store items.
2062
760c60d6
LC
2063@item --import
2064Read an archive from the standard input, and import the files listed
2065therein into the store. Abort if the archive has an invalid digital
f82cc5fd
LC
2066signature, or if it is signed by a public key not among the authorized
2067keys (see @code{--authorize} below.)
554f26ec 2068
87236aed
LC
2069@item --missing
2070Read a list of store file names from the standard input, one per line,
2071and write on the standard output the subset of these files missing from
2072the store.
2073
554f26ec 2074@item --generate-key[=@var{parameters}]
f82cc5fd 2075@cindex signing, archives
f97c9175 2076Generate a new key pair for the daemon. This is a prerequisite before
554f26ec
LC
2077archives can be exported with @code{--export}. Note that this operation
2078usually takes time, because it needs to gather enough entropy to
2079generate the key pair.
2080
2081The generated key pair is typically stored under @file{/etc/guix}, in
2082@file{signing-key.pub} (public key) and @file{signing-key.sec} (private
867d8473
LC
2083key, which must be kept secret.) When @var{parameters} is omitted,
2084an ECDSA key using the Ed25519 curve is generated, or, for Libgcrypt
2085versions before 1.6.0, it is a 4096-bit RSA key.
f97c9175 2086Alternatively, @var{parameters} can specify
554f26ec
LC
2087@code{genkey} parameters suitable for Libgcrypt (@pxref{General
2088public-key related Functions, @code{gcry_pk_genkey},, gcrypt, The
2089Libgcrypt Reference Manual}).
f82cc5fd
LC
2090
2091@item --authorize
2092@cindex authorizing, archives
2093Authorize imports signed by the public key passed on standard input.
2094The public key must be in ``s-expression advanced format''---i.e., the
2095same format as the @file{signing-key.pub} file.
2096
2097The list of authorized keys is kept in the human-editable file
2098@file{/etc/guix/acl}. The file contains
2099@url{http://people.csail.mit.edu/rivest/Sexp.txt, ``advanced-format
2100s-expressions''} and is structured as an access-control list in the
2101@url{http://theworld.com/~cme/spki.txt, Simple Public-Key Infrastructure
2102(SPKI)}.
c6f8e9dd
LC
2103
2104@item --extract=@var{directory}
2105@itemx -x @var{directory}
2106Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
2107(@pxref{Substitutes}) and extract it to @var{directory}. This is a
2108low-level operation needed in only very narrow use cases; see below.
2109
2110For example, the following command extracts the substitute for Emacs
2111served by @code{hydra.gnu.org} to @file{/tmp/emacs}:
2112
2113@example
2114$ wget -O - \
2115 http://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-emacs-24.5 \
2116 | bunzip2 | guix archive -x /tmp/emacs
2117@end example
2118
2119Single-item archives are different from multiple-item archives produced
2120by @command{guix archive --export}; they contain a single store item,
2121and they do @emph{not} embed a signature. Thus this operation does
2122@emph{no} signature verification and its output should be considered
2123unsafe.
2124
2125The primary purpose of this operation is to facilitate inspection of
2126archive contents coming from possibly untrusted substitute servers.
2127
760c60d6
LC
2128@end table
2129
f97c9175 2130To export store files as an archive to standard output, run:
760c60d6
LC
2131
2132@example
2133guix archive --export @var{options} @var{specifications}...
2134@end example
2135
2136@var{specifications} may be either store file names or package
2137specifications, as for @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix
2138package}). For instance, the following command creates an archive
2139containing the @code{gui} output of the @code{git} package and the main
2140output of @code{emacs}:
2141
2142@example
834129e0 2143guix archive --export git:gui /gnu/store/...-emacs-24.3 > great.nar
760c60d6
LC
2144@end example
2145
2146If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix archive}
2147automatically builds them. The build process may be controlled with the
ccd7158d 2148common build options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
760c60d6 2149
c554de89
AK
2150@c *********************************************************************
2151@include emacs.texi
760c60d6 2152
568717fd
LC
2153@c *********************************************************************
2154@node Programming Interface
2155@chapter Programming Interface
2156
3dc1970d
LC
2157GNU Guix provides several Scheme programming interfaces (APIs) to
2158define, build, and query packages. The first interface allows users to
2159write high-level package definitions. These definitions refer to
2160familiar packaging concepts, such as the name and version of a package,
2161its build system, and its dependencies. These definitions can then be
2162turned into concrete build actions.
2163
ba55b1cb 2164Build actions are performed by the Guix daemon, on behalf of users. In a
3dc1970d 2165standard setup, the daemon has write access to the store---the
834129e0 2166@file{/gnu/store} directory---whereas users do not. The recommended
3dc1970d
LC
2167setup also has the daemon perform builds in chroots, under a specific
2168build users, to minimize interference with the rest of the system.
2169
2170@cindex derivation
2171Lower-level APIs are available to interact with the daemon and the
2172store. To instruct the daemon to perform a build action, users actually
2173provide it with a @dfn{derivation}. A derivation is a low-level
2174representation of the build actions to be taken, and the environment in
2175which they should occur---derivations are to package definitions what
49ad317a
LC
2176assembly is to C programs. The term ``derivation'' comes from the fact
2177that build results @emph{derive} from them.
3dc1970d
LC
2178
2179This chapter describes all these APIs in turn, starting from high-level
2180package definitions.
2181
568717fd 2182@menu
b860f382 2183* Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
7458bd0a 2184* Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
b860f382
LC
2185* The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
2186* Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
2187* The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
21b679f6 2188* G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
568717fd
LC
2189@end menu
2190
2191@node Defining Packages
2192@section Defining Packages
2193
3dc1970d
LC
2194The high-level interface to package definitions is implemented in the
2195@code{(guix packages)} and @code{(guix build-system)} modules. As an
2196example, the package definition, or @dfn{recipe}, for the GNU Hello
2197package looks like this:
2198
2199@example
e7f34eb0
LC
2200(define-module (gnu packages hello)
2201 #:use-module (guix packages)
2202 #:use-module (guix download)
2203 #:use-module (guix build-system gnu)
a6dcdcac
SB
2204 #:use-module (guix licenses)
2205 #:use-module (gnu packages gawk))
b22a12fd 2206
79f5dd59 2207(define-public hello
3dc1970d
LC
2208 (package
2209 (name "hello")
17d8e33f 2210 (version "2.10")
3dc1970d 2211 (source (origin
17d8e33f
ML
2212 (method url-fetch)
2213 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
2214 ".tar.gz"))
2215 (sha256
2216 (base32
2217 "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"))))
3dc1970d 2218 (build-system gnu-build-system)
7458bd0a 2219 (arguments `(#:configure-flags '("--enable-silent-rules")))
3dc1970d 2220 (inputs `(("gawk" ,gawk)))
7458bd0a
LC
2221 (synopsis "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package")
2222 (description "Guess what GNU Hello prints!")
3dc1970d 2223 (home-page "http://www.gnu.org/software/hello/")
b22a12fd 2224 (license gpl3+)))
3dc1970d
LC
2225@end example
2226
2227@noindent
2228Without being a Scheme expert, the reader may have guessed the meaning
f97c9175
AE
2229of the various fields here. This expression binds the variable
2230@code{hello} to a @code{<package>} object, which is essentially a record
3dc1970d
LC
2231(@pxref{SRFI-9, Scheme records,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
2232This package object can be inspected using procedures found in the
2233@code{(guix packages)} module; for instance, @code{(package-name hello)}
2234returns---surprise!---@code{"hello"}.
2235
2f7d2d91
LC
2236With luck, you may be able to import part or all of the definition of
2237the package you are interested in from another repository, using the
2238@code{guix import} command (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
2239
f97c9175 2240In the example above, @var{hello} is defined in a module of its own,
e7f34eb0
LC
2241@code{(gnu packages hello)}. Technically, this is not strictly
2242necessary, but it is convenient to do so: all the packages defined in
2243modules under @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} are automatically known to
2244the command-line tools (@pxref{Package Modules}).
2245
3dc1970d
LC
2246There are a few points worth noting in the above package definition:
2247
2248@itemize
2249@item
a2bf4907
LC
2250The @code{source} field of the package is an @code{<origin>} object
2251(@pxref{origin Reference}, for the complete reference).
3dc1970d
LC
2252Here, the @code{url-fetch} method from @code{(guix download)} is used,
2253meaning that the source is a file to be downloaded over FTP or HTTP.
2254
2255The @code{mirror://gnu} prefix instructs @code{url-fetch} to use one of
2256the GNU mirrors defined in @code{(guix download)}.
2257
2258The @code{sha256} field specifies the expected SHA256 hash of the file
2259being downloaded. It is mandatory, and allows Guix to check the
2260integrity of the file. The @code{(base32 @dots{})} form introduces the
6c365eca 2261base32 representation of the hash. You can obtain this information with
210cc920
LC
2262@code{guix download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) and @code{guix
2263hash} (@pxref{Invoking guix hash}).
3dc1970d 2264
f9cc8971
LC
2265@cindex patches
2266When needed, the @code{origin} form can also have a @code{patches} field
2267listing patches to be applied, and a @code{snippet} field giving a
2268Scheme expression to modify the source code.
2269
3dc1970d
LC
2270@item
2271@cindex GNU Build System
7458bd0a
LC
2272The @code{build-system} field specifies the procedure to build the
2273package (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here, @var{gnu-build-system}
2274represents the familiar GNU Build System, where packages may be
2275configured, built, and installed with the usual @code{./configure &&
2276make && make check && make install} command sequence.
2277
2278@item
2279The @code{arguments} field specifies options for the build system
2280(@pxref{Build Systems}). Here it is interpreted by
2281@var{gnu-build-system} as a request run @file{configure} with the
2282@code{--enable-silent-rules} flag.
3dc1970d
LC
2283
2284@item
2285The @code{inputs} field specifies inputs to the build process---i.e.,
2286build-time or run-time dependencies of the package. Here, we define an
2287input called @code{"gawk"} whose value is that of the @var{gawk}
2288variable; @var{gawk} is itself bound to a @code{<package>} object.
2289
2290Note that GCC, Coreutils, Bash, and other essential tools do not need to
2291be specified as inputs here. Instead, @var{gnu-build-system} takes care
7458bd0a 2292of ensuring that they are present (@pxref{Build Systems}).
3dc1970d
LC
2293
2294However, any other dependencies need to be specified in the
2295@code{inputs} field. Any dependency not specified here will simply be
2296unavailable to the build process, possibly leading to a build failure.
2297@end itemize
2298
87eafdbd
TUBK
2299@xref{package Reference}, for a full description of possible fields.
2300
2f7d2d91 2301Once a package definition is in place, the
e49951eb 2302package may actually be built using the @code{guix build} command-line
39bee8a2
LC
2303tool (@pxref{Invoking guix build}). You can easily jump back to the
2304package definition using the @command{guix edit} command
2305(@pxref{Invoking guix edit}).
2306@xref{Packaging Guidelines}, for
b4f5e0e8
CR
2307more information on how to test package definitions, and
2308@ref{Invoking guix lint}, for information on how to check a definition
2309for style conformance.
2310
f97c9175 2311Finally, updating the package definition to a new upstream version
7458bd0a
LC
2312can be partly automated by the @command{guix refresh} command
2313(@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
3dc1970d
LC
2314
2315Behind the scenes, a derivation corresponding to the @code{<package>}
2316object is first computed by the @code{package-derivation} procedure.
834129e0 2317That derivation is stored in a @code{.drv} file under @file{/gnu/store}.
ba55b1cb 2318The build actions it prescribes may then be realized by using the
3dc1970d
LC
2319@code{build-derivations} procedure (@pxref{The Store}).
2320
2321@deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-derivation @var{store} @var{package} [@var{system}]
59688fc4
LC
2322Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} for @var{system}
2323(@pxref{Derivations}).
3dc1970d
LC
2324
2325@var{package} must be a valid @code{<package>} object, and @var{system}
2326must be a string denoting the target system type---e.g.,
2327@code{"x86_64-linux"} for an x86_64 Linux-based GNU system. @var{store}
2328must be a connection to the daemon, which operates on the store
2329(@pxref{The Store}).
2330@end deffn
568717fd 2331
9c1edabd
LC
2332@noindent
2333@cindex cross-compilation
2334Similarly, it is possible to compute a derivation that cross-builds a
2335package for some other system:
2336
2337@deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-cross-derivation @var{store} @
2338 @var{package} @var{target} [@var{system}]
59688fc4
LC
2339Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} cross-built from
2340@var{system} to @var{target}.
9c1edabd
LC
2341
2342@var{target} must be a valid GNU triplet denoting the target hardware
2343and operating system, such as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"}
2344(@pxref{Configuration Names, GNU configuration triplets,, configure, GNU
2345Configure and Build System}).
2346@end deffn
2347
87eafdbd
TUBK
2348@menu
2349* package Reference :: The package data type.
2350* origin Reference:: The origin data type.
2351@end menu
2352
2353
2354@node package Reference
2355@subsection @code{package} Reference
2356
2357This section summarizes all the options available in @code{package}
2358declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
2359
2360@deftp {Data Type} package
2361This is the data type representing a package recipe.
2362
2363@table @asis
2364@item @code{name}
2365The name of the package, as a string.
2366
2367@item @code{version}
2368The version of the package, as a string.
2369
2370@item @code{source}
2371An origin object telling how the source code for the package should be
2372acquired (@pxref{origin Reference}).
2373
2374@item @code{build-system}
2375The build system that should be used to build the package (@pxref{Build
2376Systems}).
2377
2378@item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
2379The arguments that should be passed to the build system. This is a
2380list, typically containing sequential keyword-value pairs.
2381
2382@item @code{inputs} (default: @code{'()})
70650c68
LC
2383@itemx @code{native-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
2384@itemx @code{propagated-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
2385@cindex inputs, of packages
2386These fields list dependencies of the package. Each one is a list of
2387tuples, where each tuple has a label for the input (a string) as its
2388first element, a package, origin, or derivation as its second element,
2389and optionally the name of the output thereof that should be used, which
2390defaults to @code{"out"} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}, for
f97c9175 2391more on package outputs). For example, the list below specifies three
70650c68 2392inputs:
87eafdbd 2393
70650c68
LC
2394@example
2395`(("libffi" ,libffi)
2396 ("libunistring" ,libunistring)
2397 ("glib:bin" ,glib "bin")) ;the "bin" output of Glib
2398@end example
2399
2400@cindex cross compilation, package dependencies
2401The distinction between @code{native-inputs} and @code{inputs} is
2402necessary when considering cross-compilation. When cross-compiling,
2403dependencies listed in @code{inputs} are built for the @emph{target}
2404architecture; conversely, dependencies listed in @code{native-inputs}
2405are built for the architecture of the @emph{build} machine.
2406
f97c9175
AE
2407@code{native-inputs} is typically used to list tools needed at
2408build time, but not at run time, such as Autoconf, Automake, pkg-config,
70650c68
LC
2409Gettext, or Bison. @command{guix lint} can report likely mistakes in
2410this area (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}).
2411
2412@anchor{package-propagated-inputs}
2413Lastly, @code{propagated-inputs} is similar to @code{inputs}, but the
f97c9175
AE
2414specified packages will be automatically installed alongside the package
2415they belong to (@pxref{package-cmd-propagated-inputs, @command{guix
70650c68
LC
2416package}}, for information on how @command{guix package} deals with
2417propagated inputs.)
21461f27 2418
e0508b6b
LC
2419For example this is necessary when a C/C++ library needs headers of
2420another library to compile, or when a pkg-config file refers to another
2421one @i{via} its @code{Requires} field.
2422
f97c9175
AE
2423Another example where @code{propagated-inputs} is useful is for languages
2424that lack a facility to record the run-time search path akin to the
2425@code{RUNPATH}of ELF files; this includes Guile, Python, Perl, GHC, and
e0508b6b
LC
2426more. To ensure that libraries written in those languages can find
2427library code they depend on at run time, run-time dependencies must be
2428listed in @code{propagated-inputs} rather than @code{inputs}.
87eafdbd 2429
87eafdbd
TUBK
2430@item @code{self-native-input?} (default: @code{#f})
2431This is a Boolean field telling whether the package should use itself as
2432a native input when cross-compiling.
2433
2434@item @code{outputs} (default: @code{'("out")})
2435The list of output names of the package. @xref{Packages with Multiple
2436Outputs}, for typical uses of additional outputs.
2437
2438@item @code{native-search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
2439@itemx @code{search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
2440A list of @code{search-path-specification} objects describing
2441search-path environment variables honored by the package.
2442
2443@item @code{replacement} (default: @code{#f})
f97c9175 2444This must be either @code{#f} or a package object that will be used as a
87eafdbd
TUBK
2445@dfn{replacement} for this package. @xref{Security Updates, grafts},
2446for details.
2447
2448@item @code{synopsis}
2449A one-line description of the package.
2450
2451@item @code{description}
2452A more elaborate description of the package.
2453
2454@item @code{license}
f97c9175
AE
2455The license of the package; a value from @code{(guix licenses)},
2456or a list of such values.
87eafdbd
TUBK
2457
2458@item @code{home-page}
2459The URL to the home-page of the package, as a string.
2460
2461@item @code{supported-systems} (default: @var{%supported-systems})
2462The list of systems supported by the package, as strings of the form
2463@code{architecture-kernel}, for example @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
2464
2465@item @code{maintainers} (default: @code{'()})
2466The list of maintainers of the package, as @code{maintainer} objects.
2467
2468@item @code{location} (default: source location of the @code{package} form)
f97c9175 2469The source location of the package. It is useful to override this when
87eafdbd
TUBK
2470inheriting from another package, in which case this field is not
2471automatically corrected.
2472@end table
2473@end deftp
2474
2475
2476@node origin Reference
2477@subsection @code{origin} Reference
2478
2479This section summarizes all the options available in @code{origin}
2480declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
2481
2482@deftp {Data Type} origin
2483This is the data type representing a source code origin.
2484
2485@table @asis
2486@item @code{uri}
2487An object containing the URI of the source. The object type depends on
2488the @code{method} (see below). For example, when using the
2489@var{url-fetch} method of @code{(guix download)}, the valid @code{uri}
2490values are: a URL represented as a string, or a list thereof.
2491
2492@item @code{method}
f97c9175 2493A procedure that handles the URI.
87eafdbd
TUBK
2494
2495Examples include:
2496
2497@table @asis
2498@item @var{url-fetch} from @code{(guix download)}
f97c9175 2499download a file from the HTTP, HTTPS, or FTP URL specified in the
87eafdbd
TUBK
2500@code{uri} field;
2501
2502@item @var{git-fetch} from @code{(guix git-download)}
2503clone the Git version control repository, and check out the revision
2504specified in the @code{uri} field as a @code{git-reference} object; a
2505@code{git-reference} looks like this:
2506
2507@example
2508(git-reference
2509 (url "git://git.debian.org/git/pkg-shadow/shadow")
2510 (commit "v4.1.5.1"))
2511@end example
2512@end table
2513
2514@item @code{sha256}
2515A bytevector containing the SHA-256 hash of the source. Typically the
2516@code{base32} form is used here to generate the bytevector from a
2517base-32 string.
2518
2519@item @code{file-name} (default: @code{#f})
2520The file name under which the source code should be saved. When this is
2521@code{#f}, a sensible default value will be used in most cases. In case
2522the source is fetched from a URL, the file name from the URL will be
f97c9175 2523used. For version control checkouts, it is recommended to provide the
87eafdbd
TUBK
2524file name explicitly because the default is not very descriptive.
2525
2526@item @code{patches} (default: @code{'()})
2527A list of file names containing patches to be applied to the source.
2528
2529@item @code{snippet} (default: @code{#f})
2530A quoted piece of code that will be run in the source directory to make
2531any modifications, which is sometimes more convenient than a patch.
2532
2533@item @code{patch-flags} (default: @code{'("-p1")})
2534A list of command-line flags that should be passed to the @code{patch}
2535command.
2536
2537@item @code{patch-inputs} (default: @code{#f})
2538Input packages or derivations to the patching process. When this is
2539@code{#f}, the usual set of inputs necessary for patching are provided,
2540such as GNU@tie{}Patch.
2541
2542@item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
2543A list of Guile modules that should be loaded during the patching
2544process and while running the code in the @code{snippet} field.
2545
2546@item @code{imported-modules} (default: @code{'()})
2547The list of Guile modules to import in the patch derivation, for use by
2548the @code{snippet}.
2549
2550@item @code{patch-guile} (default: @code{#f})
2551The Guile package that should be used in the patching process. When
2552this is @code{#f}, a sensible default is used.
2553@end table
2554@end deftp
2555
9c1edabd 2556
7458bd0a
LC
2557@node Build Systems
2558@section Build Systems
2559
2560@cindex build system
2561Each package definition specifies a @dfn{build system} and arguments for
2562that build system (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This @code{build-system}
f97c9175 2563field represents the build procedure of the package, as well as implicit
7458bd0a
LC
2564dependencies of that build procedure.
2565
2566Build systems are @code{<build-system>} objects. The interface to
2567create and manipulate them is provided by the @code{(guix build-system)}
2568module, and actual build systems are exported by specific modules.
2569
f5fd4fd2 2570@cindex bag (low-level package representation)
0d5a559f
LC
2571Under the hood, build systems first compile package objects to
2572@dfn{bags}. A @dfn{bag} is like a package, but with less
2573ornamentation---in other words, a bag is a lower-level representation of
2574a package, which includes all the inputs of that package, including some
2575that were implicitly added by the build system. This intermediate
2576representation is then compiled to a derivation (@pxref{Derivations}).
2577
7458bd0a
LC
2578Build systems accept an optional list of @dfn{arguments}. In package
2579definitions, these are passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field
2580(@pxref{Defining Packages}). They are typically keyword arguments
2581(@pxref{Optional Arguments, keyword arguments in Guile,, guile, GNU
2582Guile Reference Manual}). The value of these arguments is usually
2583evaluated in the @dfn{build stratum}---i.e., by a Guile process launched
2584by the daemon (@pxref{Derivations}).
2585
2586The main build system is @var{gnu-build-system}, which implements the
f97c9175 2587standard build procedure for GNU and many other packages. It
7458bd0a
LC
2588is provided by the @code{(guix build-system gnu)} module.
2589
2590@defvr {Scheme Variable} gnu-build-system
2591@var{gnu-build-system} represents the GNU Build System, and variants
2592thereof (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile conventions,,
2593standards, GNU Coding Standards}).
2594
2595@cindex build phases
f97c9175 2596In a nutshell, packages using it are configured, built, and installed with
7458bd0a
LC
2597the usual @code{./configure && make && make check && make install}
2598command sequence. In practice, a few additional steps are often needed.
2599All these steps are split up in separate @dfn{phases},
2600notably@footnote{Please see the @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)}
2601modules for more details about the build phases.}:
2602
2603@table @code
2604@item unpack
2605Unpack the source tarball, and change the current directory to the
2606extracted source tree. If the source is actually a directory, copy it
2607to the build tree, and enter that directory.
2608
2609@item patch-source-shebangs
2610Patch shebangs encountered in source files so they refer to the right
2611store file names. For instance, this changes @code{#!/bin/sh} to
2612@code{#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3/bin/sh}.
2613
2614@item configure
2615Run the @file{configure} script with a number of default options, such
2616as @code{--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, as well as the options specified
2617by the @code{#:configure-flags} argument.
2618
2619@item build
2620Run @code{make} with the list of flags specified with
0917e80e 2621@code{#:make-flags}. If the @code{#:parallel-build?} argument is true
7458bd0a
LC
2622(the default), build with @code{make -j}.
2623
2624@item check
2625Run @code{make check}, or some other target specified with
2626@code{#:test-target}, unless @code{#:tests? #f} is passed. If the
2627@code{#:parallel-tests?} argument is true (the default), run @code{make
2628check -j}.
2629
2630@item install
2631Run @code{make install} with the flags listed in @code{#:make-flags}.
2632
2633@item patch-shebangs
2634Patch shebangs on the installed executable files.
2635
2636@item strip
2637Strip debugging symbols from ELF files (unless @code{#:strip-binaries?}
2638is false), copying them to the @code{debug} output when available
2639(@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
2640@end table
2641
2642@vindex %standard-phases
2643The build-side module @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
2644@var{%standard-phases} as the default list of build phases.
2645@var{%standard-phases} is a list of symbol/procedure pairs, where the
2646procedure implements the actual phase.
2647
2648The list of phases used for a particular package can be changed with the
2649@code{#:phases} parameter. For instance, passing:
2650
2651@example
2652#:phases (alist-delete 'configure %standard-phases)
2653@end example
2654
9bf404e9 2655means that all the phases described above will be used, except the
7458bd0a
LC
2656@code{configure} phase.
2657
2658In addition, this build system ensures that the ``standard'' environment
2659for GNU packages is available. This includes tools such as GCC, libc,
2660Coreutils, Bash, Make, Diffutils, grep, and sed (see the @code{(guix
f97c9175
AE
2661build-system gnu)} module for a complete list). We call these the
2662@dfn{implicit inputs} of a package, because package definitions do not
7458bd0a
LC
2663have to mention them.
2664@end defvr
2665
2666Other @code{<build-system>} objects are defined to support other
2667conventions and tools used by free software packages. They inherit most
2668of @var{gnu-build-system}, and differ mainly in the set of inputs
2669implicitly added to the build process, and in the list of phases
2670executed. Some of these build systems are listed below.
2671
2672@defvr {Scheme Variable} cmake-build-system
2673This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cmake)}. It
2674implements the build procedure for packages using the
2675@url{http://www.cmake.org, CMake build tool}.
2676
2677It automatically adds the @code{cmake} package to the set of inputs.
2678Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:cmake}
2679parameter.
9849cfc1
LC
2680
2681The @code{#:configure-flags} parameter is taken as a list of flags
2682passed to the @command{cmake} command. The @code{#:build-type}
2683parameter specifies in abstract terms the flags passed to the compiler;
2684it defaults to @code{"RelWithDebInfo"} (short for ``release mode with
2685debugging information''), which roughly means that code is compiled with
2686@code{-O2 -g}, as is the case for Autoconf-based packages by default.
7458bd0a
LC
2687@end defvr
2688
3afcf52b
FB
2689@defvr {Scheme Variable} glib-or-gtk-build-system
2690This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system glib-or-gtk)}. It
2691is intended for use with packages making use of GLib or GTK+.
2692
2693This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
2694@var{gnu-build-system}:
2695
2696@table @code
2697@item glib-or-gtk-wrap
f97c9175
AE
2698The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-wrap} ensures that programs in
2699@file{bin/} are able to find GLib ``schemas'' and
3afcf52b
FB
2700@uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gtk3/stable/gtk-running.html, GTK+
2701modules}. This is achieved by wrapping the programs in launch scripts
2702that appropriately set the @code{XDG_DATA_DIRS} and @code{GTK_PATH}
2703environment variables.
2704
73aa8ddb
LC
2705It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping
2706process by listing their names in the
2707@code{#:glib-or-gtk-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter. This is useful
2708when an output is known not to contain any GLib or GTK+ binaries, and
2709where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on
2710GLib and GTK+.
2711
3afcf52b 2712@item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
f97c9175 2713The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas} makes sure that all
3afcf52b 2714@uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gio/stable/glib-compile-schemas.html,
f97c9175 2715GSettings schemas} of GLib are compiled. Compilation is performed by the
3afcf52b
FB
2716@command{glib-compile-schemas} program. It is provided by the package
2717@code{glib:bin} which is automatically imported by the build system.
2718The @code{glib} package providing @command{glib-compile-schemas} can be
2719specified with the @code{#:glib} parameter.
2720@end table
2721
2722Both phases are executed after the @code{install} phase.
2723@end defvr
2724
7458bd0a
LC
2725@defvr {Scheme Variable} python-build-system
2726This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system python)}. It
2727implements the more or less standard build procedure used by Python
2728packages, which consists in running @code{python setup.py build} and
2729then @code{python setup.py install --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}.
2730
2731For packages that install stand-alone Python programs under @code{bin/},
f97c9175 2732it takes care of wrapping these programs so that their @code{PYTHONPATH}
7458bd0a
LC
2733environment variable points to all the Python libraries they depend on.
2734
2735Which Python package is used can be specified with the @code{#:python}
2736parameter.
2737@end defvr
2738
2739@defvr {Scheme Variable} perl-build-system
2740This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system perl)}. It
2d2a53fc
EB
2741implements the standard build procedure for Perl packages, which either
2742consists in running @code{perl Build.PL --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}},
2743followed by @code{Build} and @code{Build install}; or in running
2744@code{perl Makefile.PL PREFIX=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, followed by
f97c9175 2745@code{make} and @code{make install}, depending on which of
2d2a53fc
EB
2746@code{Build.PL} or @code{Makefile.PL} is present in the package
2747distribution. Preference is given to the former if both @code{Build.PL}
2748and @code{Makefile.PL} exist in the package distribution. This
2749preference can be reversed by specifying @code{#t} for the
2750@code{#:make-maker?} parameter.
2751
2752The initial @code{perl Makefile.PL} or @code{perl Build.PL} invocation
2753passes flags specified by the @code{#:make-maker-flags} or
2754@code{#:module-build-flags} parameter, respectively.
7458bd0a
LC
2755
2756Which Perl package is used can be specified with @code{#:perl}.
2757@end defvr
2758
f8f3bef6
RW
2759@defvr {Scheme Variable} r-build-system
2760This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system r)}. It
2761implements the build procedure used by @uref{http://r-project.org, R}
2762packages, which essentially is little more than running @code{R CMD
2763INSTALL --library=/gnu/store/@dots{}} in an environment where
2764@code{R_LIBS_SITE} contains the paths to all R package inputs. Tests
2765are run after installation using the R function
2766@code{tools::testInstalledPackage}.
2767@end defvr
2768
c08f9818
DT
2769@defvr {Scheme Variable} ruby-build-system
2770This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ruby)}. It
2771implements the RubyGems build procedure used by Ruby packages, which
2772involves running @code{gem build} followed by @code{gem install}.
2773
5dc87623
DT
2774The @code{source} field of a package that uses this build system
2775typically references a gem archive, since this is the format that Ruby
2776developers use when releasing their software. The build system unpacks
2777the gem archive, potentially patches the source, runs the test suite,
2778repackages the gem, and installs it. Additionally, directories and
2779tarballs may be referenced to allow building unreleased gems from Git or
2780a traditional source release tarball.
e83c6d00 2781
c08f9818 2782Which Ruby package is used can be specified with the @code{#:ruby}
6e9f2913
PP
2783parameter. A list of additional flags to be passed to the @command{gem}
2784command can be specified with the @code{#:gem-flags} parameter.
c08f9818 2785@end defvr
7458bd0a 2786
a677c726
RW
2787@defvr {Scheme Variable} waf-build-system
2788This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system waf)}. It
2789implements a build procedure around the @code{waf} script. The common
2790phases---@code{configure}, @code{build}, and @code{install}---are
2791implemented by passing their names as arguments to the @code{waf}
2792script.
2793
2794The @code{waf} script is executed by the Python interpreter. Which
2795Python package is used to run the script can be specified with the
2796@code{#:python} parameter.
2797@end defvr
2798
14dfdf2e
FB
2799@defvr {Scheme Variable} haskell-build-system
2800This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system haskell)}. It
2801implements the Cabal build procedure used by Haskell packages, which
2802involves running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs configure
2803--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}} and @code{runhaskell Setup.hs build}.
2804Instead of installing the package by running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs
2805install}, to avoid trying to register libraries in the read-only
2806compiler store directory, the build system uses @code{runhaskell
2807Setup.hs copy}, followed by @code{runhaskell Setup.hs register}. In
2808addition, the build system generates the package documentation by
2809running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs haddock}, unless @code{#:haddock? #f}
2810is passed. Optional Haddock parameters can be passed with the help of
2811the @code{#:haddock-flags} parameter. If the file @code{Setup.hs} is
2812not found, the build system looks for @code{Setup.lhs} instead.
2813
2814Which Haskell compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:haskell}
a54bd6d7 2815parameter which defaults to @code{ghc}.
14dfdf2e
FB
2816@end defvr
2817
e9137a53
FB
2818@defvr {Scheme Variable} emacs-build-system
2819This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system emacs)}. It
f97c9175
AE
2820implements an installation procedure similar to the packaging system
2821of Emacs itself (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
e9137a53
FB
2822
2823It first creates the @code{@var{package}-autoloads.el} file, then it
2824byte compiles all Emacs Lisp files. Differently from the Emacs
2825packaging system, the Info documentation files are moved to the standard
2826documentation directory and the @file{dir} file is deleted. Each
2827package is installed in its own directory under
2828@file{share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d}.
2829@end defvr
2830
7458bd0a
LC
2831Lastly, for packages that do not need anything as sophisticated, a
2832``trivial'' build system is provided. It is trivial in the sense that
2833it provides basically no support: it does not pull any implicit inputs,
2834and does not have a notion of build phases.
2835
2836@defvr {Scheme Variable} trivial-build-system
2837This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system trivial)}.
2838
2839This build system requires a @code{#:builder} argument. This argument
f97c9175 2840must be a Scheme expression that builds the package output(s)---as
7458bd0a
LC
2841with @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations,
2842@code{build-expression->derivation}}).
2843@end defvr
2844
568717fd
LC
2845@node The Store
2846@section The Store
2847
e531ac2a
LC
2848@cindex store
2849@cindex store paths
2850
f97c9175
AE
2851Conceptually, the @dfn{store} is the place where derivations that have
2852been built successfully are stored---by default, @file{/gnu/store}.
e531ac2a 2853Sub-directories in the store are referred to as @dfn{store paths}. The
4988dd40 2854store has an associated database that contains information such as the
e531ac2a
LC
2855store paths referred to by each store path, and the list of @emph{valid}
2856store paths---paths that result from a successful build.
2857
2858The store is always accessed by the daemon on behalf of its clients
2859(@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). To manipulate the store, clients
f97c9175
AE
2860connect to the daemon over a Unix-domain socket, send requests to it,
2861and read the result---these are remote procedure calls, or RPCs.
e531ac2a
LC
2862
2863The @code{(guix store)} module provides procedures to connect to the
2864daemon, and to perform RPCs. These are described below.
2865
2866@deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-connection [@var{file}] [#:reserve-space? #t]
2867Connect to the daemon over the Unix-domain socket at @var{file}. When
2868@var{reserve-space?} is true, instruct it to reserve a little bit of
2869extra space on the file system so that the garbage collector can still
f97c9175 2870operate should the disk become full. Return a server object.
e531ac2a
LC
2871
2872@var{file} defaults to @var{%default-socket-path}, which is the normal
2873location given the options that were passed to @command{configure}.
2874@end deffn
2875
2876@deffn {Scheme Procedure} close-connection @var{server}
2877Close the connection to @var{server}.
2878@end deffn
2879
2880@defvr {Scheme Variable} current-build-output-port
2881This variable is bound to a SRFI-39 parameter, which refers to the port
2882where build and error logs sent by the daemon should be written.
2883@end defvr
2884
2885Procedures that make RPCs all take a server object as their first
2886argument.
2887
2888@deffn {Scheme Procedure} valid-path? @var{server} @var{path}
2889Return @code{#t} when @var{path} is a valid store path.
2890@end deffn
2891
cfbf9160 2892@deffn {Scheme Procedure} add-text-to-store @var{server} @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
e531ac2a
LC
2893Add @var{text} under file @var{name} in the store, and return its store
2894path. @var{references} is the list of store paths referred to by the
2895resulting store path.
2896@end deffn
2897
874e6874 2898@deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-derivations @var{server} @var{derivations}
59688fc4
LC
2899Build @var{derivations} (a list of @code{<derivation>} objects or
2900derivation paths), and return when the worker is done building them.
2901Return @code{#t} on success.
874e6874
LC
2902@end deffn
2903
b860f382
LC
2904Note that the @code{(guix monads)} module provides a monad as well as
2905monadic versions of the above procedures, with the goal of making it
2906more convenient to work with code that accesses the store (@pxref{The
2907Store Monad}).
2908
e531ac2a
LC
2909@c FIXME
2910@i{This section is currently incomplete.}
568717fd
LC
2911
2912@node Derivations
2913@section Derivations
2914
874e6874
LC
2915@cindex derivations
2916Low-level build actions and the environment in which they are performed
2917are represented by @dfn{derivations}. A derivation contain the
2918following pieces of information:
2919
2920@itemize
2921@item
2922The outputs of the derivation---derivations produce at least one file or
2923directory in the store, but may produce more.
2924
2925@item
2926The inputs of the derivations, which may be other derivations or plain
2927files in the store (patches, build scripts, etc.)
2928
2929@item
2930The system type targeted by the derivation---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
2931
2932@item
2933The file name of a build script in the store, along with the arguments
2934to be passed.
2935
2936@item
2937A list of environment variables to be defined.
2938
2939@end itemize
2940
2941@cindex derivation path
2942Derivations allow clients of the daemon to communicate build actions to
2943the store. They exist in two forms: as an in-memory representation,
2944both on the client- and daemon-side, and as files in the store whose
2945name end in @code{.drv}---these files are referred to as @dfn{derivation
2946paths}. Derivations paths can be passed to the @code{build-derivations}
2947procedure to perform the build actions they prescribe (@pxref{The
2948Store}).
2949
2950The @code{(guix derivations)} module provides a representation of
2951derivations as Scheme objects, along with procedures to create and
2952otherwise manipulate derivations. The lowest-level primitive to create
2953a derivation is the @code{derivation} procedure:
2954
1909431c
LC
2955@deffn {Scheme Procedure} derivation @var{store} @var{name} @var{builder} @
2956 @var{args} [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
2096ef47 2957 [#:recursive? #f] [#:inputs '()] [#:env-vars '()] @
1909431c 2958 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:references-graphs #f] @
4a6aeb67
LC
2959 [#:allowed-references #f] [#:leaked-env-vars #f] [#:local-build? #f] @
2960 [#:substitutable? #t]
59688fc4
LC
2961Build a derivation with the given arguments, and return the resulting
2962@code{<derivation>} object.
874e6874 2963
2096ef47 2964When @var{hash} and @var{hash-algo} are given, a
874e6874 2965@dfn{fixed-output derivation} is created---i.e., one whose result is
36bbbbd1
LC
2966known in advance, such as a file download. If, in addition,
2967@var{recursive?} is true, then that fixed output may be an executable
2968file or a directory and @var{hash} must be the hash of an archive
2969containing this output.
5b0c9d16 2970
858e9282 2971When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of file
5b0c9d16
LC
2972name/store path pairs. In that case, the reference graph of each store
2973path is exported in the build environment in the corresponding file, in
2974a simple text format.
1909431c 2975
b53be755
LC
2976When @var{allowed-references} is true, it must be a list of store items
2977or outputs that the derivation's output may refer to.
2978
c0468155
LC
2979When @var{leaked-env-vars} is true, it must be a list of strings
2980denoting environment variables that are allowed to ``leak'' from the
2981daemon's environment to the build environment. This is only applicable
2982to fixed-output derivations---i.e., when @var{hash} is true. The main
2983use is to allow variables such as @code{http_proxy} to be passed to
2984derivations that download files.
2985
1909431c
LC
2986When @var{local-build?} is true, declare that the derivation is not a
2987good candidate for offloading and should rather be built locally
2988(@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). This is the case for small derivations
2989where the costs of data transfers would outweigh the benefits.
4a6aeb67
LC
2990
2991When @var{substitutable?} is false, declare that substitutes of the
2992derivation's output should not be used (@pxref{Substitutes}). This is
2993useful, for instance, when building packages that capture details of the
2994host CPU instruction set.
874e6874
LC
2995@end deffn
2996
2997@noindent
2998Here's an example with a shell script as its builder, assuming
2999@var{store} is an open connection to the daemon, and @var{bash} points
3000to a Bash executable in the store:
3001
3002@lisp
3003(use-modules (guix utils)
3004 (guix store)
3005 (guix derivations))
3006
59688fc4
LC
3007(let ((builder ; add the Bash script to the store
3008 (add-text-to-store store "my-builder.sh"
3009 "echo hello world > $out\n" '())))
3010 (derivation store "foo"
3011 bash `("-e" ,builder)
21b679f6 3012 #:inputs `((,bash) (,builder))
59688fc4 3013 #:env-vars '(("HOME" . "/homeless"))))
834129e0 3014@result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo.drv => /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo>
874e6874
LC
3015@end lisp
3016
21b679f6
LC
3017As can be guessed, this primitive is cumbersome to use directly. A
3018better approach is to write build scripts in Scheme, of course! The
3019best course of action for that is to write the build code as a
3020``G-expression'', and to pass it to @code{gexp->derivation}. For more
6621cdb6 3021information, @pxref{G-Expressions}.
21b679f6
LC
3022
3023Once upon a time, @code{gexp->derivation} did not exist and constructing
3024derivations with build code written in Scheme was achieved with
3025@code{build-expression->derivation}, documented below. This procedure
3026is now deprecated in favor of the much nicer @code{gexp->derivation}.
874e6874 3027
dd1a5a15
LC
3028@deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-expression->derivation @var{store} @
3029 @var{name} @var{exp} @
3030 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:inputs '()] @
3031 [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
36bbbbd1 3032 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
63a42824 3033 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
4a6aeb67 3034 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
874e6874
LC
3035Return a derivation that executes Scheme expression @var{exp} as a
3036builder for derivation @var{name}. @var{inputs} must be a list of
3037@code{(name drv-path sub-drv)} tuples; when @var{sub-drv} is omitted,
3038@code{"out"} is assumed. @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile
3039modules from the current search path to be copied in the store,
3040compiled, and made available in the load path during the execution of
3041@var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix build utils) (guix build
3042gnu-build-system))}.
3043
3044@var{exp} is evaluated in an environment where @code{%outputs} is bound
3045to a list of output/path pairs, and where @code{%build-inputs} is bound
3046to a list of string/output-path pairs made from @var{inputs}.
3047Optionally, @var{env-vars} is a list of string pairs specifying the name
3048and value of environment variables visible to the builder. The builder
3049terminates by passing the result of @var{exp} to @code{exit}; thus, when
3050@var{exp} returns @code{#f}, the build is considered to have failed.
3051
3052@var{exp} is built using @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation). When
3053@var{guile-for-build} is omitted or is @code{#f}, the value of the
3054@code{%guile-for-build} fluid is used instead.
9c629a27 3055
63a42824 3056See the @code{derivation} procedure for the meaning of
4a6aeb67
LC
3057@var{references-graphs}, @var{allowed-references}, @var{local-build?},
3058and @var{substitutable?}.
874e6874
LC
3059@end deffn
3060
3061@noindent
3062Here's an example of a single-output derivation that creates a directory
3063containing one file:
3064
3065@lisp
3066(let ((builder '(let ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out")))
834129e0 3067 (mkdir out) ; create /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo
874e6874
LC
3068 (call-with-output-file (string-append out "/test")
3069 (lambda (p)
3070 (display '(hello guix) p))))))
dd1a5a15 3071 (build-expression->derivation store "goo" builder))
874e6874 3072
834129e0 3073@result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo.drv => @dots{}>
874e6874
LC
3074@end lisp
3075
568717fd 3076
b860f382
LC
3077@node The Store Monad
3078@section The Store Monad
3079
3080@cindex monad
3081
3082The procedures that operate on the store described in the previous
3083sections all take an open connection to the build daemon as their first
3084argument. Although the underlying model is functional, they either have
3085side effects or depend on the current state of the store.
3086
3087The former is inconvenient: the connection to the build daemon has to be
3088carried around in all those functions, making it impossible to compose
3089functions that do not take that parameter with functions that do. The
3090latter can be problematic: since store operations have side effects
3091and/or depend on external state, they have to be properly sequenced.
3092
3093@cindex monadic values
3094@cindex monadic functions
3095This is where the @code{(guix monads)} module comes in. This module
3096provides a framework for working with @dfn{monads}, and a particularly
3097useful monad for our uses, the @dfn{store monad}. Monads are a
3098construct that allows two things: associating ``context'' with values
3099(in our case, the context is the store), and building sequences of
561fb6c3 3100computations (here computations include accesses to the store.) Values
b860f382
LC
3101in a monad---values that carry this additional context---are called
3102@dfn{monadic values}; procedures that return such values are called
3103@dfn{monadic procedures}.
3104
3105Consider this ``normal'' procedure:
3106
3107@example
45adbd62
LC
3108(define (sh-symlink store)
3109 ;; Return a derivation that symlinks the 'bash' executable.
3110 (let* ((drv (package-derivation store bash))
3111 (out (derivation->output-path drv))
3112 (sh (string-append out "/bin/bash")))
3113 (build-expression->derivation store "sh"
3114 `(symlink ,sh %output))))
b860f382
LC
3115@end example
3116
c6f30b81
LC
3117Using @code{(guix monads)} and @code{(guix gexp)}, it may be rewritten
3118as a monadic function:
b860f382
LC
3119
3120@example
45adbd62 3121(define (sh-symlink)
b860f382 3122 ;; Same, but return a monadic value.
c6f30b81
LC
3123 (mlet %store-monad ((drv (package->derivation bash)))
3124 (gexp->derivation "sh"
3125 #~(symlink (string-append #$drv "/bin/bash")
3126 #$output))))
b860f382
LC
3127@end example
3128
c6f30b81
LC
3129There several things to note in the second version: the @code{store}
3130parameter is now implicit and is ``threaded'' in the calls to the
3131@code{package->derivation} and @code{gexp->derivation} monadic
3132procedures, and the monadic value returned by @code{package->derivation}
3133is @dfn{bound} using @code{mlet} instead of plain @code{let}.
3134
3135As it turns out, the call to @code{package->derivation} can even be
3136omitted since it will take place implicitly, as we will see later
3137(@pxref{G-Expressions}):
3138
3139@example
3140(define (sh-symlink)
3141 (gexp->derivation "sh"
3142 #~(symlink (string-append #$bash "/bin/bash")
3143 #$output)))
3144@end example
b860f382 3145
7ce21611
LC
3146@c See
3147@c <https://syntaxexclamation.wordpress.com/2014/06/26/escaping-continuations/>
3148@c for the funny quote.
3149Calling the monadic @code{sh-symlink} has no effect. As someone once
3150said, ``you exit a monad like you exit a building on fire: by running''.
3151So, to exit the monad and get the desired effect, one must use
3152@code{run-with-store}:
b860f382
LC
3153
3154@example
8e9aa37f
CAW
3155(run-with-store (open-connection) (sh-symlink))
3156@result{} /gnu/store/...-sh-symlink
b860f382
LC
3157@end example
3158
f97c9175 3159Note that the @code{(guix monad-repl)} module extends the Guile REPL with
b9b86078 3160new ``meta-commands'' to make it easier to deal with monadic procedures:
f97c9175 3161@code{run-in-store}, and @code{enter-store-monad}. The former is used
b9b86078
LC
3162to ``run'' a single monadic value through the store:
3163
3164@example
3165scheme@@(guile-user)> ,run-in-store (package->derivation hello)
3166$1 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
3167@end example
3168
3169The latter enters a recursive REPL, where all the return values are
3170automatically run through the store:
3171
3172@example
3173scheme@@(guile-user)> ,enter-store-monad
3174store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (package->derivation hello)
3175$2 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
3176store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (text-file "foo" "Hello!")
3177$3 = "/gnu/store/@dots{}-foo"
3178store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> ,q
3179scheme@@(guile-user)>
3180@end example
3181
3182@noindent
3183Note that non-monadic values cannot be returned in the
3184@code{store-monad} REPL.
3185
e87f0591
LC
3186The main syntactic forms to deal with monads in general are provided by
3187the @code{(guix monads)} module and are described below.
b860f382
LC
3188
3189@deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-monad @var{monad} @var{body} ...
3190Evaluate any @code{>>=} or @code{return} forms in @var{body} as being
3191in @var{monad}.
3192@end deffn
3193
3194@deffn {Scheme Syntax} return @var{val}
3195Return a monadic value that encapsulates @var{val}.
3196@end deffn
3197
751630c9 3198@deffn {Scheme Syntax} >>= @var{mval} @var{mproc} ...
b860f382 3199@dfn{Bind} monadic value @var{mval}, passing its ``contents'' to monadic
751630c9
LC
3200procedures @var{mproc}@dots{}@footnote{This operation is commonly
3201referred to as ``bind'', but that name denotes an unrelated procedure in
3202Guile. Thus we use this somewhat cryptic symbol inherited from the
3203Haskell language.}. There can be one @var{mproc} or several of them, as
3204in this example:
3205
3206@example
3207(run-with-state
3208 (with-monad %state-monad
3209 (>>= (return 1)
3210 (lambda (x) (return (+ 1 x)))
3211 (lambda (x) (return (* 2 x)))))
3212 'some-state)
3213
3214@result{} 4
3215@result{} some-state
3216@end example
b860f382
LC
3217@end deffn
3218
3219@deffn {Scheme Syntax} mlet @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
3220 @var{body} ...
3221@deffnx {Scheme Syntax} mlet* @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
3222 @var{body} ...
3223Bind the variables @var{var} to the monadic values @var{mval} in
3224@var{body}. The form (@var{var} -> @var{val}) binds @var{var} to the
3225``normal'' value @var{val}, as per @code{let}.
3226
3227@code{mlet*} is to @code{mlet} what @code{let*} is to @code{let}
3228(@pxref{Local Bindings,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
3229@end deffn
3230
405a9d4e
LC
3231@deffn {Scheme System} mbegin @var{monad} @var{mexp} ...
3232Bind @var{mexp} and the following monadic expressions in sequence,
3233returning the result of the last expression.
3234
3235This is akin to @code{mlet}, except that the return values of the
3236monadic expressions are ignored. In that sense, it is analogous to
3237@code{begin}, but applied to monadic expressions.
3238@end deffn
3239
561fb6c3
LC
3240@cindex state monad
3241The @code{(guix monads)} module provides the @dfn{state monad}, which
3242allows an additional value---the state---to be @emph{threaded} through
3243monadic procedure calls.
3244
3245@defvr {Scheme Variable} %state-monad
3246The state monad. Procedures in the state monad can access and change
3247the state that is threaded.
3248
3249Consider the example below. The @code{square} procedure returns a value
3250in the state monad. It returns the square of its argument, but also
3251increments the current state value:
3252
3253@example
3254(define (square x)
3255 (mlet %state-monad ((count (current-state)))
3256 (mbegin %state-monad
3257 (set-current-state (+ 1 count))
3258 (return (* x x)))))
3259
3260(run-with-state (sequence %state-monad (map square (iota 3))) 0)
3261@result{} (0 1 4)
3262@result{} 3
3263@end example
3264
3265When ``run'' through @var{%state-monad}, we obtain that additional state
3266value, which is the number of @code{square} calls.
3267@end defvr
3268
3269@deffn {Monadic Procedure} current-state
3270Return the current state as a monadic value.
3271@end deffn
3272
3273@deffn {Monadic Procedure} set-current-state @var{value}
3274Set the current state to @var{value} and return the previous state as a
3275monadic value.
3276@end deffn
3277
3278@deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-push @var{value}
3279Push @var{value} to the current state, which is assumed to be a list,
3280and return the previous state as a monadic value.
3281@end deffn
3282
3283@deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-pop
3284Pop a value from the current state and return it as a monadic value.
3285The state is assumed to be a list.
3286@end deffn
3287
3288@deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-state @var{mval} [@var{state}]
3289Run monadic value @var{mval} starting with @var{state} as the initial
3290state. Return two values: the resulting value, and the resulting state.
3291@end deffn
3292
e87f0591
LC
3293The main interface to the store monad, provided by the @code{(guix
3294store)} module, is as follows.
b860f382
LC
3295
3296@defvr {Scheme Variable} %store-monad
561fb6c3
LC
3297The store monad---an alias for @var{%state-monad}.
3298
3299Values in the store monad encapsulate accesses to the store. When its
3300effect is needed, a value of the store monad must be ``evaluated'' by
3301passing it to the @code{run-with-store} procedure (see below.)
b860f382
LC
3302@end defvr
3303
3304@deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-store @var{store} @var{mval} [#:guile-for-build] [#:system (%current-system)]
3305Run @var{mval}, a monadic value in the store monad, in @var{store}, an
3306open store connection.
3307@end deffn
3308
ad372953 3309@deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
b860f382 3310Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
ad372953
LC
3311containing @var{text}, a string. @var{references} is a list of store items that the
3312resulting text file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
45adbd62
LC
3313@end deffn
3314
0a90af15
LC
3315@deffn {Monadic Procedure} interned-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
3316 [#:recursive? #t]
3317Return the name of @var{file} once interned in the store. Use
3318@var{name} as its store name, or the basename of @var{file} if
3319@var{name} is omitted.
3320
3321When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added
3322recursively; if @var{file} designates a flat file and @var{recursive?}
3323is true, its contents are added, and its permission bits are kept.
3324
3325The example below adds a file to the store, under two different names:
3326
3327@example
3328(run-with-store (open-connection)
3329 (mlet %store-monad ((a (interned-file "README"))
3330 (b (interned-file "README" "LEGU-MIN")))
3331 (return (list a b))))
3332
3333@result{} ("/gnu/store/rwm@dots{}-README" "/gnu/store/44i@dots{}-LEGU-MIN")
3334@end example
3335
3336@end deffn
3337
e87f0591
LC
3338The @code{(guix packages)} module exports the following package-related
3339monadic procedures:
3340
b860f382 3341@deffn {Monadic Procedure} package-file @var{package} [@var{file}] @
4231f05b 3342 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] @
f97c9175
AE
3343 [#:output "out"]
3344Return as a monadic
b860f382
LC
3345value in the absolute file name of @var{file} within the @var{output}
3346directory of @var{package}. When @var{file} is omitted, return the name
4231f05b
LC
3347of the @var{output} directory of @var{package}. When @var{target} is
3348true, use it as a cross-compilation target triplet.
b860f382
LC
3349@end deffn
3350
b860f382 3351@deffn {Monadic Procedure} package->derivation @var{package} [@var{system}]
4231f05b
LC
3352@deffnx {Monadic Procedure} package->cross-derivation @var{package} @
3353 @var{target} [@var{system}]
3354Monadic version of @code{package-derivation} and
3355@code{package-cross-derivation} (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
b860f382
LC
3356@end deffn
3357
3358
21b679f6
LC
3359@node G-Expressions
3360@section G-Expressions
3361
3362@cindex G-expression
3363@cindex build code quoting
3364So we have ``derivations'', which represent a sequence of build actions
3365to be performed to produce an item in the store (@pxref{Derivations}).
f97c9175 3366These build actions are performed when asking the daemon to actually
21b679f6
LC
3367build the derivations; they are run by the daemon in a container
3368(@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
3369
3370@cindex strata of code
f97c9175 3371It should come as no surprise that we like to write these build actions
21b679f6
LC
3372in Scheme. When we do that, we end up with two @dfn{strata} of Scheme
3373code@footnote{The term @dfn{stratum} in this context was coined by
ef4ab0a4
LC
3374Manuel Serrano et al.@: in the context of their work on Hop. Oleg
3375Kiselyov, who has written insightful
3376@url{http://okmij.org/ftp/meta-programming/#meta-scheme, essays and code
3377on this topic}, refers to this kind of code generation as
3378@dfn{staging}.}: the ``host code''---code that defines packages, talks
3379to the daemon, etc.---and the ``build code''---code that actually
3380performs build actions, such as making directories, invoking
3381@command{make}, etc.
21b679f6
LC
3382
3383To describe a derivation and its build actions, one typically needs to
3384embed build code inside host code. It boils down to manipulating build
f97c9175 3385code as data, and the homoiconicity of Scheme---code has a direct
21b679f6 3386representation as data---comes in handy for that. But we need more than
f97c9175 3387the normal @code{quasiquote} mechanism in Scheme to construct build
21b679f6
LC
3388expressions.
3389
3390The @code{(guix gexp)} module implements @dfn{G-expressions}, a form of
3391S-expressions adapted to build expressions. G-expressions, or
f97c9175 3392@dfn{gexps}, consist essentially of three syntactic forms: @code{gexp},
21b679f6 3393@code{ungexp}, and @code{ungexp-splicing} (or simply: @code{#~},
f97c9175
AE
3394@code{#$}, and @code{#$@@}), which are comparable to
3395@code{quasiquote}, @code{unquote}, and @code{unquote-splicing},
3396respectivel (@pxref{Expression Syntax, @code{quasiquote},, guile,
3397GNU Guile Reference Manual}). However, there are major differences:
21b679f6
LC
3398
3399@itemize
3400@item
3401Gexps are meant to be written to a file and run or manipulated by other
3402processes.
3403
3404@item
b39fc6f7
LC
3405When a high-level object such as a package or derivation is unquoted
3406inside a gexp, the result is as if its output file name had been
3407introduced.
ff40e9b7 3408
21b679f6
LC
3409@item
3410Gexps carry information about the packages or derivations they refer to,
3411and these dependencies are automatically added as inputs to the build
3412processes that use them.
3413@end itemize
3414
c2b84676 3415@cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
343eacbe
LC
3416This mechanism is not limited to package and derivation
3417objects: @dfn{compilers} able to ``lower'' other high-level objects to
c2b84676
LC
3418derivations or files in the store can be defined,
3419such that these objects can also be inserted
f97c9175 3420into gexps. For example, a useful type of high-level objects that can be
343eacbe 3421inserted in a gexp is ``file-like objects'', which make it easy to
f97c9175 3422add files to the store and to refer to them in
558e8b11
LC
3423derivations and such (see @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}
3424below.)
b39fc6f7 3425
21b679f6
LC
3426To illustrate the idea, here is an example of a gexp:
3427
3428@example
3429(define build-exp
3430 #~(begin
3431 (mkdir #$output)
3432 (chdir #$output)
aff8ce7c 3433 (symlink (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
21b679f6
LC
3434 "list-files")))
3435@end example
3436
3437This gexp can be passed to @code{gexp->derivation}; we obtain a
3438derivation that builds a directory containing exactly one symlink to
3439@file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22/bin/ls}:
3440
3441@example
3442(gexp->derivation "the-thing" build-exp)
3443@end example
3444
e20fd1bf 3445As one would expect, the @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"} string is
21b679f6
LC
3446substituted to the reference to the @var{coreutils} package in the
3447actual build code, and @var{coreutils} is automatically made an input to
3448the derivation. Likewise, @code{#$output} (equivalent to @code{(ungexp
f97c9175
AE
3449output)}) is replaced by a string containing the directory name of the
3450output of the derivation.
667b2508
LC
3451
3452@cindex cross compilation
3453In a cross-compilation context, it is useful to distinguish between
3454references to the @emph{native} build of a package---that can run on the
3455host---versus references to cross builds of a package. To that end, the
3456@code{#+} plays the same role as @code{#$}, but is a reference to a
3457native package build:
3458
3459@example
3460(gexp->derivation "vi"
3461 #~(begin
3462 (mkdir #$output)
3463 (system* (string-append #+coreutils "/bin/ln")
3464 "-s"
3465 (string-append #$emacs "/bin/emacs")
3466 (string-append #$output "/bin/vi")))
3467 #:target "mips64el-linux")
3468@end example
3469
3470@noindent
3471In the example above, the native build of @var{coreutils} is used, so
3472that @command{ln} can actually run on the host; but then the
3473cross-compiled build of @var{emacs} is referenced.
3474
3475The syntactic form to construct gexps is summarized below.
21b679f6
LC
3476
3477@deffn {Scheme Syntax} #~@var{exp}
3478@deffnx {Scheme Syntax} (gexp @var{exp})
3479Return a G-expression containing @var{exp}. @var{exp} may contain one
3480or more of the following forms:
3481
3482@table @code
3483@item #$@var{obj}
3484@itemx (ungexp @var{obj})
b39fc6f7
LC
3485Introduce a reference to @var{obj}. @var{obj} may have one of the
3486supported types, for example a package or a
21b679f6
LC
3487derivation, in which case the @code{ungexp} form is replaced by its
3488output file name---e.g., @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22}.
3489
b39fc6f7
LC
3490If @var{obj} is a list, it is traversed and references to supported
3491objects are substituted similarly.
21b679f6
LC
3492
3493If @var{obj} is another gexp, its contents are inserted and its
3494dependencies are added to those of the containing gexp.
3495
3496If @var{obj} is another kind of object, it is inserted as is.
3497
b39fc6f7
LC
3498@item #$@var{obj}:@var{output}
3499@itemx (ungexp @var{obj} @var{output})
21b679f6 3500This is like the form above, but referring explicitly to the
b39fc6f7
LC
3501@var{output} of @var{obj}---this is useful when @var{obj} produces
3502multiple outputs (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
21b679f6 3503
667b2508
LC
3504@item #+@var{obj}
3505@itemx #+@var{obj}:output
3506@itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj})
3507@itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj} @var{output})
3508Same as @code{ungexp}, but produces a reference to the @emph{native}
3509build of @var{obj} when used in a cross compilation context.
3510
21b679f6
LC
3511@item #$output[:@var{output}]
3512@itemx (ungexp output [@var{output}])
3513Insert a reference to derivation output @var{output}, or to the main
3514output when @var{output} is omitted.
3515
3516This only makes sense for gexps passed to @code{gexp->derivation}.
3517
3518@item #$@@@var{lst}
3519@itemx (ungexp-splicing @var{lst})
3520Like the above, but splices the contents of @var{lst} inside the
3521containing list.
3522
667b2508
LC
3523@item #+@@@var{lst}
3524@itemx (ungexp-native-splicing @var{lst})
3525Like the above, but refers to native builds of the objects listed in
3526@var{lst}.
3527
21b679f6
LC
3528@end table
3529
3530G-expressions created by @code{gexp} or @code{#~} are run-time objects
3531of the @code{gexp?} type (see below.)
3532@end deffn
3533
3534@deffn {Scheme Procedure} gexp? @var{obj}
3535Return @code{#t} if @var{obj} is a G-expression.
3536@end deffn
3537
3538G-expressions are meant to be written to disk, either as code building
3539some derivation, or as plain files in the store. The monadic procedures
3540below allow you to do that (@pxref{The Store Monad}, for more
3541information about monads.)
3542
3543@deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->derivation @var{name} @var{exp} @
ce45eb4c 3544 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] [#:graft? #t] @
21b679f6
LC
3545 [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
3546 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
4684f301 3547 [#:module-path @var{%load-path}] @
c8351d9a 3548 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
c0468155 3549 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] @
0309e1b0 3550 [#:script-name (string-append @var{name} "-builder")] @
4a6aeb67 3551 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
21b679f6 3552Return a derivation @var{name} that runs @var{exp} (a gexp) with
0309e1b0
LC
3553@var{guile-for-build} (a derivation) on @var{system}; @var{exp} is
3554stored in a file called @var{script-name}. When @var{target} is true,
3555it is used as the cross-compilation target triplet for packages referred
3556to by @var{exp}.
21b679f6 3557
ce45eb4c
LC
3558Make @var{modules} available in the evaluation context of @var{exp};
3559@var{modules} is a list of names of Guile modules searched in
3560@var{module-path} to be copied in the store, compiled, and made available in
21b679f6
LC
3561the load path during the execution of @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix
3562build utils) (guix build gnu-build-system))}.
3563
ce45eb4c
LC
3564@var{graft?} determines whether packages referred to by @var{exp} should be grafted when
3565applicable.
3566
b53833b2
LC
3567When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of tuples of one of the
3568following forms:
3569
3570@example
3571(@var{file-name} @var{package})
3572(@var{file-name} @var{package} @var{output})
3573(@var{file-name} @var{derivation})
3574(@var{file-name} @var{derivation} @var{output})
3575(@var{file-name} @var{store-item})
3576@end example
3577
3578The right-hand-side of each element of @var{references-graphs} is automatically made
3579an input of the build process of @var{exp}. In the build environment, each
3580@var{file-name} contains the reference graph of the corresponding item, in a simple
3581text format.
3582
c8351d9a
LC
3583@var{allowed-references} must be either @code{#f} or a list of output names and packages.
3584In the latter case, the list denotes store items that the result is allowed to
3585refer to. Any reference to another store item will lead to a build error.
3586
e20fd1bf 3587The other arguments are as for @code{derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
21b679f6
LC
3588@end deffn
3589
343eacbe 3590@cindex file-like objects
e1c153e0
LC
3591The @code{local-file}, @code{plain-file}, @code{computed-file},
3592@code{program-file}, and @code{scheme-file} procedures below return
3593@dfn{file-like objects}. That is, when unquoted in a G-expression,
3594these objects lead to a file in the store. Consider this G-expression:
343eacbe
LC
3595
3596@example
3597#~(system* (string-append #$glibc "/sbin/nscd") "-f"
3598 #$(local-file "/tmp/my-nscd.conf"))
3599@end example
3600
3601The effect here is to ``intern'' @file{/tmp/my-nscd.conf} by copying it
3602to the store. Once expanded, for instance @i{via}
3603@code{gexp->derivation}, the G-expression refers to that copy under
3604@file{/gnu/store}; thus, modifying or removing the file in @file{/tmp}
3605does not have any effect on what the G-expression does.
3606@code{plain-file} can be used similarly; it differs in that the file
3607content is directly passed as a string.
3608
d9ae938f
LC
3609@deffn {Scheme Procedure} local-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
3610 [#:recursive? #t]
3611Return an object representing local file @var{file} to add to the store; this
9d3994f7
LC
3612object can be used in a gexp. If @var{file} is a relative file name, it is looked
3613up relative to the source file where this form appears. @var{file} will be added to
3614the store under @var{name}--by default the base name of @var{file}.
d9ae938f
LC
3615
3616When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added recursively; if @var{file}
3617designates a flat file and @var{recursive?} is true, its contents are added, and its
3618permission bits are kept.
3619
3620This is the declarative counterpart of the @code{interned-file} monadic
3621procedure (@pxref{The Store Monad, @code{interned-file}}).
3622@end deffn
3623
558e8b11
LC
3624@deffn {Scheme Procedure} plain-file @var{name} @var{content}
3625Return an object representing a text file called @var{name} with the given
3626@var{content} (a string) to be added to the store.
3627
3628This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file}.
3629@end deffn
3630
91937029
LC
3631@deffn {Scheme Procedure} computed-file @var{name} @var{gexp} @
3632 [#:modules '()] [#:options '(#:local-build? #t)]
3633Return an object representing the store item @var{name}, a file or
3634directory computed by @var{gexp}. @var{modules} specifies the set of
3635modules visible in the execution context of @var{gexp}. @var{options}
3636is a list of additional arguments to pass to @code{gexp->derivation}.
3637
3638This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->derivation}.
3639@end deffn
3640
21b679f6
LC
3641@deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->script @var{name} @var{exp}
3642Return an executable script @var{name} that runs @var{exp} using
3643@var{guile} with @var{modules} in its search path.
3644
3645The example below builds a script that simply invokes the @command{ls}
3646command:
3647
3648@example
3649(use-modules (guix gexp) (gnu packages base))
3650
3651(gexp->script "list-files"
3652 #~(execl (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
3653 "ls"))
3654@end example
3655
3656When ``running'' it through the store (@pxref{The Store Monad,
e20fd1bf 3657@code{run-with-store}}), we obtain a derivation that produces an
21b679f6
LC
3658executable file @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-list-files} along these lines:
3659
3660@example
3661#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-guile-2.0.11/bin/guile -ds
3662!#
3663(execl (string-append "/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"/bin/ls")
3664 "ls")
3665@end example
3666@end deffn
3667
15a01c72
LC
3668@deffn {Scheme Procedure} program-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
3669 [#:modules '()] [#:guile #f]
3670Return an object representing the executable store item @var{name} that
3671runs @var{gexp}. @var{guile} is the Guile package used to execute that
3672script, and @var{modules} is the list of modules visible to that script.
3673
3674This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->script}.
3675@end deffn
3676
21b679f6
LC
3677@deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->file @var{name} @var{exp}
3678Return a derivation that builds a file @var{name} containing @var{exp}.
3679
3680The resulting file holds references to all the dependencies of @var{exp}
3681or a subset thereof.
3682@end deffn
1ed19464 3683
e1c153e0
LC
3684@deffn {Scheme Procedure} scheme-file @var{name} @var{exp}
3685Return an object representing the Scheme file @var{name} that contains
3686@var{exp}.
3687
3688This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->file}.
3689@end deffn
3690
1ed19464
LC
3691@deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file* @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
3692Return as a monadic value a derivation that builds a text file
3693containing all of @var{text}. @var{text} may list, in addition to
d9ae938f
LC
3694strings, objects of any type that can be used in a gexp: packages,
3695derivations, local file objects, etc. The resulting store file holds
3696references to all these.
1ed19464
LC
3697
3698This variant should be preferred over @code{text-file} anytime the file
3699to create will reference items from the store. This is typically the
3700case when building a configuration file that embeds store file names,
3701like this:
3702
3703@example
3704(define (profile.sh)
3705 ;; Return the name of a shell script in the store that
3706 ;; initializes the 'PATH' environment variable.
3707 (text-file* "profile.sh"
3708 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:"
3709 grep "/bin:" sed "/bin\n"))
3710@end example
3711
3712In this example, the resulting @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile.sh} file
3713will references @var{coreutils}, @var{grep}, and @var{sed}, thereby
3714preventing them from being garbage-collected during its lifetime.
3715@end deffn
21b679f6 3716
b751cde3
LC
3717@deffn {Scheme Procedure} mixed-text-file @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
3718Return an object representing store file @var{name} containing
3719@var{text}. @var{text} is a sequence of strings and file-like objects,
3720as in:
3721
3722@example
3723(mixed-text-file "profile"
3724 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:" grep "/bin")
3725@end example
3726
3727This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file*}.
3728@end deffn
3729
21b679f6
LC
3730Of course, in addition to gexps embedded in ``host'' code, there are
3731also modules containing build tools. To make it clear that they are
3732meant to be used in the build stratum, these modules are kept in the
3733@code{(guix build @dots{})} name space.
3734
c2b84676
LC
3735@cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
3736Internally, high-level objects are @dfn{lowered}, using their compiler,
3737to either derivations or store items. For instance, lowering a package
3738yields a derivation, and lowering a @code{plain-file} yields a store
3739item. This is achieved using the @code{lower-object} monadic procedure.
3740
3741@deffn {Monadic Procedure} lower-object @var{obj} [@var{system}] @
3742 [#:target #f]
3743Return as a value in @var{%store-monad} the derivation or store item
3744corresponding to @var{obj} for @var{system}, cross-compiling for
3745@var{target} if @var{target} is true. @var{obj} must be an object that
3746has an associated gexp compiler, such as a @code{<package>}.
3747@end deffn
3748
21b679f6 3749
568717fd
LC
3750@c *********************************************************************
3751@node Utilities
3752@chapter Utilities
3753
210cc920
LC
3754This section describes tools primarily targeted at developers and users
3755who write new package definitions. They complement the Scheme
3756programming interface of Guix in a convenient way.
3757
568717fd 3758@menu
37166310 3759* Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
39bee8a2 3760* Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
210cc920 3761* Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
37166310 3762* Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
2f7d2d91 3763* Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
37166310 3764* Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
b4f5e0e8 3765* Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
fcc58db6 3766* Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
88856916 3767* Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
372c4bbc 3768* Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
aff8ce7c 3769* Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
d23c20f1 3770* Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
32efa254 3771* Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
568717fd
LC
3772@end menu
3773
e49951eb
MW
3774@node Invoking guix build
3775@section Invoking @command{guix build}
568717fd 3776
e49951eb 3777The @command{guix build} command builds packages or derivations and
6798a8e4
LC
3778their dependencies, and prints the resulting store paths. Note that it
3779does not modify the user's profile---this is the job of the
e49951eb 3780@command{guix package} command (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). Thus,
6798a8e4
LC
3781it is mainly useful for distribution developers.
3782
3783The general syntax is:
c78bd12b
LC
3784
3785@example
e49951eb 3786guix build @var{options} @var{package-or-derivation}@dots{}
c78bd12b
LC
3787@end example
3788
f97c9175 3789As an example, the following command builds the latest versions of Emacs
ccd7158d
LC
3790and of Guile, displays their build logs, and finally displays the
3791resulting directories:
3792
3793@example
3794guix build emacs guile
3795@end example
3796
3797Similarly, the following command builds all the available packages:
3798
3799@example
3800guix build --keep-going \
3801 `guix package -A | cut -f1,2 --output-delimiter=@@`
3802@end example
3803
c78bd12b 3804@var{package-or-derivation} may be either the name of a package found in
5401dd75
LC
3805the software distribution such as @code{coreutils} or
3806@code{coreutils-8.20}, or a derivation such as
834129e0 3807@file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.19.drv}. In the former case, a
e7f34eb0
LC
3808package with the corresponding name (and optionally version) is searched
3809for among the GNU distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
3810
3811Alternatively, the @code{--expression} option may be used to specify a
3812Scheme expression that evaluates to a package; this is useful when
3813disambiguation among several same-named packages or package variants is
3814needed.
c78bd12b 3815
ccd7158d
LC
3816There may be zero or more @var{options}. The available options are
3817described in the subsections below.
3818
3819@menu
3820* Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
88ad6ded 3821* Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
ccd7158d
LC
3822* Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
3823@end menu
3824
3825@node Common Build Options
3826@subsection Common Build Options
3827
3828A number of options that control the build process are common to
3829@command{guix build} and other commands that can spawn builds, such as
3830@command{guix package} or @command{guix archive}. These are the
3831following:
3832
3833@table @code
3834
3835@item --load-path=@var{directory}
3836@itemx -L @var{directory}
3837Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
3838(@pxref{Package Modules}).
3839
3840This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
3841the command-line tools.
3842
3843@item --keep-failed
3844@itemx -K
3845Keep the build tree of failed builds. Thus, if a build fail, its build
3846tree is kept under @file{/tmp}, in a directory whose name is shown at
3847the end of the build log. This is useful when debugging build issues.
3848
3849@item --keep-going
3850@itemx -k
3851Keep going when some of the derivations fail to build; return only once
3852all the builds have either completed or failed.
3853
3854The default behavior is to stop as soon as one of the specified
3855derivations has failed.
3856
3857@item --dry-run
3858@itemx -n
3859Do not build the derivations.
3860
3861@item --fallback
3862When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
3863packages locally.
3864
3865@item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
3866@anchor{client-substitute-urls}
3867Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
3868URLs, overriding the default list of URLs of @command{guix-daemon}
3869(@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @command{guix-daemon} URLs}).
3870
3871This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, provided
3872they are signed by a key authorized by the system administrator
3873(@pxref{Substitutes}).
3874
3875@item --no-substitutes
3876Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
3877locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
3878(@pxref{Substitutes}).
3879
3880@item --rounds=@var{n}
3881Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
3882consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical.
3883
3884This is a useful way to detect non-deterministic builds processes.
3885Non-deterministic build processes are a problem because they make it
3886practically impossible for users to @emph{verify} whether third-party
3887binaries are genuine. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more.
3888
3889Note that, currently, the differing build results are not kept around,
3890so you will have to manually investigate in case of an error---e.g., by
3891stashing one of the build results with @code{guix archive --export},
3892then rebuilding, and finally comparing the two results.
3893
3894@item --no-build-hook
f97c9175 3895Do not attempt to offload builds @i{via} the ``build hook'' of the daemon
ccd7158d
LC
3896(@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). That is, always build things locally
3897instead of offloading builds to remote machines.
3898
3899@item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
3900When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
3901@var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
3902
3903@item --timeout=@var{seconds}
3904Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
3905@var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
3906
3907By default there is no timeout. This behavior can be restored with
3908@code{--timeout=0}.
3909
3910@item --verbosity=@var{level}
3911Use the given verbosity level. @var{level} must be an integer between 0
3912and 5; higher means more verbose output. Setting a level of 4 or more
3913may be helpful when debugging setup issues with the build daemon.
3914
3915@item --cores=@var{n}
3916@itemx -c @var{n}
3917Allow the use of up to @var{n} CPU cores for the build. The special
3918value @code{0} means to use as many CPU cores as available.
3919
3920@item --max-jobs=@var{n}
3921@itemx -M @var{n}
3922Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. @xref{Invoking
3923guix-daemon, @code{--max-jobs}}, for details about this option and the
3924equivalent @command{guix-daemon} option.
3925
3926@end table
3927
3928Behind the scenes, @command{guix build} is essentially an interface to
3929the @code{package-derivation} procedure of the @code{(guix packages)}
3930module, and to the @code{build-derivations} procedure of the @code{(guix
3931derivations)} module.
3932
3933In addition to options explicitly passed on the command line,
3934@command{guix build} and other @command{guix} commands that support
3935building honor the @code{GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS} environment variable.
3936
3937@defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS
3938Users can define this variable to a list of command line options that
3939will automatically be used by @command{guix build} and other
3940@command{guix} commands that can perform builds, as in the example
3941below:
3942
3943@example
3944$ export GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS="--no-substitutes -c 2 -L /foo/bar"
3945@end example
3946
3947These options are parsed independently, and the result is appended to
3948the parsed command-line options.
3949@end defvr
3950
88ad6ded
LC
3951
3952@node Package Transformation Options
3953@subsection Package Transformation Options
3954
3955@cindex package variants
3956Another set of command-line options supported by @command{guix build}
b8638f03 3957and also @command{guix package} are @dfn{package transformation
f97c9175 3958options}. These are options that make it possible to define @dfn{package
b8638f03
LC
3959variants}---for instance, packages built from different source code.
3960This is a convenient way to create customized packages on the fly
3961without having to type in the definitions of package variants
3962(@pxref{Defining Packages}).
88ad6ded
LC
3963
3964@table @code
3965
3966@item --with-source=@var{source}
3967Use @var{source} as the source of the corresponding package.
3968@var{source} must be a file name or a URL, as for @command{guix
3969download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}).
3970
f97c9175
AE
3971The ``corresponding package'' is taken to be the one specified on the
3972command line the name of which matches the base of @var{source}---e.g.,
3973if @var{source} is @code{/src/guile-2.0.10.tar.gz}, the corresponding
88ad6ded 3974package is @code{guile}. Likewise, the version string is inferred from
f97c9175 3975@var{source}; in the previous example, it is @code{2.0.10}.
88ad6ded
LC
3976
3977This option allows users to try out versions of packages other than the
3978one provided by the distribution. The example below downloads
3979@file{ed-1.7.tar.gz} from a GNU mirror and uses that as the source for
3980the @code{ed} package:
3981
3982@example
3983guix build ed --with-source=mirror://gnu/ed/ed-1.7.tar.gz
3984@end example
3985
3986As a developer, @code{--with-source} makes it easy to test release
3987candidates:
3988
3989@example
3990guix build guile --with-source=../guile-2.0.9.219-e1bb7.tar.xz
3991@end example
3992
3993@dots{} or to build from a checkout in a pristine environment:
3994
3995@example
3996$ git clone git://git.sv.gnu.org/guix.git
3997$ guix build guix --with-source=./guix
3998@end example
3999
47c0f92c
LC
4000@item --with-input=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
4001Replace dependency on @var{package} by a dependency on
4002@var{replacement}. @var{package} must be a package name, and
4003@var{replacement} must be a package specification such as @code{guile}
4004or @code{guile@@1.8}.
4005
f97c9175 4006For instance, the following command builds Guix, but replaces its
47c0f92c
LC
4007dependency on the current stable version of Guile with a dependency on
4008the development version of Guile, @code{guile-next}:
4009
4010@example
4011guix build --with-input=guile=guile-next guix
4012@end example
4013
4014This is a recursive, deep replacement. So in this example, both
4015@code{guix} and its dependency @code{guile-json} (which also depends on
4016@code{guile}) get rebuilt against @code{guile-next}.
4017
4018However, implicit inputs are left unchanged.
88ad6ded
LC
4019@end table
4020
ccd7158d
LC
4021@node Additional Build Options
4022@subsection Additional Build Options
4023
4024The command-line options presented below are specific to @command{guix
4025build}.
c78bd12b
LC
4026
4027@table @code
4028
34a1783f
DT
4029@item --file=@var{file}
4030@itemx -f @var{file}
4031
4032Build the package or derivation that the code within @var{file}
4033evaluates to.
4034
4035As an example, @var{file} might contain a package definition like this
4036(@pxref{Defining Packages}):
4037
4038@example
4039@verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
4040@end example
4041
c78bd12b
LC
4042@item --expression=@var{expr}
4043@itemx -e @var{expr}
ac5de156 4044Build the package or derivation @var{expr} evaluates to.
c78bd12b 4045
5401dd75 4046For example, @var{expr} may be @code{(@@ (gnu packages guile)
c78bd12b
LC
4047guile-1.8)}, which unambiguously designates this specific variant of
4048version 1.8 of Guile.
4049
f97c9175 4050Alternatively, @var{expr} may be a G-expression, in which case it is used
56b82106
LC
4051as a build program passed to @code{gexp->derivation}
4052(@pxref{G-Expressions}).
4053
4054Lastly, @var{expr} may refer to a zero-argument monadic procedure
ac5de156
LC
4055(@pxref{The Store Monad}). The procedure must return a derivation as a
4056monadic value, which is then passed through @code{run-with-store}.
4057
c78bd12b
LC
4058@item --source
4059@itemx -S
f97c9175 4060Build the source derivations of the packages, rather than the packages
c78bd12b
LC
4061themselves.
4062
e49951eb 4063For instance, @code{guix build -S gcc} returns something like
f97c9175
AE
4064@file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2.tar.bz2}, which is the GCC
4065source tarball.
c78bd12b 4066
f9cc8971 4067The returned source tarball is the result of applying any patches and
f97c9175 4068code snippets specified in the package @code{origin} (@pxref{Defining
f9cc8971
LC
4069Packages}).
4070
2cdfe13d
EB
4071@item --sources
4072Fetch and return the source of @var{package-or-derivation} and all their
4073dependencies, recursively. This is a handy way to obtain a local copy
4074of all the source code needed to build @var{packages}, allowing you to
4075eventually build them even without network access. It is an extension
4076of the @code{--source} option and can accept one of the following
4077optional argument values:
4078
4079@table @code
4080@item package
4081This value causes the @code{--sources} option to behave in the same way
4082as the @code{--source} option.
4083
4084@item all
f97c9175
AE
4085Build the source derivations of all packages, including any source that
4086might be listed as @code{inputs}. This is the default value.
2cdfe13d
EB
4087
4088@example
4089$ guix build --sources tzdata
4090The following derivations will be built:
4091 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzdata2015b.tar.gz.drv
4092 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
4093@end example
4094
4095@item transitive
f97c9175
AE
4096Build the source derivations of all packages, as well of all transitive
4097inputs to the packages. This can be used e.g. to
2cdfe13d
EB
4098prefetch package source for later offline building.
4099
4100@example
4101$ guix build --sources=transitive tzdata
4102The following derivations will be built:
4103 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
4104 /gnu/store/@dots{}-findutils-4.4.2.tar.xz.drv
4105 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.21.tar.xz.drv
4106 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23.tar.xz.drv
4107 /gnu/store/@dots{}-make-4.1.tar.xz.drv
4108 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.tar.xz.drv
4109@dots{}
4110@end example
4111
4112@end table
4113
c78bd12b
LC
4114@item --system=@var{system}
4115@itemx -s @var{system}
4116Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
f97c9175 4117the system type of the build host.
c78bd12b
LC
4118
4119An example use of this is on Linux-based systems, which can emulate
4120different personalities. For instance, passing
4121@code{--system=i686-linux} on an @code{x86_64-linux} system allows users
4122to build packages in a complete 32-bit environment.
4123
e55ec43d
LC
4124@item --target=@var{triplet}
4125@cindex cross-compilation
4126Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
4127as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Configuration Names, GNU
4128configuration triplets,, configure, GNU Configure and Build System}).
4129
a8d65643
LC
4130@anchor{build-check}
4131@item --check
4132@cindex determinism, checking
4133@cindex reproducibility, checking
4134Rebuild @var{package-or-derivation}, which are already available in the
4135store, and raise an error if the build results are not bit-for-bit
4136identical.
4137
f97c9175
AE
4138This mechanism allows you to check whether previously installed
4139substitutes are genuine (@pxref{Substitutes}), or whether the build result
4140of a package is deterministic. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more
a8d65643
LC
4141background information and tools.
4142
05962f29
LC
4143@item --no-grafts
4144Do not ``graft'' packages. In practice, this means that package updates
4145available as grafts are not applied. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
4146information on grafts.
7f3673f2 4147
c78bd12b
LC
4148@item --derivations
4149@itemx -d
4150Return the derivation paths, not the output paths, of the given
4151packages.
4152
70ee5642
LC
4153@item --root=@var{file}
4154@itemx -r @var{file}
4155Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
4156collector root.
4157
4158@item --log-file
3f208ad7 4159Return the build log file names or URLs for the given
f97c9175 4160@var{package-or-derivation}, or raise an error if build logs are
70ee5642
LC
4161missing.
4162
4163This works regardless of how packages or derivations are specified. For
4164instance, the following invocations are equivalent:
4165
4166@example
4167guix build --log-file `guix build -d guile`
4168guix build --log-file `guix build guile`
4169guix build --log-file guile
4170guix build --log-file -e '(@@ (gnu packages guile) guile-2.0)'
4171@end example
4172
3f208ad7
LC
4173If a log is unavailable locally, and unless @code{--no-substitutes} is
4174passed, the command looks for a corresponding log on one of the
4175substitute servers (as specified with @code{--substitute-urls}.)
70ee5642 4176
f97c9175
AE
4177So for instance, imagine you want to see the build log of GDB on MIPS,
4178but you are actually on an @code{x86_64} machine:
3f208ad7
LC
4179
4180@example
4181$ guix build --log-file gdb -s mips64el-linux
4182http://hydra.gnu.org/log/@dots{}-gdb-7.10
4183@end example
4184
4185You can freely access a huge library of build logs!
70ee5642
LC
4186@end table
4187
16eb115e 4188
39bee8a2
LC
4189@node Invoking guix edit
4190@section Invoking @command{guix edit}
4191
4192@cindex package definition, editing
4193So many packages, so many source files! The @command{guix edit} command
4194facilitates the life of packagers by pointing their editor at the source
4195file containing the definition of the specified packages. For instance:
4196
4197@example
4198guix edit gcc-4.8 vim
4199@end example
4200
4201@noindent
6237b9fa
LC
4202launches the program specified in the @code{VISUAL} or in the
4203@code{EDITOR} environment variable to edit the recipe of GCC@tie{}4.8.4
4204and that of Vim.
39bee8a2 4205
f97c9175 4206If you are using Emacs, note that the Emacs user interface provides the
7c1b1ae2 4207@kbd{M-x guix-edit} command and a similar functionality in the ``package
f97c9175 4208info'' and ``package list'' buffers created by the @kbd{M-x
7c1b1ae2 4209guix-search-by-name} and similar commands (@pxref{Emacs Commands}).
39bee8a2
LC
4210
4211
210cc920
LC
4212@node Invoking guix download
4213@section Invoking @command{guix download}
4214
4215When writing a package definition, developers typically need to download
f97c9175 4216a source tarball, compute its SHA256 hash, and write that
210cc920
LC
4217hash in the package definition (@pxref{Defining Packages}). The
4218@command{guix download} tool helps with this task: it downloads a file
4219from the given URI, adds it to the store, and prints both its file name
4220in the store and its SHA256 hash.
4221
4222The fact that the downloaded file is added to the store saves bandwidth:
4223when the developer eventually tries to build the newly defined package
4224with @command{guix build}, the source tarball will not have to be
4225downloaded again because it is already in the store. It is also a
4226convenient way to temporarily stash files, which may be deleted
4227eventually (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
4228
4229The @command{guix download} command supports the same URIs as used in
4230package definitions. In particular, it supports @code{mirror://} URIs.
4231@code{https} URIs (HTTP over TLS) are supported @emph{provided} the
4232Guile bindings for GnuTLS are available in the user's environment; when
537c8bb3
LC
4233they are not available, an error is raised. @xref{Guile Preparations,
4234how to install the GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile,
4235GnuTLS-Guile}, for more information.
210cc920
LC
4236
4237The following option is available:
4238
4239@table @code
4240@item --format=@var{fmt}
4241@itemx -f @var{fmt}
4242Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}. For more
081145cf 4243information on the valid values for @var{fmt}, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}.
210cc920
LC
4244@end table
4245
6c365eca
NK
4246@node Invoking guix hash
4247@section Invoking @command{guix hash}
4248
210cc920 4249The @command{guix hash} command computes the SHA256 hash of a file.
6c365eca
NK
4250It is primarily a convenience tool for anyone contributing to the
4251distribution: it computes the cryptographic hash of a file, which can be
4252used in the definition of a package (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
4253
4254The general syntax is:
4255
4256@example
4257guix hash @var{option} @var{file}
4258@end example
4259
4260@command{guix hash} has the following option:
4261
4262@table @code
4263
4264@item --format=@var{fmt}
4265@itemx -f @var{fmt}
210cc920 4266Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}.
6c365eca
NK
4267
4268Supported formats: @code{nix-base32}, @code{base32}, @code{base16}
4269(@code{hex} and @code{hexadecimal} can be used as well).
4270
4271If the @option{--format} option is not specified, @command{guix hash}
4272will output the hash in @code{nix-base32}. This representation is used
4273in the definitions of packages.
4274
3140f2df
LC
4275@item --recursive
4276@itemx -r
4277Compute the hash on @var{file} recursively.
4278
4279In this case, the hash is computed on an archive containing @var{file},
f97c9175
AE
4280including its children if it is a directory. Some of the metadata of
4281@var{file} is part of the archive; for instance, when @var{file} is a
3140f2df 4282regular file, the hash is different depending on whether @var{file} is
f97c9175 4283executable or not. Metadata such as time stamps has no impact on the
3140f2df
LC
4284hash (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
4285@c FIXME: Replace xref above with xref to an ``Archive'' section when
4286@c it exists.
4287
6c365eca
NK
4288@end table
4289
2f7d2d91
LC
4290@node Invoking guix import
4291@section Invoking @command{guix import}
4292
4293@cindex importing packages
4294@cindex package import
4295@cindex package conversion
f97c9175
AE
4296The @command{guix import} command is useful for people who would like to
4297add a package to the distribution with as little work as
4298possible---a legitimate demand. The command knows of a few
4299repositories from which it can ``import'' package metadata. The result
2f7d2d91
LC
4300is a package definition, or a template thereof, in the format we know
4301(@pxref{Defining Packages}).
4302
4303The general syntax is:
4304
4305@example
4306guix import @var{importer} @var{options}@dots{}
4307@end example
4308
4309@var{importer} specifies the source from which to import package
f97c9175 4310metadata, and @var{options} specifies a package identifier and other
2f7d2d91
LC
4311options specific to @var{importer}. Currently, the available
4312``importers'' are:
4313
4314@table @code
4315@item gnu
f97c9175 4316Import metadata for the given GNU package. This provides a template
2f7d2d91
LC
4317for the latest version of that GNU package, including the hash of its
4318source tarball, and its canonical synopsis and description.
4319
f97c9175 4320Additional information such as the package dependencies and its
2f7d2d91
LC
4321license needs to be figured out manually.
4322
4323For example, the following command returns a package definition for
4324GNU@tie{}Hello:
4325
4326@example
4327guix import gnu hello
4328@end example
4329
4330Specific command-line options are:
4331
4332@table @code
4333@item --key-download=@var{policy}
4334As for @code{guix refresh}, specify the policy to handle missing OpenPGP
f97c9175 4335keys when verifying the package signature. @xref{Invoking guix
2f7d2d91
LC
4336refresh, @code{--key-download}}.
4337@end table
4338
4339@item pypi
4340@cindex pypi
f97c9175 4341Import metadata from the @uref{https://pypi.python.org/, Python Package
2f7d2d91
LC
4342Index}@footnote{This functionality requires Guile-JSON to be installed.
4343@xref{Requirements}.}. Information is taken from the JSON-formatted
4344description available at @code{pypi.python.org} and usually includes all
4345the relevant information, including package dependencies.
4346
f97c9175 4347The command below imports metadata for the @code{itsdangerous} Python
2f7d2d91
LC
4348package:
4349
4350@example
4351guix import pypi itsdangerous
4352@end example
4353
3aae8145
DT
4354@item gem
4355@cindex gem
f97c9175 4356Import metadata from @uref{https://rubygems.org/,
3aae8145
DT
4357RubyGems}@footnote{This functionality requires Guile-JSON to be
4358installed. @xref{Requirements}.}. Information is taken from the
4359JSON-formatted description available at @code{rubygems.org} and includes
4360most relevant information, including runtime dependencies. There are
f97c9175 4361some caveats, however. The metadata doesn't distinguish between
3aae8145
DT
4362synopses and descriptions, so the same string is used for both fields.
4363Additionally, the details of non-Ruby dependencies required to build
4364native extensions is unavailable and left as an exercise to the
4365packager.
4366
f97c9175 4367The command below imports metadata for the @code{rails} Ruby package:
3aae8145
DT
4368
4369@example
4370guix import gem rails
4371@end example
4372
d45dc6da
EB
4373@item cpan
4374@cindex CPAN
f97c9175
AE
4375Import metadata from @uref{https://www.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN}.
4376Information is taken from the JSON-formatted metadata provided through
d45dc6da 4377@uref{https://api.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN's API} and includes most
66392e47
EB
4378relevant information, such as module dependencies. License information
4379should be checked closely. If Perl is available in the store, then the
4380@code{corelist} utility will be used to filter core modules out of the
4381list of dependencies.
d45dc6da 4382
f97c9175 4383The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Acme::Boolean}
d45dc6da
EB
4384Perl module:
4385
4386@example
4387guix import cpan Acme::Boolean
4388@end example
4389
e1248602
RW
4390@item cran
4391@cindex CRAN
d0bd632f 4392@cindex Bioconductor
f97c9175 4393Import metadata from @uref{http://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN}, the
e1248602
RW
4394central repository for the @uref{http://r-project.org, GNU@tie{}R
4395statistical and graphical environment}.
4396
f97c9175 4397Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file of the package.
e1248602 4398
f97c9175 4399The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Cairo}
e1248602
RW
4400R package:
4401
4402@example
4403guix import cran Cairo
4404@end example
4405
f97c9175 4406When @code{--archive=bioconductor} is added, metadata is imported from
d0bd632f
RW
4407@uref{http://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor}, a repository of R
4408packages for for the analysis and comprehension of high-throughput
4409genomic data in bioinformatics.
4410
f97c9175 4411Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file of a package
d0bd632f
RW
4412published on the web interface of the Bioconductor SVN repository.
4413
f97c9175 4414The command below imports metadata for the @code{GenomicRanges}
d0bd632f
RW
4415R package:
4416
4417@example
4418guix import cran --archive=bioconductor GenomicRanges
4419@end example
4420
2f7d2d91 4421@item nix
f97c9175 4422Import metadata from a local copy of the source of the
2f7d2d91
LC
4423@uref{http://nixos.org/nixpkgs/, Nixpkgs distribution}@footnote{This
4424relies on the @command{nix-instantiate} command of
4425@uref{http://nixos.org/nix/, Nix}.}. Package definitions in Nixpkgs are
4426typically written in a mixture of Nix-language and Bash code. This
4427command only imports the high-level package structure that is written in
4428the Nix language. It normally includes all the basic fields of a
4429package definition.
4430
4431When importing a GNU package, the synopsis and descriptions are replaced
4432by their canonical upstream variant.
4433
961d0d2d
LC
4434Usually, you will first need to do:
4435
4436@example
4437export NIX_REMOTE=daemon
4438@end example
4439
4440@noindent
4441so that @command{nix-instantiate} does not try to open the Nix database.
4442
2f7d2d91
LC
4443As an example, the command below imports the package definition of
4444LibreOffice (more precisely, it imports the definition of the package
4445bound to the @code{libreoffice} top-level attribute):
4446
4447@example
4448guix import nix ~/path/to/nixpkgs libreoffice
4449@end example
863af4e1
FB
4450
4451@item hackage
4452@cindex hackage
f97c9175 4453Import metadata from the Haskell community's central package archive
863af4e1
FB
4454@uref{https://hackage.haskell.org/, Hackage}. Information is taken from
4455Cabal files and includes all the relevant information, including package
4456dependencies.
4457
4458Specific command-line options are:
4459
4460@table @code
a4154748
FB
4461@item --stdin
4462@itemx -s
f97c9175 4463Read a Cabal file from standard input.
863af4e1
FB
4464@item --no-test-dependencies
4465@itemx -t
f97c9175 4466Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
a4154748
FB
4467@item --cabal-environment=@var{alist}
4468@itemx -e @var{alist}
4469@var{alist} is a Scheme alist defining the environment in which the
4470Cabal conditionals are evaluated. The accepted keys are: @code{os},
4471@code{arch}, @code{impl} and a string representing the name of a flag.
4472The value associated with a flag has to be either the symbol
4473@code{true} or @code{false}. The value associated with other keys
4474has to conform to the Cabal file format definition. The default value
4475associated with the keys @code{os}, @code{arch} and @code{impl} is
f97c9175 4476@samp{linux}, @samp{x86_64} and @samp{ghc}, respectively.
863af4e1
FB
4477@end table
4478
f97c9175 4479The command below imports metadata for the latest version of the
a4154748
FB
4480@code{HTTP} Haskell package without including test dependencies and
4481specifying the value of the flag @samp{network-uri} as @code{false}:
863af4e1
FB
4482
4483@example
a4154748 4484guix import hackage -t -e "'((\"network-uri\" . false))" HTTP
863af4e1
FB
4485@end example
4486
4487A specific package version may optionally be specified by following the
4488package name by a hyphen and a version number as in the following example:
4489
4490@example
4491guix import hackage mtl-2.1.3.1
4492@end example
7f74a931
FB
4493
4494@item elpa
4495@cindex elpa
f97c9175 4496Import metadata from an Emacs Lisp Package Archive (ELPA) package
7f74a931
FB
4497repository (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
4498
4499Specific command-line options are:
4500
4501@table @code
4502@item --archive=@var{repo}
4503@itemx -a @var{repo}
4504@var{repo} identifies the archive repository from which to retrieve the
4505information. Currently the supported repositories and their identifiers
4506are:
4507@itemize -
4508@item
840bd1d3 4509@uref{http://elpa.gnu.org/packages, GNU}, selected by the @code{gnu}
7f74a931
FB
4510identifier. This is the default.
4511
4512@item
840bd1d3 4513@uref{http://stable.melpa.org/packages, MELPA-Stable}, selected by the
7f74a931
FB
4514@code{melpa-stable} identifier.
4515
4516@item
840bd1d3 4517@uref{http://melpa.org/packages, MELPA}, selected by the @code{melpa}
7f74a931
FB
4518identifier.
4519@end itemize
4520@end table
2f7d2d91
LC
4521@end table
4522
4523The structure of the @command{guix import} code is modular. It would be
4524useful to have more importers for other package formats, and your help
4525is welcome here (@pxref{Contributing}).
4526
37166310
LC
4527@node Invoking guix refresh
4528@section Invoking @command{guix refresh}
4529
4530The primary audience of the @command{guix refresh} command is developers
4531of the GNU software distribution. By default, it reports any packages
4532provided by the distribution that are outdated compared to the latest
4533upstream version, like this:
4534
4535@example
4536$ guix refresh
4537gnu/packages/gettext.scm:29:13: gettext would be upgraded from 0.18.1.1 to 0.18.2.1
4538gnu/packages/glib.scm:77:12: glib would be upgraded from 2.34.3 to 2.37.0
4539@end example
4540
f97c9175
AE
4541It does so by browsing the FTP directory of each package and determining
4542the highest version number of the source tarballs therein. The command
bcb571cb
LC
4543knows how to update specific types of packages: GNU packages, ELPA
4544packages, etc.---see the documentation for @option{--type} below. The
4545are many packages, though, for which it lacks a method to determine
4546whether a new upstream release is available. However, the mechanism is
4547extensible, so feel free to get in touch with us to add a new method!
37166310
LC
4548
4549When passed @code{--update}, it modifies distribution source files to
f97c9175 4550update the version numbers and source tarball hashes of those package
37166310
LC
4551recipes (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This is achieved by downloading
4552each package's latest source tarball and its associated OpenPGP
4553signature, authenticating the downloaded tarball against its signature
4554using @command{gpg}, and finally computing its hash. When the public
4555key used to sign the tarball is missing from the user's keyring, an
4556attempt is made to automatically retrieve it from a public key server;
f97c9175 4557when this is successful, the key is added to the user's keyring; otherwise,
37166310
LC
4558@command{guix refresh} reports an error.
4559
4560The following options are supported:
4561
4562@table @code
4563
2d7fc7da
LC
4564@item --expression=@var{expr}
4565@itemx -e @var{expr}
4566Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
4567
4568This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
4569
4570@example
4571guix refresh -l -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) glibc-final)'
4572@end example
4573
4574This command lists the dependents of the ``final'' libc (essentially all
4575the packages.)
4576
37166310
LC
4577@item --update
4578@itemx -u
38e16b49
LC
4579Update distribution source files (package recipes) in place. This is
4580usually run from a checkout of the Guix source tree (@pxref{Running
4581Guix Before It Is Installed}):
4582
4583@example
4584$ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -s non-core
4585@end example
4586
081145cf 4587@xref{Defining Packages}, for more information on package definitions.
37166310
LC
4588
4589@item --select=[@var{subset}]
4590@itemx -s @var{subset}
4591Select all the packages in @var{subset}, one of @code{core} or
4592@code{non-core}.
4593
4594The @code{core} subset refers to all the packages at the core of the
4595distribution---i.e., packages that are used to build ``everything
4596else''. This includes GCC, libc, Binutils, Bash, etc. Usually,
4597changing one of these packages in the distribution entails a rebuild of
4598all the others. Thus, such updates are an inconvenience to users in
4599terms of build time or bandwidth used to achieve the upgrade.
4600
4601The @code{non-core} subset refers to the remaining packages. It is
4602typically useful in cases where an update of the core packages would be
4603inconvenient.
4604
bcb571cb
LC
4605@item --type=@var{updater}
4606@itemx -t @var{updater}
7191adc5
AK
4607Select only packages handled by @var{updater} (may be a comma-separated
4608list of updaters). Currently, @var{updater} may be one of:
bcb571cb
LC
4609
4610@table @code
4611@item gnu
4612the updater for GNU packages;
e80c0f85
LC
4613@item gnome
4614the updater for GNOME packages;
bcb571cb 4615@item elpa
d882c235
LC
4616the updater for @uref{http://elpa.gnu.org/, ELPA} packages;
4617@item cran
b9d044ef 4618the updater for @uref{http://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN} packages;
d0bd632f
RW
4619@item bioconductor
4620the updater for @uref{http://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor} R packages;
bab020d7 4621@item pypi
b9d044ef 4622the updater for @uref{https://pypi.python.org, PyPI} packages.
bcb571cb
LC
4623@end table
4624
f97c9175
AE
4625For instance, the following command only checks for updates of Emacs
4626packages hosted at @code{elpa.gnu.org} and for updates of CRAN packages:
bcb571cb
LC
4627
4628@example
7191adc5 4629$ guix refresh --type=elpa,cran
d882c235 4630gnu/packages/statistics.scm:819:13: r-testthat would be upgraded from 0.10.0 to 0.11.0
bcb571cb
LC
4631gnu/packages/emacs.scm:856:13: emacs-auctex would be upgraded from 11.88.6 to 11.88.9
4632@end example
4633
37166310
LC
4634@end table
4635
4636In addition, @command{guix refresh} can be passed one or more package
4637names, as in this example:
4638
4639@example
38e16b49 4640$ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u emacs idutils gcc-4.8.4
37166310
LC
4641@end example
4642
4643@noindent
4644The command above specifically updates the @code{emacs} and
4645@code{idutils} packages. The @code{--select} option would have no
4646effect in this case.
4647
7d193ec3
EB
4648When considering whether to upgrade a package, it is sometimes
4649convenient to know which packages would be affected by the upgrade and
4650should be checked for compatibility. For this the following option may
4651be used when passing @command{guix refresh} one or more package names:
4652
4653@table @code
4654
6ffa706b
AK
4655@item --list-updaters
4656@itemx -L
4657List available updaters and exit (see @option{--type} above.)
4658
7d193ec3
EB
4659@item --list-dependent
4660@itemx -l
4661List top-level dependent packages that would need to be rebuilt as a
4662result of upgrading one or more packages.
4663
4664@end table
4665
4666Be aware that the @code{--list-dependent} option only
4667@emph{approximates} the rebuilds that would be required as a result of
4668an upgrade. More rebuilds might be required under some circumstances.
4669
4670@example
7779ab61
LC
4671$ guix refresh --list-dependent flex
4672Building the following 120 packages would ensure 213 dependent packages are rebuilt:
4673hop-2.4.0 geiser-0.4 notmuch-0.18 mu-0.9.9.5 cflow-1.4 idutils-4.6 @dots{}
7d193ec3
EB
4674@end example
4675
4676The command above lists a set of packages that could be built to check
4677for compatibility with an upgraded @code{flex} package.
4678
f9230085
LC
4679The following options can be used to customize GnuPG operation:
4680
4681@table @code
4682
f9230085
LC
4683@item --gpg=@var{command}
4684Use @var{command} as the GnuPG 2.x command. @var{command} is searched
4685for in @code{$PATH}.
4686
2bc53ba9
LC
4687@item --key-download=@var{policy}
4688Handle missing OpenPGP keys according to @var{policy}, which may be one
4689of:
4690
4691@table @code
4692@item always
4693Always download missing OpenPGP keys from the key server, and add them
4694to the user's GnuPG keyring.
4695
4696@item never
4697Never try to download missing OpenPGP keys. Instead just bail out.
4698
4699@item interactive
4700When a package signed with an unknown OpenPGP key is encountered, ask
4701the user whether to download it or not. This is the default behavior.
4702@end table
4703
4704@item --key-server=@var{host}
4705Use @var{host} as the OpenPGP key server when importing a public key.
4706
f9230085
LC
4707@end table
4708
b4f5e0e8
CR
4709@node Invoking guix lint
4710@section Invoking @command{guix lint}
f97c9175
AE
4711The @command{guix lint} command is meant to help package developers avoid
4712common errors and use a consistent style. It runs a number of checks on
4713a given set of packages in order to find common mistakes in their
873c4085
LC
4714definitions. Available @dfn{checkers} include (see
4715@code{--list-checkers} for a complete list):
4716
4717@table @code
4718@item synopsis
4719@itemx description
4720Validate certain typographical and stylistic rules about package
4721descriptions and synopses.
4722
4723@item inputs-should-be-native
4724Identify inputs that should most likely be native inputs.
4725
4726@item source
4727@itemx home-page
50f5c46d 4728@itemx source-file-name
873c4085 4729Probe @code{home-page} and @code{source} URLs and report those that are
50f5c46d 4730invalid. Check that the source file name is meaningful, e.g. is not
f97c9175
AE
4731just a version number or ``git-checkout'', without a declared
4732@code{file-name} (@pxref{origin Reference}).
40a7d4e5 4733
5432734b
LC
4734@item cve
4735Report known vulnerabilities found in the Common Vulnerabilities and
4736Exposures (CVE) database
4737@uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/download.cfm#CVE_FEED, published by the US
4738NIST}.
4739
40a7d4e5
LC
4740@item formatting
4741Warn about obvious source code formatting issues: trailing white space,
4742use of tabulations, etc.
873c4085 4743@end table
b4f5e0e8
CR
4744
4745The general syntax is:
4746
4747@example
4748guix lint @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
4749@end example
4750
4751If no package is given on the command line, then all packages are checked.
4752The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
4753
4754@table @code
f97c9175
AE
4755@item --list-checkers
4756@itemx -l
4757List and describe all the available checkers that will be run on packages
4758and exit.
b4f5e0e8 4759
dd7c013d
CR
4760@item --checkers
4761@itemx -c
4762Only enable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
4763names returned by @code{--list-checkers}.
4764
b4f5e0e8 4765@end table
37166310 4766
fcc58db6
LC
4767@node Invoking guix size
4768@section Invoking @command{guix size}
4769
4770The @command{guix size} command helps package developers profile the
4771disk usage of packages. It is easy to overlook the impact of an
4772additional dependency added to a package, or the impact of using a
4773single output for a package that could easily be split (@pxref{Packages
f97c9175 4774with Multiple Outputs}). Such are the typical issues that
fcc58db6
LC
4775@command{guix size} can highlight.
4776
4777The command can be passed a package specification such as @code{gcc-4.8}
4778or @code{guile:debug}, or a file name in the store. Consider this
4779example:
4780
4781@example
4782$ guix size coreutils
4783store item total self
4784/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23 70.0 13.9 19.8%
4785/gnu/store/@dots{}-gmp-6.0.0a 55.3 2.5 3.6%
4786/gnu/store/@dots{}-acl-2.2.52 53.7 0.5 0.7%
4787/gnu/store/@dots{}-attr-2.4.46 53.2 0.3 0.5%
4788/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.4-lib 52.9 15.7 22.4%
4789/gnu/store/@dots{}-glibc-2.21 37.2 37.2 53.1%
4790@end example
4791
4792@cindex closure
4793The store items listed here constitute the @dfn{transitive closure} of
4794Coreutils---i.e., Coreutils and all its dependencies, recursively---as
4795would be returned by:
4796
4797@example
4798$ guix gc -R /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23
4799@end example
4800
f97c9175 4801Here the output shows three columns next to store items. The first column,
fcc58db6
LC
4802labeled ``total'', shows the size in mebibytes (MiB) of the closure of
4803the store item---that is, its own size plus the size of all its
4804dependencies. The next column, labeled ``self'', shows the size of the
f97c9175
AE
4805item itself. The last column shows the ratio of the size of the item
4806itself to the space occupied by all the items listed here.
fcc58db6
LC
4807
4808In this example, we see that the closure of Coreutils weighs in at
480970@tie{}MiB, half of which is taken by libc. (That libc represents a
4810large fraction of the closure is not a problem @i{per se} because it is
4811always available on the system anyway.)
4812
4813When the package passed to @command{guix size} is available in the
4814store, @command{guix size} queries the daemon to determine its
4815dependencies, and measures its size in the store, similar to @command{du
4816-ms --apparent-size} (@pxref{du invocation,,, coreutils, GNU
4817Coreutils}).
4818
4819When the given package is @emph{not} in the store, @command{guix size}
f97c9175
AE
4820reports information based on the available substitutes
4821(@pxref{Substitutes}). This makes it possible it to profile disk usage of
4822store items that are not even on disk, only available remotely.
fcc58db6 4823
a8f996c6 4824The available options are:
fcc58db6
LC
4825
4826@table @option
4827
d490d06e
LC
4828@item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
4829Use substitute information from @var{urls}.
4830@xref{client-substitute-urls, the same option for @code{guix build}}.
4831
a8f996c6 4832@item --map-file=@var{file}
f97c9175 4833Write a graphical map of disk usage in PNG format to @var{file}.
a8f996c6
LC
4834
4835For the example above, the map looks like this:
4836
4837@image{images/coreutils-size-map,5in,, map of Coreutils disk usage
4838produced by @command{guix size}}
4839
4840This option requires that
4841@uref{http://wingolog.org/software/guile-charting/, Guile-Charting} be
4842installed and visible in Guile's module search path. When that is not
4843the case, @command{guix size} fails as it tries to load it.
4844
fcc58db6
LC
4845@item --system=@var{system}
4846@itemx -s @var{system}
4847Consider packages for @var{system}---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
4848
4849@end table
4850
88856916
LC
4851@node Invoking guix graph
4852@section Invoking @command{guix graph}
4853
4854@cindex DAG
4855Packages and their dependencies form a @dfn{graph}, specifically a
4856directed acyclic graph (DAG). It can quickly become difficult to have a
f97c9175
AE
4857mental model of the package DAG, so the @command{guix graph} command
4858provides a visual representation of the DAG. @command{guix graph}
4859emits a DAG representation in the input format of
88856916 4860@uref{http://www.graphviz.org/, Graphviz}, so its output can be passed
f97c9175 4861directly to the @command{dot} command of Graphviz. The general
88856916
LC
4862syntax is:
4863
4864@example
4865guix graph @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
4866@end example
4867
4868For example, the following command generates a PDF file representing the
4869package DAG for the GNU@tie{}Core Utilities, showing its build-time
4870dependencies:
4871
4872@example
4873guix graph coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
4874@end example
4875
4876The output looks like this:
4877
4878@image{images/coreutils-graph,2in,,Dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
4879
4880Nice little graph, no?
4881
f97c9175 4882But there is more than one graph! The one above is concise: it is the
88856916 4883graph of package objects, omitting implicit inputs such as GCC, libc,
f97c9175
AE
4884grep, etc. It is often useful to have such a concise graph, but
4885sometimes one may want to see more details. @command{guix graph} supports
4886several types of graphs, allowing you to choose the level of detail:
88856916
LC
4887
4888@table @code
4889@item package
f97c9175 4890This is the default type used in the example above. It shows the DAG of
88856916
LC
4891package objects, excluding implicit dependencies. It is concise, but
4892filters out many details.
4893
4894@item bag-emerged
4895This is the package DAG, @emph{including} implicit inputs.
4896
4897For instance, the following command:
4898
4899@example
4900guix graph --type=bag-emerged coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
4901@end example
4902
4903... yields this bigger graph:
4904
4905@image{images/coreutils-bag-graph,,5in,Detailed dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
4906
4907At the bottom of the graph, we see all the implicit inputs of
4908@var{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
4909
f97c9175 4910Now, note that the dependencies of these implicit inputs---that is, the
88856916
LC
4911@dfn{bootstrap dependencies} (@pxref{Bootstrapping})---are not shown
4912here, for conciseness.
4913
4914@item bag
4915Similar to @code{bag-emerged}, but this time including all the bootstrap
4916dependencies.
4917
38b92daa
LC
4918@item bag-with-origins
4919Similar to @code{bag}, but also showing origins and their dependencies.
4920
88856916
LC
4921@item derivations
4922This is the most detailed representation: It shows the DAG of
4923derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) and plain store items. Compared to
4924the above representation, many additional nodes are visible, including
f97c9175 4925build scripts, patches, Guile modules, etc.
88856916
LC
4926
4927@end table
4928
f97c9175 4929All the types above correspond to @emph{build-time dependencies}. The
88856916
LC
4930following graph type represents the @emph{run-time dependencies}:
4931
4932@table @code
4933@item references
4934This is the graph of @dfn{references} of a package output, as returned
4935by @command{guix gc --references} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
4936
4937If the given package output is not available in the store, @command{guix
4938graph} attempts to obtain dependency information from substitutes.
4939@end table
4940
4941The available options are the following:
4942
4943@table @option
4944@item --type=@var{type}
4945@itemx -t @var{type}
4946Produce a graph output of @var{type}, where @var{type} must be one of
4947the values listed above.
4948
4949@item --list-types
4950List the supported graph types.
4c8f997a
LC
4951
4952@item --expression=@var{expr}
4953@itemx -e @var{expr}
4954Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
4955
4956This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
4957
4958@example
4959guix graph -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) gnu-make-final)'
4960@end example
88856916
LC
4961@end table
4962
4963
372c4bbc
DT
4964@node Invoking guix environment
4965@section Invoking @command{guix environment}
4966
f5fd4fd2 4967@cindex reproducible build environments
fe36d84e 4968@cindex development environments
372c4bbc
DT
4969The purpose of @command{guix environment} is to assist hackers in
4970creating reproducible development environments without polluting their
4971package profile. The @command{guix environment} tool takes one or more
f97c9175 4972packages, builds all of their inputs, and creates a shell
372c4bbc
DT
4973environment to use them.
4974
4975The general syntax is:
4976
4977@example
4978guix environment @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
4979@end example
4980
fe36d84e
LC
4981The following example spawns a new shell set up for the development of
4982GNU@tie{}Guile:
372c4bbc
DT
4983
4984@example
4985guix environment guile
4986@end example
4987
f97c9175
AE
4988If the needed dependencies are not built yet, @command{guix environment}
4989automatically builds them. The environment of the new shell is an augmented
372c4bbc
DT
4990version of the environment that @command{guix environment} was run in.
4991It contains the necessary search paths for building the given package
4992added to the existing environment variables. To create a ``pure''
f97c9175 4993environment, in which the original environment variables have been unset,
50500f7c
LC
4994use the @code{--pure} option@footnote{Users sometimes wrongfully augment
4995environment variables such as @code{PATH} in their @file{~/.bashrc}
4996file. As a consequence, when @code{guix environment} launches it, Bash
4997may read @file{~/.bashrc}, thereby introducing ``impurities'' in these
4998environment variables. It is an error to define such environment
4999variables in @file{.bashrc}; instead, they should be defined in
5000@file{.bash_profile}, which is sourced only by log-in shells.
5001@xref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}, for
5002details on Bash start-up files.}.
372c4bbc 5003
28de8d25
LC
5004@vindex GUIX_ENVIRONMENT
5005@command{guix environment} defines the @code{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT}
f97c9175 5006variable in the shell it spawns. This allows users to, say, define a
28de8d25
LC
5007specific prompt for development environments in their @file{.bashrc}
5008(@pxref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}):
5009
5010@example
5011if [ -n "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT" ]
5012then
5013 export PS1="\u@@\h \w [dev]\$ "
5014fi
5015@end example
5016
372c4bbc
DT
5017Additionally, more than one package may be specified, in which case the
5018union of the inputs for the given packages are used. For example, the
5019command below spawns a shell where all of the dependencies of both Guile
5020and Emacs are available:
5021
5022@example
5023guix environment guile emacs
5024@end example
5025
1de2fe95
DT
5026Sometimes an interactive shell session is not desired. An arbitrary
5027command may be invoked by placing the @code{--} token to separate the
5028command from the rest of the arguments:
372c4bbc
DT
5029
5030@example
1de2fe95 5031guix environment guile -- make -j4
372c4bbc
DT
5032@end example
5033
fe36d84e
LC
5034In other situations, it is more convenient to specify the list of
5035packages needed in the environment. For example, the following command
5036runs @command{python} from an environment containing Python@tie{}2.7 and
5037NumPy:
5038
5039@example
1de2fe95 5040guix environment --ad-hoc python2-numpy python-2.7 -- python
fe36d84e
LC
5041@end example
5042
cc90fbbf
DT
5043Furthermore, one might want the dependencies of a package and also some
5044additional packages that are not build-time or runtime dependencies, but
5045are useful when developing nonetheless. Because of this, the
5046@code{--ad-hoc} flag is positional. Packages appearing before
5047@code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be
5048added to the environment. Packages appearing after are interpreted as
5049packages that will be added to the environment directly. For example,
5050the following command creates a Guix development environment that
5051additionally includes Git and strace:
5052
5053@example
5054guix environment guix --ad-hoc git strace
5055@end example
5056
f535dcbe
DT
5057Sometimes it is desirable to isolate the environment as much as
5058possible, for maximal purity and reproducibility. In particular, when
5059using Guix on a host distro that is not GuixSD, it is desirable to
5060prevent access to @file{/usr/bin} and other system-wide resources from
5061the development environment. For example, the following command spawns
5062a Guile REPL in a ``container'' where only the store and the current
5063working directory are mounted:
5064
5065@example
5066guix environment --ad-hoc --container guile -- guile
5067@end example
5068
0f252e26 5069@quotation Note
cfd35b4e 5070The @code{--container} option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
0f252e26
DT
5071@end quotation
5072
fe36d84e 5073The available options are summarized below.
372c4bbc
DT
5074
5075@table @code
5076@item --expression=@var{expr}
5077@itemx -e @var{expr}
c9c282ce
DT
5078Create an environment for the package or list of packages that
5079@var{expr} evaluates to.
372c4bbc 5080
fe36d84e
LC
5081For example, running:
5082
5083@example
5084guix environment -e '(@@ (gnu packages maths) petsc-openmpi)'
5085@end example
5086
5087starts a shell with the environment for this specific variant of the
5088PETSc package.
5089
c9c282ce
DT
5090Running:
5091
5092@example
5c2b2f00 5093guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(@@ (gnu) %base-packages)'
c9c282ce
DT
5094@end example
5095
5096starts a shell with all the GuixSD base packages available.
5097
779aa003
DT
5098The above commands only the use default output of the given packages.
5099To select other outputs, two element tuples can be specified:
5100
5101@example
5102guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(list (@ (gnu packages bash) bash) "include")'
5103@end example
5104
372c4bbc
DT
5105@item --load=@var{file}
5106@itemx -l @var{file}
c9c282ce
DT
5107Create an environment for the package or list of packages that the code
5108within @var{file} evaluates to.
372c4bbc 5109
fe36d84e
LC
5110As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
5111(@pxref{Defining Packages}):
5112
5113@example
5114@verbatiminclude environment-gdb.scm
5115@end example
5116
a54bd6d7
DT
5117@item --ad-hoc
5118Include all specified packages in the resulting environment, as if an
5119@i{ad hoc} package were defined with them as inputs. This option is
5120useful for quickly creating an environment without having to write a
5121package expression to contain the desired inputs.
5122
5123For instance, the command:
5124
5125@example
1de2fe95 5126guix environment --ad-hoc guile guile-sdl -- guile
a54bd6d7
DT
5127@end example
5128
5129runs @command{guile} in an environment where Guile and Guile-SDL are
5130available.
5131
417c39f1 5132Note that this example implicitly asks for the default output of
f97c9175 5133@code{guile} and @code{guile-sdl}, but it is possible to ask for a
417c39f1
LC
5134specific output---e.g., @code{glib:bin} asks for the @code{bin} output
5135of @code{glib} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
5136
cc90fbbf
DT
5137This option may be composed with the default behavior of @command{guix
5138environment}. Packages appearing before @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted
5139as packages whose dependencies will be added to the environment, the
5140default behavior. Packages appearing after are interpreted as packages
5141that will be added to the environment directly.
5142
372c4bbc
DT
5143@item --pure
5144Unset existing environment variables when building the new environment.
5145This has the effect of creating an environment in which search paths
5146only contain package inputs.
5147
5148@item --search-paths
5149Display the environment variable definitions that make up the
5150environment.
ce367ef3
LC
5151
5152@item --system=@var{system}
5153@itemx -s @var{system}
5154Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
f535dcbe
DT
5155
5156@item --container
5157@itemx -C
5158@cindex container
5159Run @var{command} within an isolated container. The current working
56b6befb 5160directory outside the container is mapped inside the
f535dcbe
DT
5161container. Additionally, the spawned process runs as the current user
5162outside the container, but has root privileges in the context of the
5163container.
5164
5165@item --network
5166@itemx -N
5167For containers, share the network namespace with the host system.
5168Containers created without this flag only have access to the loopback
5169device.
5170
5171@item --expose=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
5172For containers, expose the file system @var{source} from the host system
5173as the read-only file system @var{target} within the container. If
5174@var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
5175point in the container.
5176
5177The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
5178home directory is accessible read-only via the @file{/exchange}
5179directory:
5180
5181@example
5182guix environment --container --expose=$HOME=/exchange guile -- guile
5183@end example
5184
5c2b2f00 5185@item --share=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
f535dcbe
DT
5186For containers, share the file system @var{source} from the host system
5187as the writable file system @var{target} within the container. If
5188@var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
5189point in the container.
5190
5191The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
5192home directory is accessible for both reading and writing via the
5193@file{/exchange} directory:
5194
5195@example
5196guix environment --container --share=$HOME=/exchange guile -- guile
5197@end example
372c4bbc
DT
5198@end table
5199
5200It also supports all of the common build options that @command{guix
ccd7158d 5201build} supports (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
372c4bbc 5202
aff8ce7c
DT
5203@node Invoking guix publish
5204@section Invoking @command{guix publish}
5205
5206The purpose of @command{guix publish} is to enable users to easily share
f97c9175 5207their store with others, who can then use it as a substitute server
8ce229fc
LC
5208(@pxref{Substitutes}).
5209
5210When @command{guix publish} runs, it spawns an HTTP server which allows
5211anyone with network access to obtain substitutes from it. This means
5212that any machine running Guix can also act as if it were a build farm,
5213since the HTTP interface is compatible with Hydra, the software behind
5214the @code{hydra.gnu.org} build farm.
aff8ce7c
DT
5215
5216For security, each substitute is signed, allowing recipients to check
5217their authenticity and integrity (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because
f97c9175 5218@command{guix publish} uses the signing key of the system, which is only
5463fe51
LC
5219readable by the system administrator, it must be started as root; the
5220@code{--user} option makes it drop root privileges early on.
aff8ce7c 5221
b18812b6
LC
5222The signing key pair must be generated before @command{guix publish} is
5223launched, using @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
5224guix archive}).
5225
aff8ce7c
DT
5226The general syntax is:
5227
5228@example
5229guix publish @var{options}@dots{}
5230@end example
5231
5232Running @command{guix publish} without any additional arguments will
5233spawn an HTTP server on port 8080:
5234
5235@example
5236guix publish
5237@end example
5238
5239Once a publishing server has been authorized (@pxref{Invoking guix
5240archive}), the daemon may download substitutes from it:
5241
5242@example
5243guix-daemon --substitute-urls=http://example.org:8080
5244@end example
5245
5246The following options are available:
5247
5248@table @code
5249@item --port=@var{port}
5250@itemx -p @var{port}
5251Listen for HTTP requests on @var{port}.
5252
9e2292ef
LC
5253@item --listen=@var{host}
5254Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
5255accept connections from any interface.
5256
5463fe51
LC
5257@item --user=@var{user}
5258@itemx -u @var{user}
5259Change privileges to @var{user} as soon as possible---i.e., once the
5260server socket is open and the signing key has been read.
5261
aff8ce7c
DT
5262@item --repl[=@var{port}]
5263@itemx -r [@var{port}]
5264Spawn a Guile REPL server (@pxref{REPL Servers,,, guile, GNU Guile
8ce229fc
LC
5265Reference Manual}) on @var{port} (37146 by default). This is used
5266primarily for debugging a running @command{guix publish} server.
aff8ce7c
DT
5267@end table
5268
1c52181f
LC
5269Enabling @command{guix publish} on a GuixSD system is a one-liner: just
5270add a call to @code{guix-publish-service} in the @code{services} field
5271of the @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{guix-publish-service,
5272@code{guix-publish-service}}).
5273
d23c20f1
LC
5274
5275@node Invoking guix challenge
5276@section Invoking @command{guix challenge}
5277
5278@cindex reproducible builds
5279@cindex verifiable builds
5280
5281Do the binaries provided by this server really correspond to the source
f97c9175 5282code it claims to build? Is a package build process deterministic?
d23c20f1
LC
5283These are the questions the @command{guix challenge} command attempts to
5284answer.
5285
5286The former is obviously an important question: Before using a substitute
f97c9175 5287server (@pxref{Substitutes}), one had better @emph{verify} that it
d23c20f1
LC
5288provides the right binaries, and thus @emph{challenge} it. The latter
5289is what enables the former: If package builds are deterministic, then
5290independent builds of the package should yield the exact same result,
5291bit for bit; if a server provides a binary different from the one
5292obtained locally, it may be either corrupt or malicious.
5293
5294We know that the hash that shows up in @file{/gnu/store} file names is
5295the hash of all the inputs of the process that built the file or
5296directory---compilers, libraries, build scripts,
5297etc. (@pxref{Introduction}). Assuming deterministic build processes,
5298one store file name should map to exactly one build output.
5299@command{guix challenge} checks whether there is, indeed, a single
5300mapping by comparing the build outputs of several independent builds of
5301any given store item.
5302
f97c9175 5303The command output looks like this:
d23c20f1
LC
5304
5305@smallexample
5306$ guix challenge --substitute-urls="http://hydra.gnu.org http://guix.example.org"
5307updating list of substitutes from 'http://hydra.gnu.org'... 100.0%
5308updating list of substitutes from 'http://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
5309/gnu/store/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d contents differ:
5310 local hash: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
5311 http://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
5312 http://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 1zy4fmaaqcnjrzzajkdn3f5gmjk754b43qkq47llbyak9z0qjyim
5313/gnu/store/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 contents differ:
5314 local hash: 00p3bmryhjxrhpn2gxs2fy0a15lnip05l97205pgbk5ra395hyha
5315 http://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 069nb85bv4d4a6slrwjdy8v1cn4cwspm3kdbmyb81d6zckj3nq9f
5316 http://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 0mdqa9w1p6cmli6976v4wi0sw9r4p5prkj7lzfd1877wk11c9c73
5317/gnu/store/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1 contents differ:
5318 local hash: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
5319 http://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
5320 http://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 1cy25x1a4fzq5rk0pmvc8xhwyffnqz95h2bpvqsz2mpvlbccy0gs
5321@end smallexample
5322
5323@noindent
5324In this example, @command{guix challenge} first scans the store to
5325determine the set of locally-built derivations---as opposed to store
5326items that were downloaded from a substitute server---and then queries
5327all the substitute servers. It then reports those store items for which
5328the servers obtained a result different from the local build.
5329
5330@cindex non-determinism, in package builds
5331As an example, @code{guix.example.org} always gets a different answer.
5332Conversely, @code{hydra.gnu.org} agrees with local builds, except in the
5333case of Git. This might indicate that the build process of Git is
5334non-deterministic, meaning that its output varies as a function of
5335various things that Guix does not fully control, in spite of building
5336packages in isolated environments (@pxref{Features}). Most common
5337sources of non-determinism include the addition of timestamps in build
5338results, the inclusion of random numbers, and directory listings sorted
5339by inode number. See @uref{http://reproducible.debian.net/howto/}, for
5340more information.
5341
f97c9175 5342To find out what is wrong with this Git binary, we can do something along
d23c20f1
LC
5343these lines (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
5344
5345@example
5346$ wget -q -O - http://hydra.gnu.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 \
5347 | guix archive -x /tmp/git
043f4698 5348$ diff -ur --no-dereference /gnu/store/@dots{}-git.2.5.0 /tmp/git
d23c20f1
LC
5349@end example
5350
5351This command shows the difference between the files resulting from the
5352local build, and the files resulting from the build on
5353@code{hydra.gnu.org} (@pxref{Overview, Comparing and Merging Files,,
5354diffutils, Comparing and Merging Files}). The @command{diff} command
5355works great for text files. When binary files differ, a better option
5356is @uref{http://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, a tool that helps
5357visualize differences for all kinds of files.
5358
f97c9175 5359Once you have done that work, you can tell whether the differences are due
d23c20f1
LC
5360to a non-deterministic build process or to a malicious server. We try
5361hard to remove sources of non-determinism in packages to make it easier
f97c9175
AE
5362to verify substitutes, but of course, this is a process that
5363involves not just Guix, but a large part of the free software community.
d23c20f1
LC
5364In the meantime, @command{guix challenge} is one tool to help address
5365the problem.
5366
5367If you are writing packages for Guix, you are encouraged to check
5368whether @code{hydra.gnu.org} and other substitute servers obtain the
5369same build result as you did with:
5370
5371@example
5372$ guix challenge @var{package}
5373@end example
5374
5375@noindent
f97c9175 5376where @var{package} is a package specification such as
d23c20f1
LC
5377@code{guile-2.0} or @code{glibc:debug}.
5378
5379The general syntax is:
5380
5381@example
5382guix challenge @var{options} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
5383@end example
5384
5385The one option that matters is:
5386
5387@table @code
5388
5389@item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
5390Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
5391URLs to compare to.
5392
5393@end table
5394
5395
32efa254
DT
5396@node Invoking guix container
5397@section Invoking @command{guix container}
5398@cindex container
5399
5400@quotation Note
5401As of version @value{VERSION}, this tool is experimental. The interface
5402is subject to radical change in the future.
5403@end quotation
5404
5405The purpose of @command{guix container} is to manipulate processes
5406running within an isolated environment, commonly known as a
46c36586 5407``container'', typically created by the @command{guix environment}
32efa254
DT
5408(@pxref{Invoking guix environment}) and @command{guix system container}
5409(@pxref{Invoking guix system}) commands.
5410
5411The general syntax is:
5412
5413@example
5414guix container @var{action} @var{options}@dots{}
5415@end example
5416
5417@var{action} specifies the operation to perform with a container, and
5418@var{options} specifies the context-specific arguments for the action.
5419
5420The following actions are available:
5421
5422@table @code
5423@item exec
5424Execute a command within the context of a running container.
5425
5426The syntax is:
5427
5428@example
5429guix container exec @var{pid} @var{program} @var{arguments}@dots{}
5430@end example
5431
5432@var{pid} specifies the process ID of the running container.
f97c9175
AE
5433@var{program} specifies an executable file name within the root file
5434system of the container. @var{arguments} are the additional options that
5435will be passed to @var{program}.
32efa254
DT
5436
5437The following command launches an interactive login shell inside a
5438GuixSD container, started by @command{guix system container}, and whose
5439process ID is 9001:
5440
5441@example
5442guix container exec 9001 /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
5443@end example
5444
5445Note that the @var{pid} cannot be the parent process of a container. It
f97c9175 5446must be PID 1 of the container or one of its child processes.
32efa254
DT
5447
5448@end table
5449
a1ba8475
LC
5450@c *********************************************************************
5451@node GNU Distribution
5452@chapter GNU Distribution
5453
3ca2731c 5454@cindex Guix System Distribution
4705641f 5455@cindex GuixSD
3ca2731c
LC
5456Guix comes with a distribution of the GNU system consisting entirely of
5457free software@footnote{The term ``free'' here refers to the
a1ba8475 5458@url{http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,freedom provided to
3ca2731c 5459users of that software}.}. The
35ed9306
LC
5460distribution can be installed on its own (@pxref{System Installation}),
5461but it is also possible to install Guix as a package manager on top of
5462an installed GNU/Linux system (@pxref{Installation}). To distinguish
3ca2731c 5463between the two, we refer to the standalone distribution as the Guix
4705641f 5464System Distribution, or GuixSD.
35ed9306
LC
5465
5466The distribution provides core GNU packages such as GNU libc, GCC, and
5467Binutils, as well as many GNU and non-GNU applications. The complete
5468list of available packages can be browsed
093ae1be 5469@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/guix/packages,on-line} or by
d03bb653 5470running @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}):
a1ba8475
LC
5471
5472@example
e49951eb 5473guix package --list-available
a1ba8475
LC
5474@end example
5475
f97c9175 5476Our goal is to provide a practical 100% free software distribution of
401c53c4
LC
5477Linux-based and other variants of GNU, with a focus on the promotion and
5478tight integration of GNU components, and an emphasis on programs and
5479tools that help users exert that freedom.
5480
3ca2731c 5481Packages are currently available on the following platforms:
c320011d
LC
5482
5483@table @code
5484
5485@item x86_64-linux
5486Intel/AMD @code{x86_64} architecture, Linux-Libre kernel;
5487
5488@item i686-linux
5489Intel 32-bit architecture (IA32), Linux-Libre kernel;
5490
aa1e1947 5491@item armhf-linux
aa725117 5492ARMv7-A architecture with hard float, Thumb-2 and NEON,
f97c9175
AE
5493using the EABI hard-float application binary interface (ABI),
5494and Linux-Libre kernel.
aa1e1947 5495
c320011d
LC
5496@item mips64el-linux
5497little-endian 64-bit MIPS processors, specifically the Loongson series,
f97c9175 5498n32 ABI, and Linux-Libre kernel.
c320011d
LC
5499
5500@end table
5501
4705641f 5502GuixSD itself is currently only available on @code{i686} and @code{x86_64}.
3ca2731c 5503
c320011d
LC
5504@noindent
5505For information on porting to other architectures or kernels,
f97c9175 5506@pxref{Porting}.
c320011d 5507
401c53c4 5508@menu
5af6de3e 5509* System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
35ed9306 5510* System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
91ef73d4 5511* Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
05962f29 5512* Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
401c53c4 5513* Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
da7cabd4 5514* Packaging Guidelines:: Growing the distribution.
401c53c4 5515* Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
8b315a6d 5516* Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
401c53c4
LC
5517@end menu
5518
5519Building this distribution is a cooperative effort, and you are invited
081145cf 5520to join! @xref{Contributing}, for information about how you can help.
401c53c4 5521
5af6de3e
LC
5522@node System Installation
5523@section System Installation
5524
3ca2731c
LC
5525@cindex Guix System Distribution
5526This section explains how to install the Guix System Distribution
5527on a machine. The Guix package manager can
35ed9306
LC
5528also be installed on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
5529@pxref{Installation}.
5af6de3e
LC
5530
5531@ifinfo
5532@c This paragraph is for people reading this from tty2 of the
5533@c installation image.
5534You're reading this documentation with an Info reader. For details on
5535how to use it, hit the @key{RET} key (``return'' or ``enter'') on the
6621cdb6 5536link that follows: @pxref{Help,,, info, Info: An Introduction}. Hit
5af6de3e
LC
5537@kbd{l} afterwards to come back here.
5538@end ifinfo
5539
dedb8d5e
LC
5540@menu
5541* Limitations:: What you can expect.
5542* USB Stick Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
5543* Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
5544* Proceeding with the Installation:: The real thing.
5545* Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
5546@end menu
5547
5548@node Limitations
8aaaae38
LC
5549@subsection Limitations
5550
4705641f 5551As of version @value{VERSION}, the Guix System Distribution (GuixSD) is
3ca2731c 5552not production-ready. It may contain bugs and lack important
8aaaae38
LC
5553features. Thus, if you are looking for a stable production system that
5554respects your freedom as a computer user, a good solution at this point
5555is to consider @url{http://www.gnu.org/distros/free-distros.html, one of
f97c9175 5556the more established GNU/Linux distributions}. We hope you can soon switch
4705641f 5557to the GuixSD without fear, of course. In the meantime, you can
8aaaae38
LC
5558also keep using your distribution and try out the package manager on top
5559of it (@pxref{Installation}).
5560
5561Before you proceed with the installation, be aware of the following
5562noteworthy limitations applicable to version @value{VERSION}:
5563
5564@itemize
5565@item
5566The installation process does not include a graphical user interface and
5567requires familiarity with GNU/Linux (see the following subsections to
5568get a feel of what that means.)
5569
5570@item
093ae1be 5571The system does not yet provide full GNOME and KDE desktops. Xfce and
f97c9175 5572Enlightenment are available, though, if graphical desktop environments
093ae1be 5573are your thing, as well as a number of X11 window managers.
8aaaae38
LC
5574
5575@item
dbcb0ab1 5576Support for the Logical Volume Manager (LVM) is missing.
8aaaae38
LC
5577
5578@item
5579Few system services are currently supported out-of-the-box
5580(@pxref{Services}).
5581
5582@item
dedb8d5e 5583More than 3,000 packages are available, but you may
8aaaae38
LC
5584occasionally find that a useful package is missing.
5585@end itemize
5586
f97c9175
AE
5587You have been warned! But more than a disclaimer, this is an invitation
5588to report issues (and success stories!), and to join us in improving it.
8aaaae38 5589@xref{Contributing}, for more info.
5af6de3e 5590
dedb8d5e 5591@node USB Stick Installation
5af6de3e
LC
5592@subsection USB Stick Installation
5593
5594An installation image for USB sticks can be downloaded from
4705641f 5595@indicateurl{ftp://alpha.gnu.org/gnu/guix/guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz},
5af6de3e
LC
5596where @var{system} is one of:
5597
5598@table @code
5599@item x86_64-linux
5600for a GNU/Linux system on Intel/AMD-compatible 64-bit CPUs;
5601
5602@item i686-linux
5603for a 32-bit GNU/Linux system on Intel-compatible CPUs.
5604@end table
5605
5606This image contains a single partition with the tools necessary for an
5607installation. It is meant to be copied @emph{as is} to a large-enough
5608USB stick.
5609
5610To copy the image to a USB stick, follow these steps:
5611
5612@enumerate
5613@item
5614Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
5615
5616@example
4705641f 5617xz -d guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.xz
5af6de3e
LC
5618@end example
5619
5620@item
f97c9175
AE
5621Insert a USB stick of 1@tie{}GiB or more into your machine, and determine
5622its device name. Assuming that the USB stick is known as @file{/dev/sdX},
5af6de3e
LC
5623copy the image with:
5624
5625@example
4705641f 5626dd if=guixsd-usb-install-@value{VERSION}.x86_64 of=/dev/sdX
5af6de3e
LC
5627@end example
5628
5629Access to @file{/dev/sdX} usually requires root privileges.
5630@end enumerate
5631
5632Once this is done, you should be able to reboot the system and boot from
5633the USB stick. The latter usually requires you to get in the BIOS' boot
5634menu, where you can choose to boot from the USB stick.
5635
dedb8d5e 5636@node Preparing for Installation
5af6de3e
LC
5637@subsection Preparing for Installation
5638
5639Once you have successfully booted the image on the USB stick, you should
5640end up with a root prompt. Several console TTYs are configured and can
5641be used to run commands as root. TTY2 shows this documentation,
5642browsable using the Info reader commands (@pxref{Help,,, info, Info: An
ae7ffa9e
LC
5643Introduction}). The installation system runs the GPM mouse daemon,
5644which allows you to select text with the left mouse button and to paste
5645it with the middle button.
5af6de3e 5646
dedb8d5e 5647@subsubsection Keyboard Layout
5af6de3e 5648
dedb8d5e
LC
5649@cindex keyboard layout
5650The installation image uses the US qwerty keyboard layout. If you want
5651to change it, you can use the @command{loadkeys} command. For example,
5652the following command selects the Dvorak keyboard layout:
5af6de3e 5653
dedb8d5e
LC
5654@example
5655loadkeys dvorak
5656@end example
5657
5658See the files under @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/keymaps} for
5659a list of available keyboard layouts. Run @command{man loadkeys} for
5660more information.
5661
5662@subsubsection Networking
5663
5664Run the following command see what your network interfaces are called:
235cba85
LC
5665
5666@example
dedb8d5e 5667ifconfig -a
235cba85
LC
5668@end example
5669
95c559c1 5670@c http://cgit.freedesktop.org/systemd/systemd/tree/src/udev/udev-builtin-net_id.c#n20
dedb8d5e
LC
5671Wired interfaces have a name starting with @samp{e}; for example, the
5672interface corresponding to the first on-board Ethernet controller is
5673called @samp{eno1}. Wireless interfaces have a name starting with
5674@samp{w}, like @samp{w1p2s0}.
5675
5676@table @asis
5677@item Wired connection
5678To configure a wired network run the following command, substituting
5679@var{interface} with the name of the wired interface you want to use.
5680
5681@example
5682ifconfig @var{interface} up
5683@end example
5684
5685@item Wireless connection
5686To configure wireless networking, you can create a configuration file
5687for the @command{wpa_supplicant} configuration tool (its location is not
5688important) using one of the available text editors such as
5689@command{zile}:
5690
5691@example
5692zile wpa_supplicant.conf
5693@end example
5694
5695As an example, the following stanza can go to this file and will work
5696for many wireless networks, provided you give the actual SSID and
5697passphrase for the network you are connecting to:
5698
5699@example
5700network=@{
5701 ssid=@var{my-ssid}
5702 key_mgmt=WPA-PSK
5703 psk="the network's secret passphrase"
5704@}
5705@end example
5706
5707Start the wireless service and run it in the background with the
5708following command (substitute @var{interface} with the name of the
5709network interface you want to use):
5710
5711@example
5712wpa_supplicant -c wpa_supplicant.conf -i @var{interface} -B
5713@end example
5714
5715Run @command{man wpa_supplication} for more information.
5716@end table
5717
5718At this point, you need to acquire an IP address. On a network where IP
5719addresses are automatically assigned @i{via} DHCP, you can run:
5720
5721@example
5722dhclient @var{interface}
5723@end example
5af6de3e 5724
dedb8d5e
LC
5725Try to ping a server to see if networking is up and running:
5726
5727@example
5728ping -c 3 gnu.org
5729@end example
5af6de3e
LC
5730
5731Setting up network access is almost always a requirement because the
5732image does not contain all the software and tools that may be needed.
5733
dedb8d5e
LC
5734@subsubsection Disk Partitioning
5735
5736Unless this has already been done, the next step is to partition, and
5737then format the target partition(s).
5738
5739The installation image includes several partitioning tools, including
5740Parted (@pxref{Overview,,, parted, GNU Parted User Manual}),
5741@command{fdisk}, and @command{cfdisk}. Run it and set up your disk with
5742the partition layout you want:
5743
5744@example
5745cfdisk
5746@end example
5747
5748Once you are done partitioning the target hard disk drive, you have to
5749create a file system on the relevant partition(s)@footnote{Currently
5750GuixSD pretty much assumes an ext4 file system. In particular, code
5751that reads partition UUIDs and labels only works with ext4. This will
5752be fixed in the future.}.
5af6de3e 5753
7ab44369
LC
5754Preferably, assign partitions a label so that you can easily and
5755reliably refer to them in @code{file-system} declarations (@pxref{File
5756Systems}). This is typically done using the @code{-L} option of
dedb8d5e
LC
5757@command{mkfs.ext4} and related commands. So, assuming the target root
5758partition lives at @file{/dev/sda1}, a file system with the label
5759@code{my-root} can be created with:
7ab44369 5760
dedb8d5e
LC
5761@example
5762mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/sda1
5763@end example
dd816355 5764
316d65be
LC
5765@c FIXME: Uncomment this once GRUB fully supports encrypted roots.
5766@c A typical command sequence may be:
5767@c
5768@c @example
5769@c # fdisk /dev/sdX
5770@c @dots{} Create partitions etc.@dots{}
5771@c # cryptsetup luksFormat /dev/sdX1
5772@c # cryptsetup open --type luks /dev/sdX1 my-partition
5773@c # mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/mapper/my-partition
5774@c @end example
6d6e6281 5775
dedb8d5e
LC
5776In addition to e2fsprogs, the suite of tools to manipulate
5777ext2/ext3/ext4 file systems, the installation image includes
5778Cryptsetup/LUKS for disk encryption.
5af6de3e 5779
dedb8d5e
LC
5780Once that is done, mount the target root partition under @file{/mnt}
5781with a command like (again, assuming @file{/dev/sda1} is the root
5782partition):
83a17b62 5783
dedb8d5e
LC
5784@example
5785mount /dev/sda1 /mnt
5786@end example
83a17b62 5787
dedb8d5e
LC
5788@node Proceeding with the Installation
5789@subsection Proceeding with the Installation
83a17b62 5790
dedb8d5e
LC
5791With the target partitions ready and the target root mounted on
5792@file{/mnt}, we're ready to go. First, run:
5af6de3e 5793
dedb8d5e
LC
5794@example
5795herd start cow-store /mnt
5796@end example
5af6de3e 5797
dedb8d5e
LC
5798This makes @file{/gnu/store} copy-on-write, such that packages added to
5799it during the installation phase are written to the target disk rather
5800than kept in memory.
5af6de3e 5801
dedb8d5e 5802Next, you have to edit a file and
5af6de3e
LC
5803provide the declaration of the operating system to be installed. To
5804that end, the installation system comes with two text editors: GNU nano
5805(@pxref{Top,,, nano, GNU nano Manual}), and GNU Zile, an Emacs clone.
5806It is better to store that file on the target root file system, say, as
5807@file{/mnt/etc/config.scm}.
5808
dedb8d5e
LC
5809@xref{Using the Configuration System}, for an overview of the
5810configuration file. The example configurations discussed in that
5811section are available under @file{/etc/configuration} in the
5812installation image. Thus, to get started with a system configuration
5813providing a graphical display server (a ``desktop'' system), you can run
5814something along these lines:
5815
5816@example
5817# mkdir /mnt/etc
5818# cp /etc/configuration/desktop.scm /mnt/etc/config.scm
5819# zile /mnt/etc/config.scm
5820@end example
5821
5822You should pay attention to what your configuration file contains, and
5823in particular:
5824
5825@itemize
5826@item
5827Make sure the @code{grub-configuration} form refers to the device you
5828want to install GRUB on.
5829
5830@item
5831Be sure that your partition labels match the value of their respective
5832@code{device} fields in your @code{file-system} configuration, assuming
5833your @code{file-system} configuration sets the value of @code{title} to
5834@code{'label}.
5835@end itemize
5af6de3e 5836
dd51caac
LC
5837Once you are done preparing the configuration file, the new system must
5838be initialized (remember that the target root file system is mounted
5839under @file{/mnt}):
5af6de3e
LC
5840
5841@example
5842guix system init /mnt/etc/config.scm /mnt
5843@end example
5844
5845@noindent
dedb8d5e 5846This copies all the necessary files and installs GRUB on
5af6de3e 5847@file{/dev/sdX}, unless you pass the @option{--no-grub} option. For
6621cdb6 5848more information, @pxref{Invoking guix system}. This command may trigger
5af6de3e
LC
5849downloads or builds of missing packages, which can take some time.
5850
1bd4e6db
LC
5851Once that command has completed---and hopefully succeeded!---you can run
5852@command{reboot} and boot into the new system. The @code{root} password
5853in the new system is initially empty; other users' passwords need to be
5854initialized by running the @command{passwd} command as @code{root},
5855unless your configuration specifies otherwise
5856(@pxref{user-account-password, user account passwords}).
5857
5858Join us on @code{#guix} on the Freenode IRC network or on
5af6de3e
LC
5859@file{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to share your experience---good or not so
5860good.
5861
dedb8d5e 5862@node Building the Installation Image
5af6de3e
LC
5863@subsection Building the Installation Image
5864
5865The installation image described above was built using the @command{guix
5866system} command, specifically:
5867
5868@example
8a225c66 5869guix system disk-image --image-size=850MiB gnu/system/install.scm
5af6de3e
LC
5870@end example
5871
5872@xref{Invoking guix system}, for more information. See
5873@file{gnu/system/install.scm} in the source tree for more information
5874about the installation image.
5875
cf4a9129
LC
5876@node System Configuration
5877@section System Configuration
b208a005 5878
cf4a9129 5879@cindex system configuration
3ca2731c 5880The Guix System Distribution supports a consistent whole-system configuration
cf4a9129
LC
5881mechanism. By that we mean that all aspects of the global system
5882configuration---such as the available system services, timezone and
5883locale settings, user accounts---are declared in a single place. Such
5884a @dfn{system configuration} can be @dfn{instantiated}---i.e., effected.
91ef73d4 5885
cf4a9129
LC
5886One of the advantages of putting all the system configuration under the
5887control of Guix is that it supports transactional system upgrades, and
5888makes it possible to roll-back to a previous system instantiation,
5889should something go wrong with the new one (@pxref{Features}). Another
5890one is that it makes it easy to replicate the exact same configuration
5891across different machines, or at different points in time, without
5892having to resort to additional administration tools layered on top of
5893the system's own tools.
5894@c Yes, we're talking of Puppet, Chef, & co. here. ↑
91ef73d4 5895
cf4a9129
LC
5896This section describes this mechanism. First we focus on the system
5897administrator's viewpoint---explaining how the system is configured and
5898instantiated. Then we show how this mechanism can be extended, for
5899instance to support new system services.
91ef73d4 5900
cf4a9129
LC
5901@menu
5902* Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
7313a52e 5903* operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
cf4a9129 5904* File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
510f9d86 5905* Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
cf4a9129 5906* User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
598e19dc 5907* Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
cf4a9129 5908* Services:: Specifying system services.
0ae8c15a 5909* Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
efb5e833 5910* X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
996ed739 5911* Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
fd1b1fa2 5912* Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
88faf933 5913* GRUB Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
cf4a9129 5914* Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
97d76250 5915* Running GuixSD in a VM:: How to run GuixSD in a virtual machine.
cf4a9129
LC
5916* Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
5917@end menu
91ef73d4 5918
cf4a9129
LC
5919@node Using the Configuration System
5920@subsection Using the Configuration System
64d76fa6 5921
cf4a9129
LC
5922The operating system is configured by providing an
5923@code{operating-system} declaration in a file that can then be passed to
5924the @command{guix system} command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). A
5925simple setup, with the default system services, the default Linux-Libre
5926kernel, initial RAM disk, and boot loader looks like this:
91ef73d4 5927
cf4a9129
LC
5928@findex operating-system
5929@lisp
dd51caac 5930@include os-config-bare-bones.texi
cf4a9129 5931@end lisp
401c53c4 5932
cf4a9129
LC
5933This example should be self-describing. Some of the fields defined
5934above, such as @code{host-name} and @code{bootloader}, are mandatory.
5935Others, such as @code{packages} and @code{services}, can be omitted, in
5936which case they get a default value.
e7f34eb0 5937
5d94ac51
LC
5938Below we discuss the effect of some of the most important fields
5939(@pxref{operating-system Reference}, for details about all the available
5940fields), and how to @dfn{instantiate} the operating system using
5941@command{guix system}.
5942
5943@unnumberedsubsubsec Globally-Visible Packages
5944
cf4a9129 5945@vindex %base-packages
5d94ac51
LC
5946The @code{packages} field lists packages that will be globally visible
5947on the system, for all user accounts---i.e., in every user's @code{PATH}
5948environment variable---in addition to the per-user profiles
5949(@pxref{Invoking guix package}). The @var{%base-packages} variable
5950provides all the tools one would expect for basic user and administrator
5951tasks---including the GNU Core Utilities, the GNU Networking Utilities,
5952the GNU Zile lightweight text editor, @command{find}, @command{grep},
5953etc. The example above adds tcpdump to those, taken from the @code{(gnu
5954packages admin)} module (@pxref{Package Modules}).
e7f34eb0 5955
f6c9fb1b
LC
5956@findex specification->package
5957Referring to packages by variable name, like @var{tcpdump} above, has
5958the advantage of being unambiguous; it also allows typos and such to be
5959diagnosed right away as ``unbound variables''. The downside is that one
5960needs to know which module defines which package, and to augment the
5961@code{use-package-modules} line accordingly. To avoid that, one can use
5962the @code{specification->package} procedure of the @code{(gnu packages)}
5963module, which returns the best package for a given name or name and
5964version:
5965
5966@lisp
5967(use-modules (gnu packages))
5968
5969(operating-system
5970 ;; ...
5971 (packages (append (map specification->package
5972 '("tcpdump" "htop" "gnupg-2.0"))
5973 %base-packages)))
5974@end lisp
5975
5d94ac51
LC
5976@unnumberedsubsubsec System Services
5977
cf4a9129
LC
5978@vindex %base-services
5979The @code{services} field lists @dfn{system services} to be made
5980available when the system starts (@pxref{Services}).
5981The @code{operating-system} declaration above specifies that, in
5982addition to the basic services, we want the @command{lshd} secure shell
cd6f6c22
LC
5983daemon listening on port 2222 (@pxref{Networking Services,
5984@code{lsh-service}}). Under the hood,
cf4a9129
LC
5985@code{lsh-service} arranges so that @code{lshd} is started with the
5986right command-line options, possibly with supporting configuration files
cd6f6c22
LC
5987generated as needed (@pxref{Defining Services}).
5988
5989@cindex customization, of services
5990@findex modify-services
5991Occasionally, instead of using the base services as is, you will want to
5992customize them. For instance, to change the configuration of
5993@code{guix-daemon} and Mingetty (the console log-in), you may write the
5994following instead of @var{%base-services}:
5995
5996@lisp
5997(modify-services %base-services
5998 (guix-service-type config =>
5999 (guix-configuration
6000 (inherit config)
6001 (use-substitutes? #f)
6002 (extra-options '("--gc-keep-outputs"))))
6003 (mingetty-service-type config =>
6004 (mingetty-configuration
6005 (inherit config)
6006 (motd (plain-file "motd" "Hi there!")))))
6007@end lisp
6008
6009@noindent
6010The effect here is to change the options passed to @command{guix-daemon}
6011when it is started, as well as the ``message of the day'' that appears
6012when logging in at the console. @xref{Service Reference,
6013@code{modify-services}}, for more on that.
a1ba8475 6014
dd51caac 6015The configuration for a typical ``desktop'' usage, with the X11 display
cd6f6c22 6016server, a desktop environment, network management, power management, and
dd51caac
LC
6017more, would look like this:
6018
6019@lisp
6020@include os-config-desktop.texi
6021@end lisp
6022
6023@xref{Desktop Services}, for the exact list of services provided by
efb5e833
LC
6024@var{%desktop-services}. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for background
6025information about the @code{nss-certs} package that is used here.
dd51caac 6026
5d94ac51
LC
6027Again, @var{%desktop-services} is just a list of service objects. If
6028you want to remove services from there, you can do so using the
6029procedures for list filtering (@pxref{SRFI-1 Filtering and
6030Partitioning,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For instance, the
6031following expression returns a list that contains all the services in
6032@var{%desktop-services} minus the Avahi service:
6033
6034@example
6035(remove (lambda (service)
6036 (eq? (service-kind service) avahi-service-type))
6037 %desktop-services)
6038@end example
6039
6040@unnumberedsubsubsec Instantiating the System
6041
6042Assuming the @code{operating-system} declaration
6043is stored in the @file{my-system-config.scm}
cf4a9129
LC
6044file, the @command{guix system reconfigure my-system-config.scm} command
6045instantiates that configuration, and makes it the default GRUB boot
65797bff
LC
6046entry (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
6047
6048The normal way to change the system's configuration is by updating this
6049file and re-running @command{guix system reconfigure}. One should never
6050have to touch files in @command{/etc} or to run commands that modify the
6051system state such as @command{useradd} or @command{grub-install}. In
6052fact, you must avoid that since that would not only void your warranty
6053but also prevent you from rolling back to previous versions of your
6054system, should you ever need to.
6055
6056@cindex roll-back, of the operating system
6057Speaking of roll-back, each time you run @command{guix system
6058reconfigure}, a new @dfn{generation} of the system is created---without
6059modifying or deleting previous generations. Old system generations get
6060an entry in the GRUB boot menu, allowing you to boot them in case
6061something went wrong with the latest generation. Reassuring, no? The
6062@command{guix system list-generations} command lists the system
6063generations available on disk.
b81e1947 6064
5d94ac51
LC
6065@unnumberedsubsubsec The Programming Interface
6066
cf4a9129
LC
6067At the Scheme level, the bulk of an @code{operating-system} declaration
6068is instantiated with the following monadic procedure (@pxref{The Store
6069Monad}):
b81e1947 6070
cf4a9129
LC
6071@deffn {Monadic Procedure} operating-system-derivation os
6072Return a derivation that builds @var{os}, an @code{operating-system}
6073object (@pxref{Derivations}).
b81e1947 6074
cf4a9129
LC
6075The output of the derivation is a single directory that refers to all
6076the packages, configuration files, and other supporting files needed to
6077instantiate @var{os}.
6078@end deffn
b81e1947 6079
5d94ac51
LC
6080This procedure is provided by the @code{(gnu system)} module. Along
6081with @code{(gnu services)} (@pxref{Services}), this module contains the
6082guts of GuixSD. Make sure to visit it!
6083
6084
7313a52e
LC
6085@node operating-system Reference
6086@subsection @code{operating-system} Reference
6087
6088This section summarizes all the options available in
6089@code{operating-system} declarations (@pxref{Using the Configuration
6090System}).
6091
6092@deftp {Data Type} operating-system
6093This is the data type representing an operating system configuration.
6094By that, we mean all the global system configuration, not per-user
6095configuration (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
6096
6097@table @asis
6098@item @code{kernel} (default: @var{linux-libre})
fbb25e56 6099The package object of the operating system kernel to use@footnote{Currently
7313a52e
LC
6100only the Linux-libre kernel is supported. In the future, it will be
6101possible to use the GNU@tie{}Hurd.}.
6102
ee2a6304
LC
6103@item @code{kernel-arguments} (default: @code{'()})
6104List of strings or gexps representing additional arguments to pass on
6105the kernel's command-line---e.g., @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
6106
7313a52e 6107@item @code{bootloader}
88faf933 6108The system bootloader configuration object. @xref{GRUB Configuration}.
7313a52e
LC
6109
6110@item @code{initrd} (default: @code{base-initrd})
6111A two-argument monadic procedure that returns an initial RAM disk for
6112the Linux kernel. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
6113
f34c56be
LC
6114@item @code{firmware} (default: @var{%base-firmware})
6115@cindex firmware
6116List of firmware packages loadable by the operating system kernel.
6117
6118The default includes firmware needed for Atheros-based WiFi devices
6119(Linux-libre module @code{ath9k}.)
6120
7313a52e
LC
6121@item @code{host-name}
6122The host name.
6123
6124@item @code{hosts-file}
6125@cindex hosts file
24e02c28 6126A file-like object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) for use as
7313a52e 6127@file{/etc/hosts} (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
24e02c28 6128Reference Manual}). The default is a file with entries for
7313a52e
LC
6129@code{localhost} and @var{host-name}.
6130
6131@item @code{mapped-devices} (default: @code{'()})
6132A list of mapped devices. @xref{Mapped Devices}.
6133
6134@item @code{file-systems}
6135A list of file systems. @xref{File Systems}.
6136
6137@item @code{swap-devices} (default: @code{'()})
6138@cindex swap devices
6139A list of strings identifying devices to be used for ``swap space''
6140(@pxref{Memory Concepts,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
6141For example, @code{'("/dev/sda3")}.
6142
bf87f38a 6143@item @code{users} (default: @code{%base-user-accounts})
7313a52e
LC
6144@itemx @code{groups} (default: @var{%base-groups})
6145List of user accounts and groups. @xref{User Accounts}.
6146
6147@item @code{skeletons} (default: @code{(default-skeletons)})
6148A monadic list of pairs of target file name and files. These are the
6149files that will be used as skeletons as new accounts are created.
6150
6151For instance, a valid value may look like this:
6152
6153@example
6154(mlet %store-monad ((bashrc (text-file "bashrc" "\
6155 export PATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/bin")))
6156 (return `((".bashrc" ,bashrc))))
6157@end example
6158
6159@item @code{issue} (default: @var{%default-issue})
6160A string denoting the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file, which is
6161what displayed when users log in on a text console.
6162
6163@item @code{packages} (default: @var{%base-packages})
6164The set of packages installed in the global profile, which is accessible
6165at @file{/run/current-system/profile}.
6166
6167The default set includes core utilities, but it is good practice to
6168install non-core utilities in user profiles (@pxref{Invoking guix
6169package}).
6170
6171@item @code{timezone}
6172A timezone identifying string---e.g., @code{"Europe/Paris"}.
6173
17c20385
LC
6174You can run the @command{tzselect} command to find out which timezone
6175string corresponds to your region. Choosing an invalid timezone name
6176causes @command{guix system} to fail.
6177
598e19dc
LC
6178@item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
6179The name of the default locale (@pxref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C
6180Library Reference Manual}). @xref{Locales}, for more information.
6181
6182@item @code{locale-definitions} (default: @var{%default-locale-definitions})
6183The list of locale definitions to be compiled and that may be used at
6184run time. @xref{Locales}.
7313a52e 6185
34760ae7
LC
6186@item @code{locale-libcs} (default: @code{(list @var{glibc})})
6187The list of GNU@tie{}libc packages whose locale data and tools are used
6188to build the locale definitions. @xref{Locales}, for compatibility
6189considerations that justify this option.
6190
996ed739
LC
6191@item @code{name-service-switch} (default: @var{%default-nss})
6192Configuration of libc's name service switch (NSS)---a
6193@code{<name-service-switch>} object. @xref{Name Service Switch}, for
6194details.
6195
7313a52e 6196@item @code{services} (default: @var{%base-services})
28d939af 6197A list of service objects denoting system services. @xref{Services}.
7313a52e
LC
6198
6199@item @code{pam-services} (default: @code{(base-pam-services)})
6200@cindex PAM
6201@cindex pluggable authentication modules
6202Linux @dfn{pluggable authentication module} (PAM) services.
6203@c FIXME: Add xref to PAM services section.
6204
6205@item @code{setuid-programs} (default: @var{%setuid-programs})
6206List of string-valued G-expressions denoting setuid programs.
6207@xref{Setuid Programs}.
6208
f5a9ffa0
AK
6209@item @code{sudoers-file} (default: @var{%sudoers-specification})
6210@cindex sudoers file
84765839
LC
6211The contents of the @file{/etc/sudoers} file as a file-like object
6212(@pxref{G-Expressions, @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}}).
7313a52e
LC
6213
6214This file specifies which users can use the @command{sudo} command, what
6215they are allowed to do, and what privileges they may gain. The default
6216is that only @code{root} and members of the @code{wheel} group may use
6217@code{sudo}.
6218
6219@end table
6220@end deftp
6221
cf4a9129
LC
6222@node File Systems
6223@subsection File Systems
b81e1947 6224
cf4a9129
LC
6225The list of file systems to be mounted is specified in the
6226@code{file-systems} field of the operating system's declaration
6227(@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). Each file system is declared
6228using the @code{file-system} form, like this:
b81e1947
LC
6229
6230@example
cf4a9129
LC
6231(file-system
6232 (mount-point "/home")
6233 (device "/dev/sda3")
6234 (type "ext4"))
b81e1947
LC
6235@end example
6236
cf4a9129
LC
6237As usual, some of the fields are mandatory---those shown in the example
6238above---while others can be omitted. These are described below.
b81e1947 6239
cf4a9129
LC
6240@deftp {Data Type} file-system
6241Objects of this type represent file systems to be mounted. They
6242contain the following members:
5ff3c4b8 6243
cf4a9129
LC
6244@table @asis
6245@item @code{type}
6246This is a string specifying the type of the file system---e.g.,
6247@code{"ext4"}.
5ff3c4b8 6248
cf4a9129
LC
6249@item @code{mount-point}
6250This designates the place where the file system is to be mounted.
b81e1947 6251
cf4a9129
LC
6252@item @code{device}
6253This names the ``source'' of the file system. By default it is the name
6254of a node under @file{/dev}, but its meaning depends on the @code{title}
6255field described below.
401c53c4 6256
cf4a9129
LC
6257@item @code{title} (default: @code{'device})
6258This is a symbol that specifies how the @code{device} field is to be
6259interpreted.
401c53c4 6260
cf4a9129
LC
6261When it is the symbol @code{device}, then the @code{device} field is
6262interpreted as a file name; when it is @code{label}, then @code{device}
6263is interpreted as a partition label name; when it is @code{uuid},
6264@code{device} is interpreted as a partition unique identifier (UUID).
da7cabd4 6265
661a1d79
LC
6266UUIDs may be converted from their string representation (as shown by the
6267@command{tune2fs -l} command) using the @code{uuid} form, like this:
6268
6269@example
6270(file-system
6271 (mount-point "/home")
6272 (type "ext4")
6273 (title 'uuid)
6274 (device (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")))
6275@end example
6276
cf4a9129 6277The @code{label} and @code{uuid} options offer a way to refer to disk
661a1d79
LC
6278partitions without having to hard-code their actual device
6279name@footnote{Note that, while it is tempting to use
6280@file{/dev/disk/by-uuid} and similar device names to achieve the same
6281result, this is not recommended: These special device nodes are created
6282by the udev daemon and may be unavailable at the time the device is
6283mounted.}.
da7cabd4 6284
5f86a66e
LC
6285However, when a file system's source is a mapped device (@pxref{Mapped
6286Devices}), its @code{device} field @emph{must} refer to the mapped
6287device name---e.g., @file{/dev/mapper/root-partition}---and consequently
6288@code{title} must be set to @code{'device}. This is required so that
6289the system knows that mounting the file system depends on having the
6290corresponding device mapping established.
6291
cf4a9129
LC
6292@item @code{flags} (default: @code{'()})
6293This is a list of symbols denoting mount flags. Recognized flags
2c071ce9
LC
6294include @code{read-only}, @code{bind-mount}, @code{no-dev} (disallow
6295access to special files), @code{no-suid} (ignore setuid and setgid
6296bits), and @code{no-exec} (disallow program execution.)
da7cabd4 6297
cf4a9129
LC
6298@item @code{options} (default: @code{#f})
6299This is either @code{#f}, or a string denoting mount options.
da7cabd4 6300
be21979d
LC
6301@item @code{mount?} (default: @code{#t})
6302This value indicates whether to automatically mount the file system when
6303the system is brought up. When set to @code{#f}, the file system gets
6304an entry in @file{/etc/fstab} (read by the @command{mount} command) but
6305is not automatically mounted.
6306
cf4a9129
LC
6307@item @code{needed-for-boot?} (default: @code{#f})
6308This Boolean value indicates whether the file system is needed when
6309booting. If that is true, then the file system is mounted when the
6310initial RAM disk (initrd) is loaded. This is always the case, for
6311instance, for the root file system.
da7cabd4 6312
cf4a9129
LC
6313@item @code{check?} (default: @code{#t})
6314This Boolean indicates whether the file system needs to be checked for
6315errors before being mounted.
f9cc8971 6316
4e469051
LC
6317@item @code{create-mount-point?} (default: @code{#f})
6318When true, the mount point is created if it does not exist yet.
6319
e51710d1
LC
6320@item @code{dependencies} (default: @code{'()})
6321This is a list of @code{<file-system>} objects representing file systems
6322that must be mounted before (and unmounted after) this one.
6323
6324As an example, consider a hierarchy of mounts: @file{/sys/fs/cgroup} is
6325a dependency of @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/cpu} and
6326@file{/sys/fs/cgroup/memory}.
6327
cf4a9129
LC
6328@end table
6329@end deftp
da7cabd4 6330
a69576ea
LC
6331The @code{(gnu system file-systems)} exports the following useful
6332variables.
6333
6334@defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-file-systems
6335These are essential file systems that are required on normal systems,
cc0e575a 6336such as @var{%pseudo-terminal-file-system} and @var{%immutable-store} (see
3392ce5d
LC
6337below.) Operating system declarations should always contain at least
6338these.
a69576ea
LC
6339@end defvr
6340
7f239fd3
LC
6341@defvr {Scheme Variable} %pseudo-terminal-file-system
6342This is the file system to be mounted as @file{/dev/pts}. It supports
6343@dfn{pseudo-terminals} created @i{via} @code{openpty} and similar
6344functions (@pxref{Pseudo-Terminals,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
6345Manual}). Pseudo-terminals are used by terminal emulators such as
6346@command{xterm}.
6347@end defvr
6348
db17ae5c
LC
6349@defvr {Scheme Variable} %shared-memory-file-system
6350This file system is mounted as @file{/dev/shm} and is used to support
6351memory sharing across processes (@pxref{Memory-mapped I/O,
6352@code{shm_open},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
6353@end defvr
6354
3392ce5d
LC
6355@defvr {Scheme Variable} %immutable-store
6356This file system performs a read-only ``bind mount'' of
6357@file{/gnu/store}, making it read-only for all the users including
6358@code{root}. This prevents against accidental modification by software
6359running as @code{root} or by system administrators.
6360
6361The daemon itself is still able to write to the store: it remounts it
6362read-write in its own ``name space.''
6363@end defvr
6364
a69576ea
LC
6365@defvr {Scheme Variable} %binary-format-file-system
6366The @code{binfmt_misc} file system, which allows handling of arbitrary
6367executable file types to be delegated to user space. This requires the
6368@code{binfmt.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
6369@end defvr
6370
6371@defvr {Scheme Variable} %fuse-control-file-system
6372The @code{fusectl} file system, which allows unprivileged users to mount
6373and unmount user-space FUSE file systems. This requires the
6374@code{fuse.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
6375@end defvr
6376
510f9d86
LC
6377@node Mapped Devices
6378@subsection Mapped Devices
6379
6380@cindex device mapping
6381@cindex mapped devices
6382The Linux kernel has a notion of @dfn{device mapping}: a block device,
6383such as a hard disk partition, can be @dfn{mapped} into another device,
6384with additional processing over the data that flows through
6385it@footnote{Note that the GNU@tie{}Hurd makes no difference between the
6386concept of a ``mapped device'' and that of a file system: both boil down
6387to @emph{translating} input/output operations made on a file to
6388operations on its backing store. Thus, the Hurd implements mapped
6389devices, like file systems, using the generic @dfn{translator} mechanism
6390(@pxref{Translators,,, hurd, The GNU Hurd Reference Manual}).}. A
6391typical example is encryption device mapping: all writes to the mapped
6392device are encrypted, and all reads are deciphered, transparently.
6393
6394Mapped devices are declared using the @code{mapped-device} form:
6395
6396@example
6397(mapped-device
6398 (source "/dev/sda3")
6399 (target "home")
6400 (type luks-device-mapping))
6401@end example
6402
6403@noindent
6404@cindex disk encryption
6405@cindex LUKS
6406This example specifies a mapping from @file{/dev/sda3} to
6407@file{/dev/mapper/home} using LUKS---the
6408@url{http://code.google.com/p/cryptsetup,Linux Unified Key Setup}, a
6409standard mechanism for disk encryption. The @file{/dev/mapper/home}
6410device can then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system}
6411declaration (@pxref{File Systems}). The @code{mapped-device} form is
6412detailed below.
6413
6414@deftp {Data Type} mapped-device
6415Objects of this type represent device mappings that will be made when
6416the system boots up.
6417
9cb426b8
LC
6418@table @code
6419@item source
510f9d86
LC
6420This string specifies the name of the block device to be mapped, such as
6421@code{"/dev/sda3"}.
6422
9cb426b8 6423@item target
510f9d86
LC
6424This string specifies the name of the mapping to be established. For
6425example, specifying @code{"my-partition"} will lead to the creation of
6426the @code{"/dev/mapper/my-partition"} device.
6427
9cb426b8 6428@item type
510f9d86
LC
6429This must be a @code{mapped-device-kind} object, which specifies how
6430@var{source} is mapped to @var{target}.
6431@end table
6432@end deftp
6433
6434@defvr {Scheme Variable} luks-device-mapping
6435This defines LUKS block device encryption using the @command{cryptsetup}
6436command, from the same-named package. This relies on the
6437@code{dm-crypt} Linux kernel module.
6438@end defvr
6439
cf4a9129
LC
6440@node User Accounts
6441@subsection User Accounts
ee85f3db 6442
9bea87a5
LC
6443User accounts and groups are entirely managed through the
6444@code{operating-system} declaration. They are specified with the
6445@code{user-account} and @code{user-group} forms:
ee85f3db 6446
cf4a9129
LC
6447@example
6448(user-account
6449 (name "alice")
6450 (group "users")
24e752c0
LC
6451 (supplementary-groups '("wheel" ;allow use of sudo, etc.
6452 "audio" ;sound card
6453 "video" ;video devices such as webcams
6454 "cdrom")) ;the good ol' CD-ROM
cf4a9129
LC
6455 (comment "Bob's sister")
6456 (home-directory "/home/alice"))
6457@end example
25083588 6458
9bea87a5
LC
6459When booting or upon completion of @command{guix system reconfigure},
6460the system ensures that only the user accounts and groups specified in
6461the @code{operating-system} declaration exist, and with the specified
6462properties. Thus, account or group creations or modifications made by
6463directly invoking commands such as @command{useradd} are lost upon
6464reconfiguration or reboot. This ensures that the system remains exactly
6465as declared.
6466
cf4a9129
LC
6467@deftp {Data Type} user-account
6468Objects of this type represent user accounts. The following members may
6469be specified:
ee85f3db 6470
cf4a9129
LC
6471@table @asis
6472@item @code{name}
6473The name of the user account.
ee85f3db 6474
cf4a9129
LC
6475@item @code{group}
6476This is the name (a string) or identifier (a number) of the user group
6477this account belongs to.
ee85f3db 6478
cf4a9129
LC
6479@item @code{supplementary-groups} (default: @code{'()})
6480Optionally, this can be defined as a list of group names that this
6481account belongs to.
ee85f3db 6482
cf4a9129
LC
6483@item @code{uid} (default: @code{#f})
6484This is the user ID for this account (a number), or @code{#f}. In the
6485latter case, a number is automatically chosen by the system when the
6486account is created.
ee85f3db 6487
cf4a9129
LC
6488@item @code{comment} (default: @code{""})
6489A comment about the account, such as the account's owner full name.
c8c871d1 6490
cf4a9129
LC
6491@item @code{home-directory}
6492This is the name of the home directory for the account.
ee85f3db 6493
cf4a9129
LC
6494@item @code{shell} (default: Bash)
6495This is a G-expression denoting the file name of a program to be used as
6496the shell (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
ee85f3db 6497
cf4a9129
LC
6498@item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
6499This Boolean value indicates whether the account is a ``system''
6500account. System accounts are sometimes treated specially; for instance,
6501graphical login managers do not list them.
ee85f3db 6502
1bd4e6db 6503@anchor{user-account-password}
cf4a9129 6504@item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
eb59595c
LC
6505You would normally leave this field to @code{#f}, initialize user
6506passwords as @code{root} with the @command{passwd} command, and then let
9bea87a5
LC
6507users change it with @command{passwd}. Passwords set with
6508@command{passwd} are of course preserved across reboot and
6509reconfiguration.
eb59595c
LC
6510
6511If you @emph{do} want to have a preset password for an account, then
6512this field must contain the encrypted password, as a string.
5d1f1177
LC
6513@xref{crypt,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for more information
6514on password encryption, and @ref{Encryption,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
eb59595c 6515Manual}, for information on Guile's @code{crypt} procedure.
c8c871d1 6516
cf4a9129
LC
6517@end table
6518@end deftp
ee85f3db 6519
cf4a9129 6520User group declarations are even simpler:
ee85f3db 6521
cf4a9129
LC
6522@example
6523(user-group (name "students"))
6524@end example
ee85f3db 6525
cf4a9129
LC
6526@deftp {Data Type} user-group
6527This type is for, well, user groups. There are just a few fields:
af8a56b8 6528
cf4a9129
LC
6529@table @asis
6530@item @code{name}
6531The group's name.
ee85f3db 6532
cf4a9129
LC
6533@item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
6534The group identifier (a number). If @code{#f}, a new number is
6535automatically allocated when the group is created.
ee85f3db 6536
c8fa3426
LC
6537@item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
6538This Boolean value indicates whether the group is a ``system'' group.
6539System groups have low numerical IDs.
6540
cf4a9129
LC
6541@item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
6542What, user groups can have a password? Well, apparently yes. Unless
6543@code{#f}, this field specifies the group's password.
ee85f3db 6544
cf4a9129
LC
6545@end table
6546@end deftp
401c53c4 6547
cf4a9129
LC
6548For convenience, a variable lists all the basic user groups one may
6549expect:
401c53c4 6550
cf4a9129
LC
6551@defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-groups
6552This is the list of basic user groups that users and/or packages expect
6553to be present on the system. This includes groups such as ``root'',
6554``wheel'', and ``users'', as well as groups used to control access to
6555specific devices such as ``audio'', ``disk'', and ``cdrom''.
6556@end defvr
401c53c4 6557
bf87f38a
LC
6558@defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-user-accounts
6559This is the list of basic system accounts that programs may expect to
6560find on a GNU/Linux system, such as the ``nobody'' account.
6561
6562Note that the ``root'' account is not included here. It is a
6563special-case and is automatically added whether or not it is specified.
6564@end defvr
6565
598e19dc
LC
6566@node Locales
6567@subsection Locales
6568
6569@cindex locale
6570A @dfn{locale} defines cultural conventions for a particular language
6571and region of the world (@pxref{Locales,,, libc, The GNU C Library
6572Reference Manual}). Each locale has a name that typically has the form
b2636518 6573@code{@var{language}_@var{territory}.@var{codeset}}---e.g.,
598e19dc
LC
6574@code{fr_LU.utf8} designates the locale for the French language, with
6575cultural conventions from Luxembourg, and using the UTF-8 encoding.
6576
6577@cindex locale definition
6578Usually, you will want to specify the default locale for the machine
6579using the @code{locale} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
6580(@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{locale}}).
6581
f5582b2c
LC
6582The selected locale is automatically added to the @dfn{locale
6583definitions} known to the system if needed, with its codeset inferred
6584from its name---e.g., @code{bo_CN.utf8} will be assumed to use the
6585@code{UTF-8} codeset. Additional locale definitions can be specified in
6586the @code{locale-definitions} slot of @code{operating-system}---this is
6587useful, for instance, if the codeset could not be inferred from the
6588locale name. The default set of locale definitions includes some widely
6589used locales, but not all the available locales, in order to save space.
6590
6591For instance, to add the North Frisian locale for Germany, the value of
6592that field may be:
598e19dc
LC
6593
6594@example
6595(cons (locale-definition
6596 (name "fy_DE.utf8") (source "fy_DE"))
6597 %default-locale-definitions)
6598@end example
6599
6600Likewise, to save space, one might want @code{locale-definitions} to
6601list only the locales that are actually used, as in:
6602
6603@example
6604(list (locale-definition
6605 (name "ja_JP.eucjp") (source "ja_JP")
6606 (charset "EUC-JP")))
6607@end example
6608
5c3c1427
LC
6609@vindex LOCPATH
6610The compiled locale definitions are available at
46bd6edd
LC
6611@file{/run/current-system/locale/X.Y}, where @code{X.Y} is the libc
6612version, which is the default location where the GNU@tie{}libc provided
6613by Guix looks for locale data. This can be overridden using the
6614@code{LOCPATH} environment variable (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
5c3c1427
LC
6615@code{LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
6616
598e19dc
LC
6617The @code{locale-definition} form is provided by the @code{(gnu system
6618locale)} module. Details are given below.
6619
6620@deftp {Data Type} locale-definition
6621This is the data type of a locale definition.
6622
6623@table @asis
6624
6625@item @code{name}
6626The name of the locale. @xref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
6627Reference Manual}, for more information on locale names.
6628
6629@item @code{source}
6630The name of the source for that locale. This is typically the
6631@code{@var{language}_@var{territory}} part of the locale name.
6632
6633@item @code{charset} (default: @code{"UTF-8"})
6634The ``character set'' or ``code set'' for that locale,
6635@uref{http://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets, as defined by
6636IANA}.
6637
6638@end table
6639@end deftp
6640
6641@defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-locale-definitions
b2636518
LC
6642An arbitrary list of commonly used UTF-8 locales, used as the default
6643value of the @code{locale-definitions} field of @code{operating-system}
598e19dc 6644declarations.
b2636518
LC
6645
6646@cindex locale name
6647@cindex normalized codeset in locale names
6648These locale definitions use the @dfn{normalized codeset} for the part
6649that follows the dot in the name (@pxref{Using gettextized software,
6650normalized codeset,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). So for
6651instance it has @code{uk_UA.utf8} but @emph{not}, say,
6652@code{uk_UA.UTF-8}.
598e19dc 6653@end defvr
401c53c4 6654
34760ae7
LC
6655@subsubsection Locale Data Compatibility Considerations
6656
6657@cindex incompatibility, of locale data
6658@code{operating-system} declarations provide a @code{locale-libcs} field
6659to specify the GNU@tie{}libc packages that are used to compile locale
6660declarations (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). ``Why would I
6661care?'', you may ask. Well, it turns out that the binary format of
6662locale data is occasionally incompatible from one libc version to
6663another.
6664
6665@c See <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2015-09/msg00575.html>
6666@c and <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2015-08/msg00737.html>.
6667For instance, a program linked against libc version 2.21 is unable to
6668read locale data produced with libc 2.22; worse, that program
6669@emph{aborts} instead of simply ignoring the incompatible locale
6670data@footnote{Versions 2.23 and later of GNU@tie{}libc will simply skip
6671the incompatible locale data, which is already an improvement.}.
6672Similarly, a program linked against libc 2.22 can read most, but not
6673all, the locale data from libc 2.21 (specifically, @code{LC_COLLATE}
6674data is incompatible); thus calls to @code{setlocale} may fail, but
6675programs will not abort.
6676
6677The ``problem'' in GuixSD is that users have a lot of freedom: They can
6678choose whether and when to upgrade software in their profiles, and might
6679be using a libc version different from the one the system administrator
6680used to build the system-wide locale data.
6681
6682Fortunately, unprivileged users can also install their own locale data
6683and define @var{GUIX_LOCPATH} accordingly (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
6684@code{GUIX_LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
6685
6686Still, it is best if the system-wide locale data at
6687@file{/run/current-system/locale} is built for all the libc versions
6688actually in use on the system, so that all the programs can access
6689it---this is especially crucial on a multi-user system. To do that, the
6690administrator can specify several libc packages in the
6691@code{locale-libcs} field of @code{operating-system}:
6692
6693@example
6694(use-package-modules base)
6695
6696(operating-system
6697 ;; @dots{}
6698 (locale-libcs (list glibc-2.21 (canonical-package glibc))))
6699@end example
6700
6701This example would lead to a system containing locale definitions for
6702both libc 2.21 and the current version of libc in
6703@file{/run/current-system/locale}.
6704
6705
cf4a9129
LC
6706@node Services
6707@subsection Services
401c53c4 6708
cf4a9129
LC
6709@cindex system services
6710An important part of preparing an @code{operating-system} declaration is
6711listing @dfn{system services} and their configuration (@pxref{Using the
6712Configuration System}). System services are typically daemons launched
6713when the system boots, or other actions needed at that time---e.g.,
d8b94dbd
LC
6714configuring network access.
6715
dd17bc38
AK
6716Services are managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd (@pxref{Introduction,,,
6717shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). On a running system, the
6718@command{herd} command allows you to list the available services, show
6719their status, start and stop them, or do other specific operations
6720(@pxref{Jump Start,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). For example:
d8b94dbd
LC
6721
6722@example
dd17bc38 6723# herd status
d8b94dbd
LC
6724@end example
6725
6726The above command, run as @code{root}, lists the currently defined
dd17bc38 6727services. The @command{herd doc} command shows a synopsis of the given
d8b94dbd
LC
6728service:
6729
6730@example
dd17bc38 6731# herd doc nscd
d8b94dbd
LC
6732Run libc's name service cache daemon (nscd).
6733@end example
6734
6735The @command{start}, @command{stop}, and @command{restart} sub-commands
6736have the effect you would expect. For instance, the commands below stop
6737the nscd service and restart the Xorg display server:
6738
6739@example
dd17bc38 6740# herd stop nscd
d8b94dbd 6741Service nscd has been stopped.
dd17bc38 6742# herd restart xorg-server
d8b94dbd
LC
6743Service xorg-server has been stopped.
6744Service xorg-server has been started.
6745@end example
401c53c4 6746
cf4a9129 6747The following sections document the available services, starting with
d8b94dbd
LC
6748the core services, that may be used in an @code{operating-system}
6749declaration.
401c53c4 6750
cf4a9129
LC
6751@menu
6752* Base Services:: Essential system services.
6753* Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
6754* X Window:: Graphical display.
fe1a39d3 6755* Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
105369a4 6756* Database Services:: SQL databases.
d8c18af8 6757* Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
58724c48 6758* Web Services:: Web servers.
aa4ed923 6759* Various Services:: Other services.
cf4a9129 6760@end menu
401c53c4 6761
cf4a9129
LC
6762@node Base Services
6763@subsubsection Base Services
a1ba8475 6764
cf4a9129
LC
6765The @code{(gnu services base)} module provides definitions for the basic
6766services that one expects from the system. The services exported by
6767this module are listed below.
401c53c4 6768
cf4a9129 6769@defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-services
31771497
LC
6770This variable contains a list of basic services (@pxref{Service Types
6771and Services}, for more information on service objects) one would
cf4a9129
LC
6772expect from the system: a login service (mingetty) on each tty, syslogd,
6773libc's name service cache daemon (nscd), the udev device manager, and
6774more.
401c53c4 6775
cf4a9129
LC
6776This is the default value of the @code{services} field of
6777@code{operating-system} declarations. Usually, when customizing a
6778system, you will want to append services to @var{%base-services}, like
6779this:
401c53c4 6780
cf4a9129 6781@example
fa1e31b8 6782(cons* (avahi-service) (lsh-service) %base-services)
cf4a9129
LC
6783@end example
6784@end defvr
401c53c4 6785
be1c2c54 6786@deffn {Scheme Procedure} host-name-service @var{name}
cf4a9129
LC
6787Return a service that sets the host name to @var{name}.
6788@end deffn
401c53c4 6789
66e4f01c
LC
6790@deffn {Scheme Procedure} mingetty-service @var{config}
6791Return a service to run mingetty according to @var{config}, a
6792@code{<mingetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run, among
6793other things.
cf4a9129 6794@end deffn
401c53c4 6795
66e4f01c
LC
6796@deftp {Data Type} mingetty-configuration
6797This is the data type representing the configuration of Mingetty, which
6798implements console log-in.
6799
6800@table @asis
6801
6802@item @code{tty}
6803The name of the console this Mingetty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
6804
6805@item @code{motd}
6806A file-like object containing the ``message of the day''.
6807
6808@item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
6809When true, this field must be a string denoting the user name under
f9b9a033 6810which the system automatically logs in. When it is @code{#f}, a
66e4f01c
LC
6811user name and password must be entered to log in.
6812
6813@item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#f})
6814This must be either @code{#f}, in which case the default log-in program
6815is used (@command{login} from the Shadow tool suite), or a gexp denoting
6816the name of the log-in program.
6817
6818@item @code{login-pause?} (default: @code{#f})
6819When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{auto-login}, the user
6820will have to press a key before the log-in shell is launched.
6821
6822@item @code{mingetty} (default: @var{mingetty})
6823The Mingetty package to use.
6824
6825@end table
6826@end deftp
6827
6454b333
LC
6828@cindex name service cache daemon
6829@cindex nscd
be1c2c54 6830@deffn {Scheme Procedure} nscd-service [@var{config}] [#:glibc glibc] @
4aee6e60 6831 [#:name-services '()]
b893f1ae
LC
6832Return a service that runs libc's name service cache daemon (nscd) with the
6833given @var{config}---an @code{<nscd-configuration>} object. @xref{Name
6834Service Switch}, for an example.
cf4a9129 6835@end deffn
401c53c4 6836
6454b333
LC
6837@defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-configuration
6838This is the default @code{<nscd-configuration>} value (see below) used
6839by @code{nscd-service}. This uses the caches defined by
6840@var{%nscd-default-caches}; see below.
6841@end defvr
6842
6843@deftp {Data Type} nscd-configuration
6844This is the type representing the name service cache daemon (nscd)
6845configuration.
6846
6847@table @asis
6848
b893f1ae
LC
6849@item @code{name-services} (default: @code{'()})
6850List of packages denoting @dfn{name services} that must be visible to
6851the nscd---e.g., @code{(list @var{nss-mdns})}.
6852
6853@item @code{glibc} (default: @var{glibc})
6854Package object denoting the GNU C Library providing the @command{nscd}
6855command.
6856
6454b333
LC
6857@item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/nscd.log"})
6858Name of nscd's log file. This is where debugging output goes when
6859@code{debug-level} is strictly positive.
6860
6861@item @code{debug-level} (default: @code{0})
6862Integer denoting the debugging levels. Higher numbers mean more
6863debugging output is logged.
6864
6865@item @code{caches} (default: @var{%nscd-default-caches})
6866List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects denoting things to be cached; see
6867below.
6868
6869@end table
6870@end deftp
6871
6872@deftp {Data Type} nscd-cache
6873Data type representing a cache database of nscd and its parameters.
6874
6875@table @asis
6876
6877@item @code{database}
6878This is a symbol representing the name of the database to be cached.
6879Valid values are @code{passwd}, @code{group}, @code{hosts}, and
6880@code{services}, which designate the corresponding NSS database
6881(@pxref{NSS Basics,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
6882
6883@item @code{positive-time-to-live}
6884@itemx @code{negative-time-to-live} (default: @code{20})
6885A number representing the number of seconds during which a positive or
6886negative lookup result remains in cache.
6887
6888@item @code{check-files?} (default: @code{#t})
6889Whether to check for updates of the files corresponding to
6890@var{database}.
6891
6892For instance, when @var{database} is @code{hosts}, setting this flag
6893instructs nscd to check for updates in @file{/etc/hosts} and to take
6894them into account.
6895
6896@item @code{persistent?} (default: @code{#t})
6897Whether the cache should be stored persistently on disk.
6898
6899@item @code{shared?} (default: @code{#t})
6900Whether the cache should be shared among users.
6901
6902@item @code{max-database-size} (default: 32@tie{}MiB)
6903Maximum size in bytes of the database cache.
6904
6905@c XXX: 'suggested-size' and 'auto-propagate?' seem to be expert
6906@c settings, so leave them out.
6907
6908@end table
6909@end deftp
6910
6911@defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-caches
6912List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects used by default by
6913@code{nscd-configuration} (see above.)
6914
6915It enables persistent and aggressive caching of service and host name
6916lookups. The latter provides better host name lookup performance,
6917resilience in the face of unreliable name servers, and also better
6918privacy---often the result of host name lookups is in local cache, so
6919external name servers do not even need to be queried.
6920@end defvr
6921
6922
be1c2c54 6923@deffn {Scheme Procedure} syslog-service [#:config-file #f]
1bb76f75
AK
6924Return a service that runs @code{syslogd}. If configuration file name
6925@var{config-file} is not specified, use some reasonable default
cf4a9129
LC
6926settings.
6927@end deffn
401c53c4 6928
0adfe95a
LC
6929@anchor{guix-configuration-type}
6930@deftp {Data Type} guix-configuration
6931This data type represents the configuration of the Guix build daemon.
6932@xref{Invoking guix-daemon}, for more information.
6933
6934@table @asis
6935@item @code{guix} (default: @var{guix})
6936The Guix package to use.
401c53c4 6937
0adfe95a
LC
6938@item @code{build-group} (default: @code{"guixbuild"})
6939Name of the group for build user accounts.
401c53c4 6940
0adfe95a
LC
6941@item @code{build-accounts} (default: @code{10})
6942Number of build user accounts to create.
401c53c4 6943
0adfe95a
LC
6944@item @code{authorize-key?} (default: @code{#t})
6945Whether to authorize the substitute key for @code{hydra.gnu.org}
6946(@pxref{Substitutes}).
6947
6948@item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#t})
6949Whether to use substitutes.
6950
b0b9f6e0
LC
6951@item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @var{%default-substitute-urls})
6952The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
6953
0adfe95a
LC
6954@item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
6955List of extra command-line options for @command{guix-daemon}.
6956
6957@item @code{lsof} (default: @var{lsof})
6958@itemx @code{lsh} (default: @var{lsh})
6959The lsof and lsh packages to use.
6960
6961@end table
6962@end deftp
6963
6964@deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-service @var{config}
6965Return a service that runs the Guix build daemon according to
6966@var{config}.
cf4a9129 6967@end deffn
a1ba8475 6968
be1c2c54 6969@deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-service [#:udev udev]
cf4a9129
LC
6970Run @var{udev}, which populates the @file{/dev} directory dynamically.
6971@end deffn
401c53c4 6972
be1c2c54 6973@deffn {Scheme Procedure} console-keymap-service @var{file}
dedb8d5e 6974@cindex keyboard layout
5eca9459
AK
6975Return a service to load console keymap from @var{file} using
6976@command{loadkeys} command.
6977@end deffn
6978
8664cc88
LC
6979@deffn {Scheme Procedure} gpm-service-type [#:gpm @var{gpm}] @
6980 [#:options]
6981Run @var{gpm}, the general-purpose mouse daemon, with the given
6982command-line @var{options}. GPM allows users to use the mouse in the console,
6983notably to select, copy, and paste text. The default value of @var{options}
6984uses the @code{ps2} protocol, which works for both USB and PS/2 mice.
6985
6986This service is not part of @var{%base-services}.
6987@end deffn
6988
1c52181f
LC
6989@anchor{guix-publish-service}
6990@deffn {Scheme Procedure} guix-publish-service [#:guix @var{guix}] @
6991 [#:port 80] [#:host "localhost"]
6992Return a service that runs @command{guix publish} listening on @var{host}
6993and @var{port} (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
6994
6995This assumes that @file{/etc/guix} already contains a signing key pair as
6996created by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking guix
6997archive}). If that is not the case, the service will fail to start.
6998@end deffn
6999
a69576ea 7000
cf4a9129
LC
7001@node Networking Services
7002@subsubsection Networking Services
401c53c4 7003
fa1e31b8 7004The @code{(gnu services networking)} module provides services to configure
cf4a9129 7005the network interface.
a1ba8475 7006
a023cca8 7007@cindex DHCP, networking service
be1c2c54 7008@deffn {Scheme Procedure} dhcp-client-service [#:dhcp @var{isc-dhcp}]
a023cca8
LC
7009Return a service that runs @var{dhcp}, a Dynamic Host Configuration
7010Protocol (DHCP) client, on all the non-loopback network interfaces.
7011@end deffn
7012
be1c2c54 7013@deffn {Scheme Procedure} static-networking-service @var{interface} @var{ip} @
cf4a9129
LC
7014 [#:gateway #f] [#:name-services @code{'()}]
7015Return a service that starts @var{interface} with address @var{ip}. If
7016@var{gateway} is true, it must be a string specifying the default network
7017gateway.
7018@end deffn
8b315a6d 7019
b7d0c494 7020@cindex wicd
87f40011 7021@cindex network management
be1c2c54 7022@deffn {Scheme Procedure} wicd-service [#:wicd @var{wicd}]
87f40011
LC
7023Return a service that runs @url{https://launchpad.net/wicd,Wicd}, a network
7024management daemon that aims to simplify wired and wireless networking.
7025
7026This service adds the @var{wicd} package to the global profile, providing
7027several commands to interact with the daemon and configure networking:
7028@command{wicd-client}, a graphical user interface, and the @command{wicd-cli}
7029and @command{wicd-curses} user interfaces.
b7d0c494
MW
7030@end deffn
7031
c0a9589d
SB
7032@cindex NetworkManager
7033@deffn {Scheme Procedure} network-manager-service @
7034 [#:network-manager @var{network-manager}]
7035Return a service that runs NetworkManager, a network connection manager
7036that attempting to keep active network connectivity when available.
7037@end deffn
7038
be1c2c54 7039@deffn {Scheme Procedure} ntp-service [#:ntp @var{ntp}] @
63854bcb
LC
7040 [#:name-service @var{%ntp-servers}]
7041Return a service that runs the daemon from @var{ntp}, the
7042@uref{http://www.ntp.org, Network Time Protocol package}. The daemon will
7043keep the system clock synchronized with that of @var{servers}.
7044@end deffn
7045
7046@defvr {Scheme Variable} %ntp-servers
7047List of host names used as the default NTP servers.
7048@end defvr
7049
375c6108
LC
7050@deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-service [@var{config-file}] [#:tor @var{tor}]
7051Return a service to run the @uref{https://torproject.org, Tor} anonymous
7052networking daemon.
8b315a6d 7053
375c6108 7054The daemon runs as the @code{tor} unprivileged user. It is passed
6331bde7
LC
7055@var{config-file}, a file-like object, with an additional @code{User tor} line
7056and lines for hidden services added via @code{tor-hidden-service}. Run
7057@command{man tor} for information about the configuration file.
7058@end deffn
7059
24a8ef3b 7060@cindex hidden service
6331bde7
LC
7061@deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-hidden-service @var{name} @var{mapping}
7062Define a new Tor @dfn{hidden service} called @var{name} and implementing
7063@var{mapping}. @var{mapping} is a list of port/host tuples, such as:
7064
7065@example
24a8ef3b
LC
7066 '((22 "127.0.0.1:22")
7067 (80 "127.0.0.1:8080"))
6331bde7
LC
7068@end example
7069
7070In this example, port 22 of the hidden service is mapped to local port 22, and
7071port 80 is mapped to local port 8080.
7072
6629099a
LC
7073This creates a @file{/var/lib/tor/hidden-services/@var{name}} directory, where
7074the @file{hostname} file contains the @code{.onion} host name for the hidden
6331bde7
LC
7075service.
7076
7077See @uref{https://www.torproject.org/docs/tor-hidden-service.html.en, the Tor
7078project's documentation} for more information.
cf4a9129 7079@end deffn
8b315a6d 7080
be1c2c54 7081@deffn {Scheme Procedure} bitlbee-service [#:bitlbee bitlbee] @
4627a464
LC
7082 [#:interface "127.0.0.1"] [#:port 6667] @
7083 [#:extra-settings ""]
7084Return a service that runs @url{http://bitlbee.org,BitlBee}, a daemon that
7085acts as a gateway between IRC and chat networks.
7086
7087The daemon will listen to the interface corresponding to the IP address
7088specified in @var{interface}, on @var{port}. @code{127.0.0.1} means that only
7089local clients can connect, whereas @code{0.0.0.0} means that connections can
7090come from any networking interface.
7091
7092In addition, @var{extra-settings} specifies a string to append to the
7093configuration file.
7094@end deffn
7095
f4391bec 7096Furthermore, @code{(gnu services ssh)} provides the following service.
8b315a6d 7097
be1c2c54 7098@deffn {Scheme Procedure} lsh-service [#:host-key "/etc/lsh/host-key"] @
5833bf33 7099 [#:daemonic? #t] [#:interfaces '()] [#:port-number 22] @
cf4a9129
LC
7100 [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] [#:root-login? #f] @
7101 [#:syslog-output? #t] [#:x11-forwarding? #t] @
7102 [#:tcp/ip-forwarding? #t] [#:password-authentication? #t] @
21cc905a 7103 [#:public-key-authentication? #t] [#:initialize? #t]
cf4a9129
LC
7104Run the @command{lshd} program from @var{lsh} to listen on port @var{port-number}.
7105@var{host-key} must designate a file containing the host key, and readable
7106only by root.
72e25e35 7107
5833bf33
DP
7108When @var{daemonic?} is true, @command{lshd} will detach from the
7109controlling terminal and log its output to syslogd, unless one sets
7110@var{syslog-output?} to false. Obviously, it also makes lsh-service
7111depend on existence of syslogd service. When @var{pid-file?} is true,
7112@command{lshd} writes its PID to the file called @var{pid-file}.
7113
cf4a9129
LC
7114When @var{initialize?} is true, automatically create the seed and host key
7115upon service activation if they do not exist yet. This may take long and
7116require interaction.
8b315a6d 7117
20dd519c
LC
7118When @var{initialize?} is false, it is up to the user to initialize the
7119randomness generator (@pxref{lsh-make-seed,,, lsh, LSH Manual}), and to create
7120a key pair with the private key stored in file @var{host-key} (@pxref{lshd
7121basics,,, lsh, LSH Manual}).
7122
cf4a9129
LC
7123When @var{interfaces} is empty, lshd listens for connections on all the
7124network interfaces; otherwise, @var{interfaces} must be a list of host names
7125or addresses.
9bf3c1a7 7126
20dd519c
LC
7127@var{allow-empty-passwords?} specifies whether to accept log-ins with empty
7128passwords, and @var{root-login?} specifies whether to accept log-ins as
cf4a9129 7129root.
4af2447e 7130
cf4a9129
LC
7131The other options should be self-descriptive.
7132@end deffn
4af2447e 7133
fa0c1d61
LC
7134@defvr {Scheme Variable} %facebook-host-aliases
7135This variable contains a string for use in @file{/etc/hosts}
7136(@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). Each
7137line contains a entry that maps a known server name of the Facebook
7138on-line service---e.g., @code{www.facebook.com}---to the local
7139host---@code{127.0.0.1} or its IPv6 equivalent, @code{::1}.
7140
7141This variable is typically used in the @code{hosts-file} field of an
7313a52e
LC
7142@code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
7143@file{/etc/hosts}}):
fa0c1d61
LC
7144
7145@example
7146(use-modules (gnu) (guix))
7147
7148(operating-system
7149 (host-name "mymachine")
7150 ;; ...
7151 (hosts-file
7152 ;; Create a /etc/hosts file with aliases for "localhost"
7153 ;; and "mymachine", as well as for Facebook servers.
24e02c28
LC
7154 (plain-file "hosts"
7155 (string-append (local-host-aliases host-name)
7156 %facebook-host-aliases))))
fa0c1d61
LC
7157@end example
7158
7159This mechanism can prevent programs running locally, such as Web
7160browsers, from accessing Facebook.
7161@end defvr
7162
965a7332
LC
7163The @code{(gnu services avahi)} provides the following definition.
7164
be1c2c54 7165@deffn {Scheme Procedure} avahi-service [#:avahi @var{avahi}] @
965a7332
LC
7166 [#:host-name #f] [#:publish? #t] [#:ipv4? #t] @
7167 [#:ipv6? #t] [#:wide-area? #f] @
7168 [#:domains-to-browse '()]
7169Return a service that runs @command{avahi-daemon}, a system-wide
7170mDNS/DNS-SD responder that allows for service discovery and
cc9c1f39
LC
7171"zero-configuration" host name lookups (see @uref{http://avahi.org/}), and
7172extends the name service cache daemon (nscd) so that it can resolve
7173@code{.local} host names using
1065bed9
LC
7174@uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, nss-mdns}. Additionally,
7175add the @var{avahi} package to the system profile so that commands such as
7176@command{avahi-browse} are directly usable.
965a7332
LC
7177
7178If @var{host-name} is different from @code{#f}, use that as the host name to
7179publish for this machine; otherwise, use the machine's actual host name.
7180
7181When @var{publish?} is true, publishing of host names and services is allowed;
7182in particular, avahi-daemon will publish the machine's host name and IP
7183address via mDNS on the local network.
7184
7185When @var{wide-area?} is true, DNS-SD over unicast DNS is enabled.
7186
7187Boolean values @var{ipv4?} and @var{ipv6?} determine whether to use IPv4/IPv6
7188sockets.
7189@end deffn
7190
7191
cf4a9129
LC
7192@node X Window
7193@subsubsection X Window
68ad877c 7194
cf4a9129
LC
7195Support for the X Window graphical display system---specifically
7196Xorg---is provided by the @code{(gnu services xorg)} module. Note that
7197there is no @code{xorg-service} procedure. Instead, the X server is
7198started by the @dfn{login manager}, currently SLiM.
4af2447e 7199
be1c2c54 7200@deffn {Scheme Procedure} slim-service [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] @
0ecc3bf3
LC
7201 [#:auto-login? #f] [#:default-user ""] [#:startx] @
7202 [#:theme @var{%default-slim-theme}] @
4bd43bbe 7203 [#:theme-name @var{%default-slim-theme-name}]
cf4a9129
LC
7204Return a service that spawns the SLiM graphical login manager, which in
7205turn starts the X display server with @var{startx}, a command as returned by
7206@code{xorg-start-command}.
4af2447e 7207
04e4e6ab
LC
7208@cindex X session
7209
7210SLiM automatically looks for session types described by the @file{.desktop}
7211files in @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions} and allows users
7212to choose a session from the log-in screen using @kbd{F1}. Packages such as
7213@var{xfce}, @var{sawfish}, and @var{ratpoison} provide @file{.desktop} files;
7214adding them to the system-wide set of packages automatically makes them
7215available at the log-in screen.
7216
7217In addition, @file{~/.xsession} files are honored. When available,
7218@file{~/.xsession} must be an executable that starts a window manager
7219and/or other X clients.
7220
cf4a9129
LC
7221When @var{allow-empty-passwords?} is true, allow logins with an empty
7222password. When @var{auto-login?} is true, log in automatically as
7223@var{default-user}.
0ecc3bf3
LC
7224
7225If @var{theme} is @code{#f}, the use the default log-in theme; otherwise
7226@var{theme} must be a gexp denoting the name of a directory containing the
7227theme to use. In that case, @var{theme-name} specifies the name of the
7228theme.
cf4a9129 7229@end deffn
4af2447e 7230
0ecc3bf3
LC
7231@defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
7232@defvrx {Scheme Variable} %default-theme-name
7233The G-Expression denoting the default SLiM theme and its name.
7234@end defvr
7235
be1c2c54 7236@deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-start-command [#:guile] @
d1cdd7ba 7237 [#:configuration-file #f] [#:xorg-server @var{xorg-server}]
f703413e 7238Return a derivation that builds a @var{guile} script to start the X server
d1cdd7ba
LC
7239from @var{xorg-server}. @var{configuration-file} is the server configuration
7240file or a derivation that builds it; when omitted, the result of
7241@code{xorg-configuration-file} is used.
7242
7243Usually the X server is started by a login manager.
7244@end deffn
7245
be1c2c54 7246@deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-configuration-file @
12422c9d 7247 [#:drivers '()] [#:resolutions '()] [#:extra-config '()]
d1cdd7ba
LC
7248Return a configuration file for the Xorg server containing search paths for
7249all the common drivers.
f703413e
LC
7250
7251@var{drivers} must be either the empty list, in which case Xorg chooses a
7252graphics driver automatically, or a list of driver names that will be tried in
d1cdd7ba 7253this order---e.g., @code{(\"modesetting\" \"vesa\")}.
d2e59637
LC
7254
7255Likewise, when @var{resolutions} is the empty list, Xorg chooses an
7256appropriate screen resolution; otherwise, it must be a list of
7257resolutions---e.g., @code{((1024 768) (640 480))}.
12422c9d
LC
7258
7259Last, @var{extra-config} is a list of strings or objects appended to the
7260@code{text-file*} argument list. It is used to pass extra text to be added
7261verbatim to the configuration file.
f703413e 7262@end deffn
4af2447e 7263
6726282b
LC
7264@deffn {Scheme Procedure} screen-locker-service @var{package} [@var{name}]
7265Add @var{package}, a package for a screen-locker or screen-saver whose
7266command is @var{program}, to the set of setuid programs and add a PAM entry
7267for it. For example:
7268
7269@lisp
7270(screen-locker-service xlockmore "xlock")
7271@end lisp
7272
7273makes the good ol' XlockMore usable.
7274@end deffn
7275
7276
fe1a39d3
LC
7277@node Desktop Services
7278@subsubsection Desktop Services
aa4ed923 7279
fe1a39d3
LC
7280The @code{(gnu services desktop)} module provides services that are
7281usually useful in the context of a ``desktop'' setup---that is, on a
7282machine running a graphical display server, possibly with graphical user
7283interfaces, etc.
aa4ed923 7284
4467be21
LC
7285To simplify things, the module defines a variable containing the set of
7286services that users typically expect on a machine with a graphical
7287environment and networking:
7288
7289@defvr {Scheme Variable} %desktop-services
7290This is a list of services that builds upon @var{%base-services} and
7291adds or adjust services for a typical ``desktop'' setup.
7292
7293In particular, it adds a graphical login manager (@pxref{X Window,
6726282b
LC
7294@code{slim-service}}), screen lockers,
7295a network management tool (@pxref{Networking
4467be21 7296Services, @code{wicd-service}}), energy and color management services,
4650a77e 7297the @code{elogind} login and seat manager, the Polkit privilege service,
cee32ee4
AW
7298the GeoClue location service, an NTP client (@pxref{Networking
7299Services}), the Avahi daemon, and has the name service switch service
7300configured to be able to use @code{nss-mdns} (@pxref{Name Service
7301Switch, mDNS}).
4467be21
LC
7302@end defvr
7303
7304The @var{%desktop-services} variable can be used as the @code{services}
7305field of an @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system
7306Reference, @code{services}}).
7307
0adfe95a
LC
7308The actual service definitions provided by @code{(gnu services dbus)}
7309and @code{(gnu services desktop)} are described below.
4467be21 7310
0adfe95a 7311@deffn {Scheme Procedure} dbus-service [#:dbus @var{dbus}] [#:services '()]
fe1a39d3
LC
7312Return a service that runs the ``system bus'', using @var{dbus}, with
7313support for @var{services}.
aa4ed923 7314
fe1a39d3
LC
7315@uref{http://dbus.freedesktop.org/, D-Bus} is an inter-process communication
7316facility. Its system bus is used to allow system services to communicate
7317and be notified of system-wide events.
aa4ed923 7318
fe1a39d3
LC
7319@var{services} must be a list of packages that provide an
7320@file{etc/dbus-1/system.d} directory containing additional D-Bus configuration
7321and policy files. For example, to allow avahi-daemon to use the system bus,
7322@var{services} must be equal to @code{(list avahi)}.
aa4ed923
AK
7323@end deffn
7324
0adfe95a 7325@deffn {Scheme Procedure} elogind-service [#:config @var{config}]
4650a77e
AW
7326Return a service that runs the @code{elogind} login and
7327seat management daemon. @uref{https://github.com/andywingo/elogind,
7328Elogind} exposes a D-Bus interface that can be used to know which users
7329are logged in, know what kind of sessions they have open, suspend the
7330system, inhibit system suspend, reboot the system, and other tasks.
7331
7332Elogind handles most system-level power events for a computer, for
7333example suspending the system when a lid is closed, or shutting it down
7334when the power button is pressed.
7335
7336The @var{config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
7337elogind, and should be the result of a @code{(elogind-configuration
7338(@var{parameter} @var{value})...)} invocation. Available parameters and
7339their default values are:
7340
7341@table @code
7342@item kill-user-processes?
7343@code{#f}
7344@item kill-only-users
7345@code{()}
7346@item kill-exclude-users
7347@code{("root")}
7348@item inhibit-delay-max-seconds
7349@code{5}
7350@item handle-power-key
7351@code{poweroff}
7352@item handle-suspend-key
7353@code{suspend}
7354@item handle-hibernate-key
7355@code{hibernate}
7356@item handle-lid-switch
7357@code{suspend}
7358@item handle-lid-switch-docked
7359@code{ignore}
7360@item power-key-ignore-inhibited?
7361@code{#f}
7362@item suspend-key-ignore-inhibited?
7363@code{#f}
7364@item hibernate-key-ignore-inhibited?
7365@code{#f}
7366@item lid-switch-ignore-inhibited?
7367@code{#t}
7368@item holdoff-timeout-seconds
7369@code{30}
7370@item idle-action
7371@code{ignore}
7372@item idle-action-seconds
7373@code{(* 30 60)}
7374@item runtime-directory-size-percent
7375@code{10}
7376@item runtime-directory-size
7377@code{#f}
7378@item remove-ipc?
7379@code{#t}
7380@item suspend-state
7381@code{("mem" "standby" "freeze")}
7382@item suspend-mode
7383@code{()}
7384@item hibernate-state
7385@code{("disk")}
7386@item hibernate-mode
7387@code{("platform" "shutdown")}
7388@item hybrid-sleep-state
7389@code{("disk")}
7390@item hybrid-sleep-mode
7391@code{("suspend" "platform" "shutdown")}
7392@end table
7393@end deffn
7394
be1c2c54 7395@deffn {Scheme Procedure} polkit-service @
4650a77e 7396 [#:polkit @var{polkit}]
222e3319
LC
7397Return a service that runs the
7398@uref{http://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/polkit/, Polkit privilege
7399management service}, which allows system administrators to grant access to
7400privileged operations in a structured way. By querying the Polkit service, a
7401privileged system component can know when it should grant additional
7402capabilities to ordinary users. For example, an ordinary user can be granted
7403the capability to suspend the system if the user is logged in locally.
4650a77e
AW
7404@end deffn
7405
be1c2c54 7406@deffn {Scheme Procedure} upower-service [#:upower @var{upower}] @
be234128
AW
7407 [#:watts-up-pro? #f] @
7408 [#:poll-batteries? #t] @
7409 [#:ignore-lid? #f] @
7410 [#:use-percentage-for-policy? #f] @
7411 [#:percentage-low 10] @
7412 [#:percentage-critical 3] @
7413 [#:percentage-action 2] @
7414 [#:time-low 1200] @
7415 [#:time-critical 300] @
7416 [#:time-action 120] @
7417 [#:critical-power-action 'hybrid-sleep]
7418Return a service that runs @uref{http://upower.freedesktop.org/,
7419@command{upowerd}}, a system-wide monitor for power consumption and battery
7420levels, with the given configuration settings. It implements the
7421@code{org.freedesktop.UPower} D-Bus interface, and is notably used by
7422GNOME.
7423@end deffn
7424
2b9e0a94
LC
7425@deffn {Scheme Procedure} udisks-service [#:udisks @var{udisks}]
7426Return a service for @uref{http://udisks.freedesktop.org/docs/latest/,
7427UDisks}, a @dfn{disk management} daemon that provides user interfaces with
7428notifications and ways to mount/unmount disks. Programs that talk to UDisks
7429include the @command{udisksctl} command, part of UDisks, and GNOME Disks.
7430@end deffn
7431
be1c2c54 7432@deffn {Scheme Procedure} colord-service [#:colord @var{colord}]
7ce597ff
AW
7433Return a service that runs @command{colord}, a system service with a D-Bus
7434interface to manage the color profiles of input and output devices such as
7435screens and scanners. It is notably used by the GNOME Color Manager graphical
7436tool. See @uref{http://www.freedesktop.org/software/colord/, the colord web
7437site} for more information.
7438@end deffn
7439
cee32ee4
AW
7440@deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-application name [#:allowed? #t] [#:system? #f] [#:users '()]
7441Return an configuration allowing an application to access GeoClue
7442location data. @var{name} is the Desktop ID of the application, without
7443the @code{.desktop} part. If @var{allowed?} is true, the application
7444will have access to location information by default. The boolean
7445@var{system?} value indicates that an application is a system component
7446or not. Finally @var{users} is a list of UIDs of all users for which
7447this application is allowed location info access. An empty users list
7448means that all users are allowed.
7449@end deffn
7450
7451@defvr {Scheme Variable} %standard-geoclue-applications
7452The standard list of well-known GeoClue application configurations,
7453granting authority to GNOME's date-and-time utility to ask for the
7454current location in order to set the time zone, and allowing the Firefox
7455(IceCat) and Epiphany web browsers to request location information.
7456Firefox and Epiphany both query the user before allowing a web page to
7457know the user's location.
7458@end defvr
7459
be1c2c54 7460@deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-service [#:colord @var{colord}] @
cee32ee4
AW
7461 [#:whitelist '()] @
7462 [#:wifi-geolocation-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/geolocate?key=geoclue"] @
7463 [#:submit-data? #f]
7464 [#:wifi-submission-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/submit?key=geoclue"] @
7465 [#:submission-nick "geoclue"] @
7466 [#:applications %standard-geoclue-applications]
7467Return a service that runs the GeoClue location service. This service
7468provides a D-Bus interface to allow applications to request access to a
7469user's physical location, and optionally to add information to online
7470location databases. See
7471@uref{https://wiki.freedesktop.org/www/Software/GeoClue/, the GeoClue
7472web site} for more information.
7473@end deffn
7474
105369a4
DT
7475@node Database Services
7476@subsubsection Database Services
7477
7478The @code{(gnu services databases)} module provides the following service.
7479
be1c2c54 7480@deffn {Scheme Procedure} postgresql-service [#:postgresql postgresql] @
105369a4
DT
7481 [#:config-file] [#:data-directory ``/var/lib/postgresql/data'']
7482Return a service that runs @var{postgresql}, the PostgreSQL database
7483server.
7484
7485The PostgreSQL daemon loads its runtime configuration from
7486@var{config-file} and stores the database cluster in
7487@var{data-directory}.
7488@end deffn
fe1a39d3 7489
d8c18af8
AW
7490@node Mail Services
7491@subsubsection Mail Services
7492
7493The @code{(gnu services mail)} module provides Guix service definitions
7494for mail services. Currently the only implemented service is Dovecot,
7495an IMAP, POP3, and LMTP server.
7496
7497Guix does not yet have a mail transfer agent (MTA), although for some
7498lightweight purposes the @code{esmtp} relay-only MTA may suffice. Help
7499is needed to properly integrate a full MTA, such as Postfix. Patches
7500welcome!
7501
7502To add an IMAP/POP3 server to a GuixSD system, add a
7503@code{dovecot-service} to the operating system definition:
7504
7505@deffn {Scheme Procedure} dovecot-service [#:config (dovecot-configuration)]
7506Return a service that runs the Dovecot IMAP/POP3/LMTP mail server.
7507@end deffn
7508
7509By default, Dovecot doesn't need much configuration; the default
7510configuration object created by @code{(dovecot-configuration)} will
7511suffice if your mail is delivered to @code{~/Maildir}. A self-signed
7512certificate will be generated for TLS-protected connections, though
7513Dovecot will also listen on cleartext ports by default. There are a
7514number of options though which mail administrators might need to change,
7515and as is the case with other services, Guix allows the system
7516administrator to specify these parameters via a uniform Scheme interface.
7517
7518For example, to specify that mail is located at @code{maildir~/.mail},
7519one would instantiate the Dovecot service like this:
7520
7521@example
7522(dovecot-service #:config
7523 (dovecot-configuration
7524 (mail-location "maildir:~/.mail")))
7525@end example
7526
7527The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
7528definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
7529indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
7530strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
7531if you have an old @code{dovecot.conf} file that you want to port over
7532from some other system; see the end for more details.
7533
7534@c The following documentation was initially generated by
7535@c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services mail). Manually maintained
7536@c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
7537@c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
7538@c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
7539@c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
7540@c the churn as dovecot updates.
7541
7542Available @code{dovecot-configuration} fields are:
7543
7544@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
7545The dovecot package.
7546@end deftypevr
7547
7548@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list listen
7549A list of IPs or hosts where to listen in for connections. @samp{*}
7550listens in all IPv4 interfaces, @samp{::} listens in all IPv6
7551interfaces. If you want to specify non-default ports or anything more
7552complex, customize the address and port fields of the
7553@samp{inet-listener} of the specific services you are interested in.
7554@end deftypevr
7555
7556@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} protocol-configuration-list protocols
7557List of protocols we want to serve. Available protocols include
7558@samp{imap}, @samp{pop3}, and @samp{lmtp}.
7559
7560Available @code{protocol-configuration} fields are:
7561
7562@deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string name
7563The name of the protocol.
7564@end deftypevr
7565
7566@deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string auth-socket-path
7567UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
7568This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
7569Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
7570@end deftypevr
7571
7572@deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
7573Space separated list of plugins to load.
7574@end deftypevr
7575
7576@deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-userip-connections
7577Maximum number of IMAP connections allowed for a user from each IP
7578address. NOTE: The username is compared case-sensitively.
7579Defaults to @samp{10}.
7580@end deftypevr
7581
7582@end deftypevr
7583
7584@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} service-configuration-list services
7585List of services to enable. Available services include @samp{imap},
7586@samp{imap-login}, @samp{pop3}, @samp{pop3-login}, @samp{auth}, and
7587@samp{lmtp}.
7588
7589Available @code{service-configuration} fields are:
7590
7591@deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} string kind
7592The service kind. Valid values include @code{director},
7593@code{imap-login}, @code{pop3-login}, @code{lmtp}, @code{imap},
7594@code{pop3}, @code{auth}, @code{auth-worker}, @code{dict},
7595@code{tcpwrap}, @code{quota-warning}, or anything else.
7596@end deftypevr
7597
7598@deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} listener-configuration-list listeners
7599Listeners for the service. A listener is either an
7600@code{unix-listener-configuration}, a @code{fifo-listener-configuration}, or
7601an @code{inet-listener-configuration}.
7602Defaults to @samp{()}.
7603
7604Available @code{unix-listener-configuration} fields are:
7605
7606@deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} file-name path
7607The file name on which to listen.
7608@end deftypevr
7609
7610@deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
7611The access mode for the socket.
7612Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
7613@end deftypevr
7614
7615@deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
f9b9a033 7616The user to own the socket.
d8c18af8
AW
7617Defaults to @samp{""}.
7618@end deftypevr
7619
7620@deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
7621The group to own the socket.
7622Defaults to @samp{""}.
7623@end deftypevr
7624
7625
7626Available @code{fifo-listener-configuration} fields are:
7627
7628@deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} file-name path
7629The file name on which to listen.
7630@end deftypevr
7631
7632@deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
7633The access mode for the socket.
7634Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
7635@end deftypevr
7636
7637@deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
f9b9a033 7638The user to own the socket.
d8c18af8
AW
7639Defaults to @samp{""}.
7640@end deftypevr
7641
7642@deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
7643The group to own the socket.
7644Defaults to @samp{""}.
7645@end deftypevr
7646
7647
7648Available @code{inet-listener-configuration} fields are:
7649
7650@deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string protocol
7651The protocol to listen for.
7652@end deftypevr
7653
7654@deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string address
7655The address on which to listen, or empty for all addresses.
7656Defaults to @samp{""}.
7657@end deftypevr
7658
7659@deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
7660The port on which to listen.
7661@end deftypevr
7662
7663@deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl?
7664Whether to use SSL for this service; @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or
7665@samp{required}.
7666Defaults to @samp{#t}.
7667@end deftypevr
7668
7669@end deftypevr
7670
7671@deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer service-count
7672Number of connections to handle before starting a new process.
7673Typically the only useful values are 0 (unlimited) or 1. 1 is more
7674secure, but 0 is faster. <doc/wiki/LoginProcess.txt>.
7675Defaults to @samp{1}.
7676@end deftypevr
7677
7678@deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-min-avail
7679Number of processes to always keep waiting for more connections.
7680Defaults to @samp{0}.
7681@end deftypevr
7682
7683@deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer vsz-limit
7684If you set @samp{service-count 0}, you probably need to grow
7685this.
7686Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
7687@end deftypevr
7688
7689@end deftypevr
7690
7691@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} dict-configuration dict
7692Dict configuration, as created by the @code{dict-configuration}
7693constructor.
7694
7695Available @code{dict-configuration} fields are:
7696
7697@deftypevr {@code{dict-configuration} parameter} free-form-fields entries
7698A list of key-value pairs that this dict should hold.
7699Defaults to @samp{()}.
7700@end deftypevr
7701
7702@end deftypevr
7703
7704@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} passdb-configuration-list passdbs
7705List of passdb configurations, each one created by the
7706@code{passdb-configuration} constructor.
7707
7708Available @code{passdb-configuration} fields are:
7709
7710@deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
7711The driver that the passdb should use. Valid values include
7712@samp{pam}, @samp{passwd}, @samp{shadow}, @samp{bsdauth}, and
7713@samp{static}.
7714Defaults to @samp{"pam"}.
7715@end deftypevr
7716
7717@deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args args
7718A list of key-value args to the passdb driver.
7719Defaults to @samp{()}.
7720@end deftypevr
7721
7722@end deftypevr
7723
7724@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} userdb-configuration-list userdbs
7725List of userdb configurations, each one created by the
7726@code{userdb-configuration} constructor.
7727
7728Available @code{userdb-configuration} fields are:
7729
7730@deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
7731The driver that the userdb should use. Valid values include
7732@samp{passwd} and @samp{static}.
7733Defaults to @samp{"passwd"}.
7734@end deftypevr
7735
7736@deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args args
7737A list of key-value args to the userdb driver.
7738Defaults to @samp{()}.
7739@end deftypevr
7740
7741@deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args override-fields
7742Override fields from passwd.
7743Defaults to @samp{()}.
7744@end deftypevr
7745
7746@end deftypevr
7747
7748@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} plugin-configuration plugin-configuration
7749Plug-in configuration, created by the @code{plugin-configuration}
7750constructor.
7751@end deftypevr
7752
7753@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} list-of-namespace-configuration namespaces
7754List of namespaces. Each item in the list is created by the
7755@code{namespace-configuration} constructor.
7756
7757Available @code{namespace-configuration} fields are:
7758
7759@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string name
7760Name for this namespace.
7761@end deftypevr
7762
7763@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string type
7764Namespace type: @samp{private}, @samp{shared} or @samp{public}.
7765Defaults to @samp{"private"}.
7766@end deftypevr
7767
7768@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string separator
7769Hierarchy separator to use. You should use the same separator for
7770all namespaces or some clients get confused. @samp{/} is usually a good
7771one. The default however depends on the underlying mail storage
7772format.
7773Defaults to @samp{""}.
7774@end deftypevr
7775
7776@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string prefix
7777Prefix required to access this namespace. This needs to be
7778different for all namespaces. For example @samp{Public/}.
7779Defaults to @samp{""}.
7780@end deftypevr
7781
7782@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string location
7783Physical location of the mailbox. This is in same format as
7784mail_location, which is also the default for it.
7785Defaults to @samp{""}.
7786@end deftypevr
7787
7788@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean inbox?
7789There can be only one INBOX, and this setting defines which
7790namespace has it.
7791Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7792@end deftypevr
7793
7794@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean hidden?
7795If namespace is hidden, it's not advertised to clients via NAMESPACE
7796extension. You'll most likely also want to set @samp{list? #f}. This is mostly
7797useful when converting from another server with different namespaces
7798which you want to deprecate but still keep working. For example you can
7799create hidden namespaces with prefixes @samp{~/mail/}, @samp{~%u/mail/}
7800and @samp{mail/}.
7801Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7802@end deftypevr
7803
7804@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean list?
7805Show the mailboxes under this namespace with LIST command. This
7806makes the namespace visible for clients that don't support NAMESPACE
7807extension. The special @code{children} value lists child mailboxes, but
7808hides the namespace prefix.
7809Defaults to @samp{#t}.
7810@end deftypevr
7811
7812@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean subscriptions?
7813Namespace handles its own subscriptions. If set to @code{#f}, the
7814parent namespace handles them. The empty prefix should always have this
7815as @code{#t}.)
7816Defaults to @samp{#t}.
7817@end deftypevr
7818
7819@deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} mailbox-configuration-list mailboxes
7820List of predefined mailboxes in this namespace.
7821Defaults to @samp{()}.
7822
7823Available @code{mailbox-configuration} fields are:
7824
7825@deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string name
7826Name for this mailbox.
7827@end deftypevr
7828
7829@deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string auto
7830@samp{create} will automatically create this mailbox.
7831@samp{subscribe} will both create and subscribe to the mailbox.
7832Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
7833@end deftypevr
7834
7835@deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list special-use
7836List of IMAP @code{SPECIAL-USE} attributes as specified by RFC 6154.
7837Valid values are @code{\All}, @code{\Archive}, @code{\Drafts},
7838@code{\Flagged}, @code{\Junk}, @code{\Sent}, and @code{\Trash}.
7839Defaults to @samp{()}.
7840@end deftypevr
7841
7842@end deftypevr
7843
7844@end deftypevr
7845
7846@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name base-dir
7847Base directory where to store runtime data.
7848Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/"}.
7849@end deftypevr
7850
7851@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-greeting
7852Greeting message for clients.
7853Defaults to @samp{"Dovecot ready."}.
7854@end deftypevr
7855
7856@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-trusted-networks
7857List of trusted network ranges. Connections from these IPs are
7858allowed to override their IP addresses and ports (for logging and for
7859authentication checks). @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} is also ignored
7860for these networks. Typically you'd specify your IMAP proxy servers
7861here.
7862Defaults to @samp{()}.
7863@end deftypevr
7864
7865@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-access-sockets
7866List of login access check sockets (e.g. tcpwrap).
7867Defaults to @samp{()}.
7868@end deftypevr
7869
7870@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-proctitle?
7871Show more verbose process titles (in ps). Currently shows user name
7872and IP address. Useful for seeing who are actually using the IMAP
7873processes (e.g. shared mailboxes or if same uid is used for multiple
7874accounts).
7875Defaults to @samp{#f}.
7876@end deftypevr
7877
7878@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean shutdown-clients?
7879Should all processes be killed when Dovecot master process shuts down.
7880Setting this to @code{#f} means that Dovecot can be upgraded without
7881forcing existing client connections to close (although that could also
7882be a problem if the upgrade is e.g. because of a security fix).
7883Defaults to @samp{#t}.
7884@end deftypevr
7885
7886@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer doveadm-worker-count
7887If non-zero, run mail commands via this many connections to doveadm
7888server, instead of running them directly in the same process.
7889Defaults to @samp{0}.
7890@end deftypevr
7891
7892@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string doveadm-socket-path
7893UNIX socket or host:port used for connecting to doveadm server.
7894Defaults to @samp{"doveadm-server"}.
7895@end deftypevr
7896
7897@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list import-environment
7898List of environment variables that are preserved on Dovecot startup
7899and passed down to all of its child processes. You can also give
7900key=value pairs to always set specific settings.
7901@end deftypevr
7902
7903@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean disable-plaintext-auth?
7904Disable LOGIN command and all other plaintext authentications unless
7905SSL/TLS is used (LOGINDISABLED capability). Note that if the remote IP
7906matches the local IP (i.e. you're connecting from the same computer),
7907the connection is considered secure and plaintext authentication is
7908allowed. See also ssl=required setting.
7909Defaults to @samp{#t}.
7910@end deftypevr
7911
7912@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-cache-size
7913Authentication cache size (e.g. @samp{#e10e6}). 0 means it's disabled.
7914Note that bsdauth, PAM and vpopmail require @samp{cache-key} to be set
7915for caching to be used.
7916Defaults to @samp{0}.
7917@end deftypevr
7918
7919@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-ttl
7920Time to live for cached data. After TTL expires the cached record
7921is no longer used, *except* if the main database lookup returns internal
7922failure. We also try to handle password changes automatically: If
7923user's previous authentication was successful, but this one wasn't, the
7924cache isn't used. For now this works only with plaintext
7925authentication.
7926Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
7927@end deftypevr
7928
7929@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-negative-ttl
7930TTL for negative hits (user not found, password mismatch).
79310 disables caching them completely.
7932Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
7933@end deftypevr
7934
7935@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-realms
7936List of realms for SASL authentication mechanisms that need them.
7937You can leave it empty if you don't want to support multiple realms.
7938Many clients simply use the first one listed here, so keep the default
7939realm first.
7940Defaults to @samp{()}.
7941@end deftypevr
7942
7943@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-default-realm
7944Default realm/domain to use if none was specified. This is used for
7945both SASL realms and appending @@domain to username in plaintext
7946logins.
7947Defaults to @samp{""}.
7948@end deftypevr
7949
7950@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-chars
7951List of allowed characters in username. If the user-given username
7952contains a character not listed in here, the login automatically fails.
7953This is just an extra check to make sure user can't exploit any
7954potential quote escaping vulnerabilities with SQL/LDAP databases. If
7955you want to allow all characters, set this value to empty.
7956Defaults to @samp{"abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ01234567890.-_@@"}.
7957@end deftypevr
7958
7959@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-translation
7960Username character translations before it's looked up from
7961databases. The value contains series of from -> to characters. For
7962example @samp{#@@/@@} means that @samp{#} and @samp{/} characters are
7963translated to @samp{@@}.
7964Defaults to @samp{""}.
7965@end deftypevr
7966
7967@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-format
7968Username formatting before it's looked up from databases. You can
7969use the standard variables here, e.g. %Lu would lowercase the username,
7970%n would drop away the domain if it was given, or @samp{%n-AT-%d} would
7971change the @samp{@@} into @samp{-AT-}. This translation is done after
7972@samp{auth-username-translation} changes.
7973Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
7974@end deftypevr
7975
7976@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-master-user-separator
7977If you want to allow master users to log in by specifying the master
7978username within the normal username string (i.e. not using SASL
7979mechanism's support for it), you can specify the separator character
7980here. The format is then <username><separator><master username>.
7981UW-IMAP uses @samp{*} as the separator, so that could be a good
7982choice.
7983Defaults to @samp{""}.
7984@end deftypevr
7985
7986@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-anonymous-username
7987Username to use for users logging in with ANONYMOUS SASL
7988mechanism.
7989Defaults to @samp{"anonymous"}.
7990@end deftypevr
7991
7992@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-worker-max-count
7993Maximum number of dovecot-auth worker processes. They're used to
7994execute blocking passdb and userdb queries (e.g. MySQL and PAM).
7995They're automatically created and destroyed as needed.
7996Defaults to @samp{30}.
7997@end deftypevr
7998
7999@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-gssapi-hostname
8000Host name to use in GSSAPI principal names. The default is to use
8001the name returned by gethostname(). Use @samp{$ALL} (with quotes) to
8002allow all keytab entries.
8003Defaults to @samp{""}.
8004@end deftypevr
8005
8006@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-krb5-keytab
8007Kerberos keytab to use for the GSSAPI mechanism. Will use the
8008system default (usually /etc/krb5.keytab) if not specified. You may
8009need to change the auth service to run as root to be able to read this
8010file.
8011Defaults to @samp{""}.
8012@end deftypevr
8013
8014@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-use-winbind?
8015Do NTLM and GSS-SPNEGO authentication using Samba's winbind daemon
8016and @samp{ntlm-auth} helper.
8017<doc/wiki/Authentication/Mechanisms/Winbind.txt>.
8018Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8019@end deftypevr
8020
8021@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-winbind-helper-path
8022Path for Samba's @samp{ntlm-auth} helper binary.
8023Defaults to @samp{"/usr/bin/ntlm_auth"}.
8024@end deftypevr
8025
8026@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-failure-delay
8027Time to delay before replying to failed authentications.
8028Defaults to @samp{"2 secs"}.
8029@end deftypevr
8030
8031@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-require-client-cert?
8032Require a valid SSL client certificate or the authentication
8033fails.
8034Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8035@end deftypevr
8036
8037@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-username-from-cert?
8038Take the username from client's SSL certificate, using
8039@code{X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID()} which returns the subject's DN's
8040CommonName.
8041Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8042@end deftypevr
8043
8044@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-mechanisms
8045List of wanted authentication mechanisms. Supported mechanisms are:
8046@samp{plain}, @samp{login}, @samp{digest-md5}, @samp{cram-md5},
8047@samp{ntlm}, @samp{rpa}, @samp{apop}, @samp{anonymous}, @samp{gssapi},
8048@samp{otp}, @samp{skey}, and @samp{gss-spnego}. NOTE: See also
8049@samp{disable-plaintext-auth} setting.
8050@end deftypevr
8051
8052@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-servers
8053List of IPs or hostnames to all director servers, including ourself.
8054Ports can be specified as ip:port. The default port is the same as what
8055director service's @samp{inet-listener} is using.
8056Defaults to @samp{()}.
8057@end deftypevr
8058
8059@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-mail-servers
8060List of IPs or hostnames to all backend mail servers. Ranges are
8061allowed too, like 10.0.0.10-10.0.0.30.
8062Defaults to @samp{()}.
8063@end deftypevr
8064
8065@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-user-expire
8066How long to redirect users to a specific server after it no longer
8067has any connections.
8068Defaults to @samp{"15 min"}.
8069@end deftypevr
8070
8071@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer director-doveadm-port
8072TCP/IP port that accepts doveadm connections (instead of director
8073connections) If you enable this, you'll also need to add
8074@samp{inet-listener} for the port.
8075Defaults to @samp{0}.
8076@end deftypevr
8077
8078@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-username-hash
8079How the username is translated before being hashed. Useful values
8080include %Ln if user can log in with or without @@domain, %Ld if mailboxes
8081are shared within domain.
8082Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
8083@end deftypevr
8084
8085@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-path
8086Log file to use for error messages. @samp{syslog} logs to syslog,
8087@samp{/dev/stderr} logs to stderr.
8088Defaults to @samp{"syslog"}.
8089@end deftypevr
8090
8091@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string info-log-path
8092Log file to use for informational messages. Defaults to
8093@samp{log-path}.
8094Defaults to @samp{""}.
8095@end deftypevr
8096
8097@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string debug-log-path
8098Log file to use for debug messages. Defaults to
8099@samp{info-log-path}.
8100Defaults to @samp{""}.
8101@end deftypevr
8102
8103@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string syslog-facility
8104Syslog facility to use if you're logging to syslog. Usually if you
8105don't want to use @samp{mail}, you'll use local0..local7. Also other
8106standard facilities are supported.
8107Defaults to @samp{"mail"}.
8108@end deftypevr
8109
8110@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose?
8111Log unsuccessful authentication attempts and the reasons why they
8112failed.
8113Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8114@end deftypevr
8115
8116@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose-passwords?
8117In case of password mismatches, log the attempted password. Valid
8118values are no, plain and sha1. sha1 can be useful for detecting brute
8119force password attempts vs. user simply trying the same password over
8120and over again. You can also truncate the value to n chars by appending
8121":n" (e.g. sha1:6).
8122Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8123@end deftypevr
8124
8125@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug?
8126Even more verbose logging for debugging purposes. Shows for example
8127SQL queries.
8128Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8129@end deftypevr
8130
8131@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug-passwords?
8132In case of password mismatches, log the passwords and used scheme so
8133the problem can be debugged. Enabling this also enables
8134@samp{auth-debug}.
8135Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8136@end deftypevr
8137
8138@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-debug?
8139Enable mail process debugging. This can help you figure out why
8140Dovecot isn't finding your mails.
8141Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8142@end deftypevr
8143
8144@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-ssl?
8145Show protocol level SSL errors.
8146Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8147@end deftypevr
8148
8149@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-timestamp
8150Prefix for each line written to log file. % codes are in
8151strftime(3) format.
8152Defaults to @samp{"\"%b %d %H:%M:%S \""}.
8153@end deftypevr
8154
8155@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-log-format-elements
8156List of elements we want to log. The elements which have a
8157non-empty variable value are joined together to form a comma-separated
8158string.
8159@end deftypevr
8160
8161@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-log-format
8162Login log format. %s contains @samp{login-log-format-elements}
8163string, %$ contains the data we want to log.
8164Defaults to @samp{"%$: %s"}.
8165@end deftypevr
8166
8167@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-log-prefix
8168Log prefix for mail processes. See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for list
8169of possible variables you can use.
8170Defaults to @samp{"\"%s(%u): \""}.
8171@end deftypevr
8172
8173@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string deliver-log-format
8174Format to use for logging mail deliveries. You can use variables:
8175@table @code
8176@item %$
8177Delivery status message (e.g. @samp{saved to INBOX})
8178@item %m
8179Message-ID
8180@item %s
8181Subject
8182@item %f
8183From address
8184@item %p
8185Physical size
8186@item %w
8187Virtual size.
8188@end table
8189Defaults to @samp{"msgid=%m: %$"}.
8190@end deftypevr
8191
8192@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-location
8193Location for users' mailboxes. The default is empty, which means
8194that Dovecot tries to find the mailboxes automatically. This won't work
8195if the user doesn't yet have any mail, so you should explicitly tell
8196Dovecot the full location.
8197
8198If you're using mbox, giving a path to the INBOX
8199file (e.g. /var/mail/%u) isn't enough. You'll also need to tell Dovecot
8200where the other mailboxes are kept. This is called the "root mail
8201directory", and it must be the first path given in the
8202@samp{mail-location} setting.
8203
8204There are a few special variables you can use, eg.:
8205
8206@table @samp
8207@item %u
8208username
8209@item %n
8210user part in user@@domain, same as %u if there's no domain
8211@item %d
8212domain part in user@@domain, empty if there's no domain
8213@item %h
8214home director
8215@end table
8216
8217See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for full list. Some examples:
8218@table @samp
8219@item maildir:~/Maildir
8220@item mbox:~/mail:INBOX=/var/mail/%u
8221@item mbox:/var/mail/%d/%1n/%n:INDEX=/var/indexes/%d/%1n/%
8222@end table
8223Defaults to @samp{""}.
8224@end deftypevr
8225
8226@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-uid
8227System user and group used to access mails. If you use multiple,
8228userdb can override these by returning uid or gid fields. You can use
8229either numbers or names. <doc/wiki/UserIds.txt>.
8230Defaults to @samp{""}.
8231@end deftypevr
8232
8233@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-gid
8234
8235Defaults to @samp{""}.
8236@end deftypevr
8237
8238@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-privileged-group
8239Group to enable temporarily for privileged operations. Currently
8240this is used only with INBOX when either its initial creation or
8241dotlocking fails. Typically this is set to "mail" to give access to
8242/var/mail.
8243Defaults to @samp{""}.
8244@end deftypevr
8245
8246@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-access-groups
8247Grant access to these supplementary groups for mail processes.
8248Typically these are used to set up access to shared mailboxes. Note
8249that it may be dangerous to set these if users can create
8250symlinks (e.g. if "mail" group is set here, ln -s /var/mail ~/mail/var
8251could allow a user to delete others' mailboxes, or ln -s
8252/secret/shared/box ~/mail/mybox would allow reading it).
8253Defaults to @samp{""}.
8254@end deftypevr
8255
8256@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-full-filesystem-access?
8257Allow full filesystem access to clients. There's no access checks
8258other than what the operating system does for the active UID/GID. It
8259works with both maildir and mboxes, allowing you to prefix mailboxes
8260names with e.g. /path/ or ~user/.
8261Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8262@end deftypevr
8263
8264@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mmap-disable?
8265Don't use mmap() at all. This is required if you store indexes to
8266shared filesystems (NFS or clustered filesystem).
8267Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8268@end deftypevr
8269
8270@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean dotlock-use-excl?
8271Rely on @samp{O_EXCL} to work when creating dotlock files. NFS
8272supports @samp{O_EXCL} since version 3, so this should be safe to use
8273nowadays by default.
8274Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8275@end deftypevr
8276
8277@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-fsync
8278When to use fsync() or fdatasync() calls:
8279@table @code
8280@item optimized
8281Whenever necessary to avoid losing important data
8282@item always
8283Useful with e.g. NFS when write()s are delayed
8284@item never
8285Never use it (best performance, but crashes can lose data).
8286@end table
8287Defaults to @samp{"optimized"}.
8288@end deftypevr
8289
8290@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-storage?
8291Mail storage exists in NFS. Set this to yes to make Dovecot flush
8292NFS caches whenever needed. If you're using only a single mail server
8293this isn't needed.
8294Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8295@end deftypevr
8296
8297@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-index?
8298Mail index files also exist in NFS. Setting this to yes requires
8299@samp{mmap-disable? #t} and @samp{fsync-disable? #f}.
8300Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8301@end deftypevr
8302
8303@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lock-method
8304Locking method for index files. Alternatives are fcntl, flock and
8305dotlock. Dotlocking uses some tricks which may create more disk I/O
8306than other locking methods. NFS users: flock doesn't work, remember to
8307change @samp{mmap-disable}.
8308Defaults to @samp{"fcntl"}.
8309@end deftypevr
8310
8311@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-temp-dir
8312Directory in which LDA/LMTP temporarily stores incoming mails >128
8313kB.
8314Defaults to @samp{"/tmp"}.
8315@end deftypevr
8316
8317@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-uid
8318Valid UID range for users. This is mostly to make sure that users can't
8319log in as daemons or other system users. Note that denying root logins is
8320hardcoded to dovecot binary and can't be done even if @samp{first-valid-uid}
8321is set to 0.
8322Defaults to @samp{500}.
8323@end deftypevr
8324
8325@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-uid
8326
8327Defaults to @samp{0}.
8328@end deftypevr
8329
8330@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-gid
8331Valid GID range for users. Users having non-valid GID as primary group ID
8332aren't allowed to log in. If user belongs to supplementary groups with
8333non-valid GIDs, those groups are not set.
8334Defaults to @samp{1}.
8335@end deftypevr
8336
8337@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-gid
8338
8339Defaults to @samp{0}.
8340@end deftypevr
8341
8342@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-keyword-length
8343Maximum allowed length for mail keyword name. It's only forced when
8344trying to create new keywords.
8345Defaults to @samp{50}.
8346@end deftypevr
8347
8348@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} colon-separated-file-name-list valid-chroot-dirs
8349List of directories under which chrooting is allowed for mail
8350processes (i.e. /var/mail will allow chrooting to /var/mail/foo/bar
8351too). This setting doesn't affect @samp{login-chroot}
8352@samp{mail-chroot} or auth chroot settings. If this setting is empty,
8353"/./" in home dirs are ignored. WARNING: Never add directories here
8354which local users can modify, that may lead to root exploit. Usually
8355this should be done only if you don't allow shell access for users.
8356<doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
8357Defaults to @samp{()}.
8358@end deftypevr
8359
8360@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-chroot
8361Default chroot directory for mail processes. This can be overridden
8362for specific users in user database by giving /./ in user's home
8363directory (e.g. /home/./user chroots into /home). Note that usually
8364there is no real need to do chrooting, Dovecot doesn't allow users to
8365access files outside their mail directory anyway. If your home
8366directories are prefixed with the chroot directory, append "/." to
8367@samp{mail-chroot}. <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
8368Defaults to @samp{""}.
8369@end deftypevr
8370
8371@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-socket-path
8372UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
8373This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
8374Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
8375@end deftypevr
8376
8377@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-plugin-dir
8378Directory where to look up mail plugins.
8379Defaults to @samp{"/usr/lib/dovecot"}.
8380@end deftypevr
8381
8382@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
8383List of plugins to load for all services. Plugins specific to IMAP,
8384LDA, etc. are added to this list in their own .conf files.
8385Defaults to @samp{()}.
8386@end deftypevr
8387
8388@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-cache-min-mail-count
8389The minimum number of mails in a mailbox before updates are done to
8390cache file. This allows optimizing Dovecot's behavior to do less disk
8391writes at the cost of more disk reads.
8392Defaults to @samp{0}.
8393@end deftypevr
8394
8395@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mailbox-idle-check-interval
8396When IDLE command is running, mailbox is checked once in a while to
8397see if there are any new mails or other changes. This setting defines
8398the minimum time to wait between those checks. Dovecot can also use
8399dnotify, inotify and kqueue to find out immediately when changes
8400occur.
8401Defaults to @samp{"30 secs"}.
8402@end deftypevr
8403
8404@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-save-crlf?
8405Save mails with CR+LF instead of plain LF. This makes sending those
8406mails take less CPU, especially with sendfile() syscall with Linux and
8407FreeBSD. But it also creates a bit more disk I/O which may just make it
8408slower. Also note that if other software reads the mboxes/maildirs,
8409they may handle the extra CRs wrong and cause problems.
8410Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8411@end deftypevr
8412
8413@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-stat-dirs?
8414By default LIST command returns all entries in maildir beginning
8415with a dot. Enabling this option makes Dovecot return only entries
8416which are directories. This is done by stat()ing each entry, so it
8417causes more disk I/O.
8418 (For systems setting struct @samp{dirent->d_type} this check is free
8419and it's done always regardless of this setting).
8420Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8421@end deftypevr
8422
8423@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-copy-with-hardlinks?
8424When copying a message, do it with hard links whenever possible.
8425This makes the performance much better, and it's unlikely to have any
8426side effects.
8427Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8428@end deftypevr
8429
8430@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-very-dirty-syncs?
8431Assume Dovecot is the only MUA accessing Maildir: Scan cur/
8432directory only when its mtime changes unexpectedly or when we can't find
8433the mail otherwise.
8434Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8435@end deftypevr
8436
8437@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-read-locks
8438Which locking methods to use for locking mbox. There are four
8439available:
8440
8441@table @code
8442@item dotlock
8443Create <mailbox>.lock file. This is the oldest and most NFS-safe
8444solution. If you want to use /var/mail/ like directory, the users will
8445need write access to that directory.
8446@item dotlock-try
8447Same as dotlock, but if it fails because of permissions or because there
8448isn't enough disk space, just skip it.
8449@item fcntl
8450Use this if possible. Works with NFS too if lockd is used.
8451@item flock
8452May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
8453@item lockf
8454May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
8455@end table
8456
8457You can use multiple locking methods; if you do the order they're declared
8458in is important to avoid deadlocks if other MTAs/MUAs are using multiple
8459locking methods as well. Some operating systems don't allow using some of
8460them simultaneously.
8461@end deftypevr
8462
8463@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-write-locks
8464
8465@end deftypevr
8466
8467@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-lock-timeout
8468Maximum time to wait for lock (all of them) before aborting.
8469Defaults to @samp{"5 mins"}.
8470@end deftypevr
8471
8472@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-dotlock-change-timeout
8473If dotlock exists but the mailbox isn't modified in any way,
8474override the lock file after this much time.
8475Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
8476@end deftypevr
8477
8478@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-dirty-syncs?
8479When mbox changes unexpectedly we have to fully read it to find out
8480what changed. If the mbox is large this can take a long time. Since
8481the change is usually just a newly appended mail, it'd be faster to
8482simply read the new mails. If this setting is enabled, Dovecot does
8483this but still safely fallbacks to re-reading the whole mbox file
8484whenever something in mbox isn't how it's expected to be. The only real
8485downside to this setting is that if some other MUA changes message
8486flags, Dovecot doesn't notice it immediately. Note that a full sync is
8487done with SELECT, EXAMINE, EXPUNGE and CHECK commands.
8488Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8489@end deftypevr
8490
8491@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-very-dirty-syncs?
8492Like @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs}, but don't do full syncs even with SELECT,
8493EXAMINE, EXPUNGE or CHECK commands. If this is set,
8494@samp{mbox-dirty-syncs} is ignored.
8495Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8496@end deftypevr
8497
8498@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-lazy-writes?
8499Delay writing mbox headers until doing a full write sync (EXPUNGE
8500and CHECK commands and when closing the mailbox). This is especially
8501useful for POP3 where clients often delete all mails. The downside is
8502that our changes aren't immediately visible to other MUAs.
8503Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8504@end deftypevr
8505
8506@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mbox-min-index-size
8507If mbox size is smaller than this (e.g. 100k), don't write index
8508files. If an index file already exists it's still read, just not
8509updated.
8510Defaults to @samp{0}.
8511@end deftypevr
8512
8513@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mdbox-rotate-size
8514Maximum dbox file size until it's rotated.
8515Defaults to @samp{2000000}.
8516@end deftypevr
8517
8518@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mdbox-rotate-interval
8519Maximum dbox file age until it's rotated. Typically in days. Day
8520begins from midnight, so 1d = today, 2d = yesterday, etc. 0 = check
8521disabled.
8522Defaults to @samp{"1d"}.
8523@end deftypevr
8524
8525@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mdbox-preallocate-space?
8526When creating new mdbox files, immediately preallocate their size to
8527@samp{mdbox-rotate-size}. This setting currently works only in Linux
8528with some filesystems (ext4, xfs).
8529Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8530@end deftypevr
8531
8532@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-dir
8533sdbox and mdbox support saving mail attachments to external files,
8534which also allows single instance storage for them. Other backends
8535don't support this for now.
8536
8537WARNING: This feature hasn't been tested much yet. Use at your own risk.
8538
8539Directory root where to store mail attachments. Disabled, if empty.
8540Defaults to @samp{""}.
8541@end deftypevr
8542
8543@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-attachment-min-size
8544Attachments smaller than this aren't saved externally. It's also
8545possible to write a plugin to disable saving specific attachments
8546externally.
8547Defaults to @samp{128000}.
8548@end deftypevr
8549
8550@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-fs
8551Filesystem backend to use for saving attachments:
8552@table @code
8553@item posix
8554No SiS done by Dovecot (but this might help FS's own deduplication)
8555@item sis posix
8556SiS with immediate byte-by-byte comparison during saving
8557@item sis-queue posix
8558SiS with delayed comparison and deduplication.
8559@end table
8560Defaults to @samp{"sis posix"}.
8561@end deftypevr
8562
8563@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-hash
8564Hash format to use in attachment filenames. You can add any text and
8565variables: @code{%@{md4@}}, @code{%@{md5@}}, @code{%@{sha1@}},
8566@code{%@{sha256@}}, @code{%@{sha512@}}, @code{%@{size@}}. Variables can be
8567truncated, e.g. @code{%@{sha256:80@}} returns only first 80 bits.
8568Defaults to @samp{"%@{sha1@}"}.
8569@end deftypevr
8570
8571@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-process-limit
8572
8573Defaults to @samp{100}.
8574@end deftypevr
8575
8576@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-client-limit
8577
8578Defaults to @samp{1000}.
8579@end deftypevr
8580
8581@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-vsz-limit
8582Default VSZ (virtual memory size) limit for service processes.
8583This is mainly intended to catch and kill processes that leak memory
8584before they eat up everything.
8585Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
8586@end deftypevr
8587
8588@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-login-user
8589Login user is internally used by login processes. This is the most
8590untrusted user in Dovecot system. It shouldn't have access to anything
8591at all.
8592Defaults to @samp{"dovenull"}.
8593@end deftypevr
8594
8595@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-internal-user
8596Internal user is used by unprivileged processes. It should be
8597separate from login user, so that login processes can't disturb other
8598processes.
8599Defaults to @samp{"dovecot"}.
8600@end deftypevr
8601
8602@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl?
8603SSL/TLS support: yes, no, required. <doc/wiki/SSL.txt>.
8604Defaults to @samp{"required"}.
8605@end deftypevr
8606
8607@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert
8608PEM encoded X.509 SSL/TLS certificate (public key).
8609Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/default.pem"}.
8610@end deftypevr
8611
8612@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key
8613PEM encoded SSL/TLS private key. The key is opened before
8614dropping root privileges, so keep the key file unreadable by anyone but
8615root.
8616Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/private/default.pem"}.
8617@end deftypevr
8618
8619@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key-password
8620If key file is password protected, give the password here.
8621Alternatively give it when starting dovecot with -p parameter. Since
8622this file is often world-readable, you may want to place this setting
8623instead to a different.
8624Defaults to @samp{""}.
8625@end deftypevr
8626
8627@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca
8628PEM encoded trusted certificate authority. Set this only if you
8629intend to use @samp{ssl-verify-client-cert? #t}. The file should
8630contain the CA certificate(s) followed by the matching
8631CRL(s). (e.g. @samp{ssl-ca </etc/ssl/certs/ca.pem}).
8632Defaults to @samp{""}.
8633@end deftypevr
8634
8635@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-require-crl?
8636Require that CRL check succeeds for client certificates.
8637Defaults to @samp{#t}.
8638@end deftypevr
8639
8640@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-verify-client-cert?
8641Request client to send a certificate. If you also want to require
8642it, set @samp{auth-ssl-require-client-cert? #t} in auth section.
8643Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8644@end deftypevr
8645
8646@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-username-field
8647Which field from certificate to use for username. commonName and
8648x500UniqueIdentifier are the usual choices. You'll also need to set
8649@samp{auth-ssl-username-from-cert? #t}.
8650Defaults to @samp{"commonName"}.
8651@end deftypevr
8652
8653@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} hours ssl-parameters-regenerate
8654How often to regenerate the SSL parameters file. Generation is
8655quite CPU intensive operation. The value is in hours, 0 disables
8656regeneration entirely.
8657Defaults to @samp{168}.
8658@end deftypevr
8659
8660@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-protocols
8661SSL protocols to use.
8662Defaults to @samp{"!SSLv2"}.
8663@end deftypevr
8664
8665@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cipher-list
8666SSL ciphers to use.
8667Defaults to @samp{"ALL:!LOW:!SSLv2:!EXP:!aNULL"}.
8668@end deftypevr
8669
8670@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-crypto-device
8671SSL crypto device to use, for valid values run "openssl engine".
8672Defaults to @samp{""}.
8673@end deftypevr
8674
8675@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string postmaster-address
8676Address to use when sending rejection mails.
8677Default is postmaster@@<your domain>. %d expands to recipient domain.
8678Defaults to @samp{""}.
8679@end deftypevr
8680
8681@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string hostname
8682Hostname to use in various parts of sent mails (e.g. in Message-Id)
8683and in LMTP replies. Default is the system's real hostname@@domain.
8684Defaults to @samp{""}.
8685@end deftypevr
8686
8687@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean quota-full-tempfail?
8688If user is over quota, return with temporary failure instead of
8689bouncing the mail.
8690Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8691@end deftypevr
8692
8693@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name sendmail-path
8694Binary to use for sending mails.
8695Defaults to @samp{"/usr/sbin/sendmail"}.
8696@end deftypevr
8697
8698@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string submission-host
8699If non-empty, send mails via this SMTP host[:port] instead of
8700sendmail.
8701Defaults to @samp{""}.
8702@end deftypevr
8703
8704@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-subject
8705Subject: header to use for rejection mails. You can use the same
8706variables as for @samp{rejection-reason} below.
8707Defaults to @samp{"Rejected: %s"}.
8708@end deftypevr
8709
8710@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-reason
8711Human readable error message for rejection mails. You can use
8712variables:
8713
8714@table @code
8715@item %n
8716CRLF
8717@item %r
8718reason
8719@item %s
8720original subject
8721@item %t
8722recipient
8723@end table
8724Defaults to @samp{"Your message to <%t> was automatically rejected:%n%r"}.
8725@end deftypevr
8726
8727@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string recipient-delimiter
8728Delimiter character between local-part and detail in email
8729address.
8730Defaults to @samp{"+"}.
8731@end deftypevr
8732
8733@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lda-original-recipient-header
8734Header where the original recipient address (SMTP's RCPT TO:
8735address) is taken from if not available elsewhere. With dovecot-lda -a
8736parameter overrides this. A commonly used header for this is
8737X-Original-To.
8738Defaults to @samp{""}.
8739@end deftypevr
8740
8741@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autocreate?
8742Should saving a mail to a nonexistent mailbox automatically create
8743it?.
8744Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8745@end deftypevr
8746
8747@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autosubscribe?
8748Should automatically created mailboxes be also automatically
8749subscribed?.
8750Defaults to @samp{#f}.
8751@end deftypevr
8752
8753@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer imap-max-line-length
8754Maximum IMAP command line length. Some clients generate very long
8755command lines with huge mailboxes, so you may need to raise this if you
8756get "Too long argument" or "IMAP command line too large" errors
8757often.
8758Defaults to @samp{64000}.
8759@end deftypevr
8760
8761@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-logout-format
8762IMAP logout format string:
8763@table @code
8764@item %i
8765total number of bytes read from client
8766@item %o
8767total number of bytes sent to client.
8768@end table
8769Defaults to @samp{"in=%i out=%o"}.
8770@end deftypevr
8771
8772@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-capability
8773Override the IMAP CAPABILITY response. If the value begins with '+',
8774add the given capabilities on top of the defaults (e.g. +XFOO XBAR).
8775Defaults to @samp{""}.
8776@end deftypevr
8777
8778@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-idle-notify-interval
8779How long to wait between "OK Still here" notifications when client
8780is IDLEing.
8781Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
8782@end deftypevr
8783
8784@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-send
8785ID field names and values to send to clients. Using * as the value
8786makes Dovecot use the default value. The following fields have default
8787values currently: name, version, os, os-version, support-url,
8788support-email.
8789Defaults to @samp{""}.
8790@end deftypevr
8791
8792@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-log
8793ID fields sent by client to log. * means everything.
8794Defaults to @samp{""}.
8795@end deftypevr
8796
8797@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list imap-client-workarounds
8798Workarounds for various client bugs:
8799
8800@table @code
8801@item delay-newmail
8802Send EXISTS/RECENT new mail notifications only when replying to NOOP and
8803CHECK commands. Some clients ignore them otherwise, for example OSX
8804Mail (<v2.1). Outlook Express breaks more badly though, without this it
8805may show user "Message no longer in server" errors. Note that OE6
8806still breaks even with this workaround if synchronization is set to
8807"Headers Only".
8808
8809@item tb-extra-mailbox-sep
8810Thunderbird gets somehow confused with LAYOUT=fs (mbox and dbox) and
8811adds extra @samp{/} suffixes to mailbox names. This option causes Dovecot to
8812ignore the extra @samp{/} instead of treating it as invalid mailbox name.
8813
8814@item tb-lsub-flags
8815Show \Noselect flags for LSUB replies with LAYOUT=fs (e.g. mbox).
8816This makes Thunderbird realize they aren't selectable and show them
8817greyed out, instead of only later giving "not selectable" popup error.
8818@end table
8819Defaults to @samp{()}.
8820@end deftypevr
8821
8822@deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-urlauth-host
8823Host allowed in URLAUTH URLs sent by client. "*" allows all.
8824Defaults to @samp{""}.
8825@end deftypevr
8826
8827
8828Whew! Lots of configuration options. The nice thing about it though is
8829that GuixSD has a complete interface to Dovecot's configuration
8830language. This allows not only a nice way to declare configurations,
8831but also offers reflective capabilities as well: users can write code to
8832inspect and transform configurations from within Scheme.
8833
8834However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{dovecot.conf} up
8835and running. In that case, you can pass an
8836@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} as the @code{#:config} paramter to
8837@code{dovecot-service}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
8838does not have easy reflective capabilities.
8839
8840Available @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} fields are:
8841
8842@deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
8843The dovecot package.
8844@end deftypevr
8845
8846@deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} string string
8847The contents of the @code{dovecot.conf}, as a string.
8848@end deftypevr
8849
8850For example, if your @code{dovecot.conf} is just the empty string, you
8851could instantiate a dovecot service like this:
8852
8853@example
8854(dovecot-service #:config
8855 (opaque-dovecot-configuration
8856 (string "")))
8857@end example
8858
58724c48
DT
8859@node Web Services
8860@subsubsection Web Services
8861
8862The @code{(gnu services web)} module provides the following service:
8863
be1c2c54 8864@deffn {Scheme Procedure} nginx-service [#:nginx nginx] @
58724c48
DT
8865 [#:log-directory ``/var/log/nginx''] @
8866 [#:run-directory ``/var/run/nginx''] @
8867 [#:config-file]
8868
8869Return a service that runs @var{nginx}, the nginx web server.
8870
8871The nginx daemon loads its runtime configuration from @var{config-file}.
8872Log files are written to @var{log-directory} and temporary runtime data
8873files are written to @var{run-directory}. For proper operation, these
8874arguments should match what is in @var{config-file} to ensure that the
8875directories are created when the service is activated.
8876
8877@end deffn
8878
fe1a39d3
LC
8879@node Various Services
8880@subsubsection Various Services
8881
8882The @code{(gnu services lirc)} module provides the following service.
8883
be1c2c54 8884@deffn {Scheme Procedure} lirc-service [#:lirc lirc] @
fe1a39d3
LC
8885 [#:device #f] [#:driver #f] [#:config-file #f] @
8886 [#:extra-options '()]
8887Return a service that runs @url{http://www.lirc.org,LIRC}, a daemon that
8888decodes infrared signals from remote controls.
8889
8890Optionally, @var{device}, @var{driver} and @var{config-file}
8891(configuration file name) may be specified. See @command{lircd} manual
8892for details.
8893
8894Finally, @var{extra-options} is a list of additional command-line options
8895passed to @command{lircd}.
8896@end deffn
8897
8898
0ae8c15a
LC
8899@node Setuid Programs
8900@subsection Setuid Programs
8901
8902@cindex setuid programs
8903Some programs need to run with ``root'' privileges, even when they are
8904launched by unprivileged users. A notorious example is the
4d40227c
LC
8905@command{passwd} program, which users can run to change their
8906password, and which needs to access the @file{/etc/passwd} and
0ae8c15a
LC
8907@file{/etc/shadow} files---something normally restricted to root, for
8908obvious security reasons. To address that, these executables are
8909@dfn{setuid-root}, meaning that they always run with root privileges
8910(@pxref{How Change Persona,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual},
f7e4ae7f 8911for more info about the setuid mechanism.)
0ae8c15a
LC
8912
8913The store itself @emph{cannot} contain setuid programs: that would be a
8914security issue since any user on the system can write derivations that
8915populate the store (@pxref{The Store}). Thus, a different mechanism is
8916used: instead of changing the setuid bit directly on files that are in
8917the store, we let the system administrator @emph{declare} which programs
8918should be setuid root.
8919
8920The @code{setuid-programs} field of an @code{operating-system}
8921declaration contains a list of G-expressions denoting the names of
8922programs to be setuid-root (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
8923For instance, the @command{passwd} program, which is part of the Shadow
8924package, can be designated by this G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
8925
8926@example
8927#~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/passwd")
8928@end example
8929
8930A default set of setuid programs is defined by the
8931@code{%setuid-programs} variable of the @code{(gnu system)} module.
8932
8933@defvr {Scheme Variable} %setuid-programs
8934A list of G-expressions denoting common programs that are setuid-root.
8935
8936The list includes commands such as @command{passwd}, @command{ping},
8937@command{su}, and @command{sudo}.
8938@end defvr
8939
8940Under the hood, the actual setuid programs are created in the
8941@file{/run/setuid-programs} directory at system activation time. The
8942files in this directory refer to the ``real'' binaries, which are in the
8943store.
8944
efb5e833
LC
8945@node X.509 Certificates
8946@subsection X.509 Certificates
8947
8948@cindex HTTPS, certificates
8949@cindex X.509 certificates
8950@cindex TLS
8951Web servers available over HTTPS (that is, HTTP over the transport-layer
8952security mechanism, TLS) send client programs an @dfn{X.509 certificate}
8953that the client can then use to @emph{authenticate} the server. To do
8954that, clients verify that the server's certificate is signed by a
8955so-called @dfn{certificate authority} (CA). But to verify the CA's
8956signature, clients must have first acquired the CA's certificate.
8957
8958Web browsers such as GNU@tie{}IceCat include their own set of CA
8959certificates, such that they are able to verify CA signatures
8960out-of-the-box.
8961
8962However, most other programs that can talk HTTPS---@command{wget},
8963@command{git}, @command{w3m}, etc.---need to be told where CA
8964certificates can be found.
8965
8966@cindex @code{nss-certs}
8967In GuixSD, this is done by adding a package that provides certificates
8968to the @code{packages} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
8969(@pxref{operating-system Reference}). GuixSD includes one such package,
8970@code{nss-certs}, which is a set of CA certificates provided as part of
8971Mozilla's Network Security Services.
8972
8973Note that it is @emph{not} part of @var{%base-packages}, so you need to
8974explicitly add it. The @file{/etc/ssl/certs} directory, which is where
8975most applications and libraries look for certificates by default, points
8976to the certificates installed globally.
8977
8978Unprivileged users can also install their own certificate package in
8979their profile. A number of environment variables need to be defined so
8980that applications and libraries know where to find them. Namely, the
8981OpenSSL library honors the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} and @code{SSL_CERT_FILE}
8982variables. Some applications add their own environment variables; for
8983instance, the Git version control system honors the certificate bundle
8984pointed to by the @code{GIT_SSL_CAINFO} environment variable.
8985
8986
996ed739
LC
8987@node Name Service Switch
8988@subsection Name Service Switch
8989
8990@cindex name service switch
8991@cindex NSS
8992The @code{(gnu system nss)} module provides bindings to the
8993configuration file of libc's @dfn{name service switch} or @dfn{NSS}
8994(@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
8995Manual}). In a nutshell, the NSS is a mechanism that allows libc to be
8996extended with new ``name'' lookup methods for system databases, which
8997includes host names, service names, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name
8998Service Switch, System Databases and Name Service Switch,, libc, The GNU
8999C Library Reference Manual}).
9000
9001The NSS configuration specifies, for each system database, which lookup
9002method is to be used, and how the various methods are chained
9003together---for instance, under which circumstances NSS should try the
9004next method in the list. The NSS configuration is given in the
9005@code{name-service-switch} field of @code{operating-system} declarations
9006(@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{name-service-switch}}).
9007
4c9050c6
LC
9008@cindex nss-mdns
9009@cindex .local, host name lookup
996ed739 9010As an example, the declaration below configures the NSS to use the
4c9050c6
LC
9011@uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, @code{nss-mdns}
9012back-end}, which supports host name lookups over multicast DNS (mDNS)
9013for host names ending in @code{.local}:
996ed739
LC
9014
9015@example
9016(name-service-switch
9017 (hosts (list %files ;first, check /etc/hosts
9018
9019 ;; If the above did not succeed, try
9020 ;; with 'mdns_minimal'.
9021 (name-service
9022 (name "mdns_minimal")
9023
9024 ;; 'mdns_minimal' is authoritative for
9025 ;; '.local'. When it returns "not found",
9026 ;; no need to try the next methods.
9027 (reaction (lookup-specification
9028 (not-found => return))))
9029
9030 ;; Then fall back to DNS.
9031 (name-service
9032 (name "dns"))
9033
9034 ;; Finally, try with the "full" 'mdns'.
9035 (name-service
9036 (name "mdns")))))
9037@end example
9038
15137a29
LC
9039Don't worry: the @code{%mdns-host-lookup-nss} variable (see below)
9040contains this configuration, so you won't have to type it if all you
9041want is to have @code{.local} host lookup working.
9042
4c9050c6
LC
9043Note that, in this case, in addition to setting the
9044@code{name-service-switch} of the @code{operating-system} declaration,
cc9c1f39
LC
9045you also need to use @code{avahi-service} (@pxref{Networking Services,
9046@code{avahi-service}}), or @var{%desktop-services}, which includes it
9047(@pxref{Desktop Services}). Doing this makes @code{nss-mdns} accessible
9048to the name service cache daemon (@pxref{Base Services,
9049@code{nscd-service}}).
15137a29
LC
9050
9051For convenience, the following variables provide typical NSS
9052configurations.
9053
9054@defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-nss
9055This is the default name service switch configuration, a
9056@code{name-service-switch} object.
9057@end defvr
9058
9059@defvr {Scheme Variable} %mdns-host-lookup-nss
9060This is the name service switch configuration with support for host name
9061lookup over multicast DNS (mDNS) for host names ending in @code{.local}.
9062@end defvr
4c9050c6 9063
996ed739
LC
9064The reference for name service switch configuration is given below. It
9065is a direct mapping of the C library's configuration file format, so
9066please refer to the C library manual for more information (@pxref{NSS
9067Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
9068Compared to libc's NSS configuration file format, it has the advantage
9069not only of adding this warm parenthetic feel that we like, but also
9070static checks: you'll know about syntax errors and typos as soon as you
9071run @command{guix system}.
9072
996ed739
LC
9073@deftp {Data Type} name-service-switch
9074
9075This is the data type representation the configuration of libc's name
9076service switch (NSS). Each field below represents one of the supported
9077system databases.
9078
9079@table @code
9080@item aliases
9081@itemx ethers
9082@itemx group
9083@itemx gshadow
9084@itemx hosts
9085@itemx initgroups
9086@itemx netgroup
9087@itemx networks
9088@itemx password
9089@itemx public-key
9090@itemx rpc
9091@itemx services
9092@itemx shadow
9093The system databases handled by the NSS. Each of these fields must be a
9094list of @code{<name-service>} objects (see below.)
9095@end table
9096@end deftp
9097
9098@deftp {Data Type} name-service
9099
9100This is the data type representing an actual name service and the
9101associated lookup action.
9102
9103@table @code
9104@item name
9105A string denoting the name service (@pxref{Services in the NSS
9106configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
9107
4aee6e60
LC
9108Note that name services listed here must be visible to nscd. This is
9109achieved by passing the @code{#:name-services} argument to
9110@code{nscd-service} the list of packages providing the needed name
9111services (@pxref{Base Services, @code{nscd-service}}).
9112
996ed739
LC
9113@item reaction
9114An action specified using the @code{lookup-specification} macro
9115(@pxref{Actions in the NSS configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library
9116Reference Manual}). For example:
9117
9118@example
9119(lookup-specification (unavailable => continue)
9120 (success => return))
9121@end example
9122@end table
9123@end deftp
0ae8c15a 9124
fd1b1fa2
LC
9125@node Initial RAM Disk
9126@subsection Initial RAM Disk
9127
9128@cindex initial RAM disk (initrd)
9129@cindex initrd (initial RAM disk)
9130For bootstrapping purposes, the Linux-Libre kernel is passed an
9131@dfn{initial RAM disk}, or @dfn{initrd}. An initrd contains a temporary
9132root file system, as well as an initialization script. The latter is
9133responsible for mounting the real root file system, and for loading any
9134kernel modules that may be needed to achieve that.
9135
9136The @code{initrd} field of an @code{operating-system} declaration allows
9137you to specify which initrd you would like to use. The @code{(gnu
9138system linux-initrd)} module provides two ways to build an initrd: the
9139high-level @code{base-initrd} procedure, and the low-level
9140@code{expression->initrd} procedure.
9141
9142The @code{base-initrd} procedure is intended to cover most common uses.
9143For example, if you want to add a bunch of kernel modules to be loaded
9144at boot time, you can define the @code{initrd} field of the operating
9145system declaration like this:
9146
9147@example
52ac153e 9148(initrd (lambda (file-systems . rest)
027981d6
LC
9149 ;; Create a standard initrd that has modules "foo.ko"
9150 ;; and "bar.ko", as well as their dependencies, in
9151 ;; addition to the modules available by default.
52ac153e 9152 (apply base-initrd file-systems
027981d6 9153 #:extra-modules '("foo" "bar")
52ac153e 9154 rest)))
fd1b1fa2
LC
9155@end example
9156
52ac153e
LC
9157The @code{base-initrd} procedure also handles common use cases that
9158involves using the system as a QEMU guest, or as a ``live'' system whose
9159root file system is volatile.
fd1b1fa2 9160
e90cf6c1
LC
9161The initial RAM disk produced by @code{base-initrd} honors several
9162options passed on the Linux kernel command line (that is, arguments
9163passed @i{via} GRUB's @code{linux} command, or with QEMU's
9164@code{-append} option), notably:
9165
9166@table @code
9167@item --load=@var{boot}
9168Tell the initial RAM disk to load @var{boot}, a file containing a Scheme
9169program, once it has mounted the root file system.
9170
9171GuixSD uses this option to yield control to a boot program that runs the
dd17bc38 9172service activation programs and then spawns the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, the
e90cf6c1
LC
9173initialization system.
9174
9175@item --root=@var{root}
9176Mount @var{root} as the root file system. @var{root} can be a device
9177device name like @code{/dev/sda1}, a partition label, or a partition
9178UUID.
9179
9180@item --system=@var{system}
9181Have @file{/run/booted-system} and @file{/run/current-system} point to
9182@var{system}.
9183
9184@item modprobe.blacklist=@var{modules}@dots{}
9185@cindex module, black-listing
9186@cindex black list, of kernel modules
9187Instruct the initial RAM disk as well as the @command{modprobe} command
9188(from the kmod package) to refuse to load @var{modules}. @var{modules}
9189must be a comma-separated list of module names---e.g.,
9190@code{usbkbd,9pnet}.
9191
9192@item --repl
9193Start a read-eval-print loop (REPL) from the initial RAM disk before it
9194tries to load kernel modules and to mount the root file system. Our
9195marketing team calls it @dfn{boot-to-Guile}. The Schemer in you will
9196love it. @xref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
9197Manual}, for more information on Guile's REPL.
9198
9199@end table
9200
9201Now that you know all the features that initial RAM disks produced by
9202@code{base-initrd} provide, here is how to use it and customize it
9203further.
9204
fd1b1fa2 9205@deffn {Monadic Procedure} base-initrd @var{file-systems} @
9059b97d 9206 [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:virtio? #t] [#:volatile-root? #f] @
52ac153e 9207 [#:extra-modules '()] [#:mapped-devices '()]
fd1b1fa2
LC
9208Return a monadic derivation that builds a generic initrd. @var{file-systems} is
9209a list of file-systems to be mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to
9210the root file system specified on the kernel command line via @code{--root}.
52ac153e
LC
9211@var{mapped-devices} is a list of device mappings to realize before
9212@var{file-systems} are mounted (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
fd1b1fa2
LC
9213
9214When @var{qemu-networking?} is true, set up networking with the standard QEMU
9215parameters. When @var{virtio?} is true, load additional modules so the initrd can
9216be used as a QEMU guest with para-virtualized I/O drivers.
9217
9218When @var{volatile-root?} is true, the root file system is writable but any changes
9219to it are lost.
9220
9221The initrd is automatically populated with all the kernel modules necessary
9222for @var{file-systems} and for the given options. However, additional kernel
9223modules can be listed in @var{extra-modules}. They will be added to the initrd, and
9224loaded at boot time in the order in which they appear.
9225@end deffn
9226
9227Needless to say, the initrds we produce and use embed a
9228statically-linked Guile, and the initialization program is a Guile
9229program. That gives a lot of flexibility. The
9230@code{expression->initrd} procedure builds such an initrd, given the
9231program to run in that initrd.
9232
9233@deffn {Monadic Procedure} expression->initrd @var{exp} @
9234 [#:guile %guile-static-stripped] [#:name "guile-initrd"] @
42d10464 9235 [#:modules '()]
fd1b1fa2
LC
9236Return a derivation that builds a Linux initrd (a gzipped cpio archive)
9237containing @var{guile} and that evaluates @var{exp}, a G-expression,
df650fa8
LC
9238upon booting. All the derivations referenced by @var{exp} are
9239automatically copied to the initrd.
fd1b1fa2 9240
42d10464
LC
9241@var{modules} is a list of Guile module names to be embedded in the
9242initrd.
fd1b1fa2
LC
9243@end deffn
9244
88faf933
LC
9245@node GRUB Configuration
9246@subsection GRUB Configuration
9247
9248@cindex GRUB
9249@cindex boot loader
9250
9251The operating system uses GNU@tie{}GRUB as its boot loader
9252(@pxref{Overview, overview of GRUB,, grub, GNU GRUB Manual}). It is
9253configured using @code{grub-configuration} declarations. This data type
9254is exported by the @code{(gnu system grub)} module, and described below.
9255
9256@deftp {Data Type} grub-configuration
9257The type of a GRUB configuration declaration.
9258
9259@table @asis
9260
9261@item @code{device}
9262This is a string denoting the boot device. It must be a device name
9263understood by the @command{grub-install} command, such as
9264@code{/dev/sda} or @code{(hd0)} (@pxref{Invoking grub-install,,, grub,
9265GNU GRUB Manual}).
9266
9267@item @code{menu-entries} (default: @code{()})
9268A possibly empty list of @code{menu-entry} objects (see below), denoting
9269entries to appear in the GRUB boot menu, in addition to the current
9270system entry and the entry pointing to previous system generations.
9271
9272@item @code{default-entry} (default: @code{0})
9273The index of the default boot menu entry. Index 0 is for the current
9274system's entry.
9275
9276@item @code{timeout} (default: @code{5})
9277The number of seconds to wait for keyboard input before booting. Set to
92780 to boot immediately, and to -1 to wait indefinitely.
9279
9280@item @code{theme} (default: @var{%default-theme})
9281The @code{grub-theme} object describing the theme to use.
9282@end table
9283
9284@end deftp
9285
9286Should you want to list additional boot menu entries @i{via} the
9287@code{menu-entries} field above, you will need to create them with the
9288@code{menu-entry} form:
9289
9290@deftp {Data Type} menu-entry
9291The type of an entry in the GRUB boot menu.
9292
9293@table @asis
9294
9295@item @code{label}
35ed9306 9296The label to show in the menu---e.g., @code{"GNU"}.
88faf933
LC
9297
9298@item @code{linux}
9299The Linux kernel to boot.
9300
9301@item @code{linux-arguments} (default: @code{()})
9302The list of extra Linux kernel command-line arguments---e.g.,
9303@code{("console=ttyS0")}.
9304
9305@item @code{initrd}
9306A G-Expression or string denoting the file name of the initial RAM disk
9307to use (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
9308
9309@end table
9310@end deftp
9311
9312@c FIXME: Write documentation once it's stable.
9313Themes are created using the @code{grub-theme} form, which is not
9314documented yet.
9315
9316@defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
9317This is the default GRUB theme used by the operating system, with a
9318fancy background image displaying the GNU and Guix logos.
9319@end defvr
9320
9321
cf4a9129
LC
9322@node Invoking guix system
9323@subsection Invoking @code{guix system}
0918e64a 9324
cf4a9129
LC
9325Once you have written an operating system declaration, as seen in the
9326previous section, it can be @dfn{instantiated} using the @command{guix
9327system} command. The synopsis is:
4af2447e 9328
cf4a9129
LC
9329@example
9330guix system @var{options}@dots{} @var{action} @var{file}
9331@end example
4af2447e 9332
cf4a9129
LC
9333@var{file} must be the name of a file containing an
9334@code{operating-system} declaration. @var{action} specifies how the
9335operating system is instantiate. Currently the following values are
9336supported:
4af2447e 9337
cf4a9129
LC
9338@table @code
9339@item reconfigure
9340Build the operating system described in @var{file}, activate it, and
9341switch to it@footnote{This action is usable only on systems already
65797bff 9342running GuixSD.}.
4af2447e 9343
cf4a9129
LC
9344This effects all the configuration specified in @var{file}: user
9345accounts, system services, global package list, setuid programs, etc.
240b57f0
LC
9346The command starts system services specified in @var{file} that are not
9347currently running; if a service is currently running, it does not
9348attempt to upgrade it since it would not be possible without stopping it
9349first.
4af2447e 9350
cf4a9129
LC
9351It also adds a GRUB menu entry for the new OS configuration, and moves
9352entries for older configurations to a submenu---unless
9353@option{--no-grub} is passed.
4af2447e 9354
240b57f0 9355@quotation Note
bf2479c7
LC
9356@c The paragraph below refers to the problem discussed at
9357@c <http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2014-08/msg00057.html>.
9358It is highly recommended to run @command{guix pull} once before you run
9359@command{guix system reconfigure} for the first time (@pxref{Invoking
9360guix pull}). Failing to do that you would see an older version of Guix
9361once @command{reconfigure} has completed.
240b57f0 9362@end quotation
bf2479c7 9363
cf4a9129
LC
9364@item build
9365Build the operating system's derivation, which includes all the
9366configuration files and programs needed to boot and run the system.
9367This action does not actually install anything.
113daf62 9368
cf4a9129
LC
9369@item init
9370Populate the given directory with all the files necessary to run the
9371operating system specified in @var{file}. This is useful for first-time
4705641f 9372installations of GuixSD. For instance:
113daf62
LC
9373
9374@example
cf4a9129 9375guix system init my-os-config.scm /mnt
113daf62
LC
9376@end example
9377
cf4a9129
LC
9378copies to @file{/mnt} all the store items required by the configuration
9379specified in @file{my-os-config.scm}. This includes configuration
9380files, packages, and so on. It also creates other essential files
9381needed for the system to operate correctly---e.g., the @file{/etc},
9382@file{/var}, and @file{/run} directories, and the @file{/bin/sh} file.
113daf62 9383
cf4a9129
LC
9384This command also installs GRUB on the device specified in
9385@file{my-os-config}, unless the @option{--no-grub} option was passed.
113daf62 9386
cf4a9129
LC
9387@item vm
9388@cindex virtual machine
0276f697 9389@cindex VM
f535dcbe 9390@anchor{guix system vm}
cf4a9129
LC
9391Build a virtual machine that contain the operating system declared in
9392@var{file}, and return a script to run that virtual machine (VM).
810568b3 9393Arguments given to the script are passed as is to QEMU.
113daf62 9394
cf4a9129 9395The VM shares its store with the host system.
113daf62 9396
0276f697
LC
9397Additional file systems can be shared between the host and the VM using
9398the @code{--share} and @code{--expose} command-line options: the former
9399specifies a directory to be shared with write access, while the latter
9400provides read-only access to the shared directory.
9401
9402The example below creates a VM in which the user's home directory is
9403accessible read-only, and where the @file{/exchange} directory is a
9404read-write mapping of the host's @file{$HOME/tmp}:
9405
9406@example
9407guix system vm my-config.scm \
9408 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
9409@end example
9410
6aa260af
LC
9411On GNU/Linux, the default is to boot directly to the kernel; this has
9412the advantage of requiring only a very tiny root disk image since the
9413host's store can then be mounted.
9414
9415The @code{--full-boot} option forces a complete boot sequence, starting
9416with the bootloader. This requires more disk space since a root image
9417containing at least the kernel, initrd, and bootloader data files must
9418be created. The @code{--image-size} option can be used to specify the
9419image's size.
ab11f0be 9420
cf4a9129
LC
9421@item vm-image
9422@itemx disk-image
9423Return a virtual machine or disk image of the operating system declared
9424in @var{file} that stands alone. Use the @option{--image-size} option
9425to specify the size of the image.
113daf62 9426
cf4a9129 9427When using @code{vm-image}, the returned image is in qcow2 format, which
97d76250
LF
9428the QEMU emulator can efficiently use. @xref{Running GuixSD in a VM},
9429for more information on how to run the image in a virtual machine.
113daf62 9430
cf4a9129
LC
9431When using @code{disk-image}, a raw disk image is produced; it can be
9432copied as is to a USB stick, for instance. Assuming @code{/dev/sdc} is
9433the device corresponding to a USB stick, one can copy the image on it
9434using the following command:
113daf62 9435
cf4a9129
LC
9436@example
9437# dd if=$(guix system disk-image my-os.scm) of=/dev/sdc
9438@end example
113daf62 9439
1c8a81b1
DT
9440@item container
9441Return a script to run the operating system declared in @var{file}
9442within a container. Containers are a set of lightweight isolation
9443mechanisms provided by the kernel Linux-libre. Containers are
9444substantially less resource-demanding than full virtual machines since
9445the kernel, shared objects, and other resources can be shared with the
9446host system; this also means they provide thinner isolation.
9447
9448Currently, the script must be run as root in order to support more than
9449a single user and group. The container shares its store with the host
9450system.
9451
9452As with the @code{vm} action (@pxref{guix system vm}), additional file
9453systems to be shared between the host and container can be specified
9454using the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} options:
9455
9456@example
9457guix system container my-config.scm \
9458 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
9459@end example
9460
0f252e26 9461@quotation Note
cfd35b4e 9462This option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
0f252e26
DT
9463@end quotation
9464
cf4a9129 9465@end table
113daf62 9466
ccd7158d
LC
9467@var{options} can contain any of the common build options (@pxref{Common
9468Build Options}). In addition, @var{options} can contain one of the
9469following:
113daf62 9470
cf4a9129
LC
9471@table @option
9472@item --system=@var{system}
9473@itemx -s @var{system}
9474Attempt to build for @var{system} instead of the host's system type.
9475This works as per @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
113daf62 9476
f3f427c2
LC
9477@item --derivation
9478@itemx -d
9479Return the derivation file name of the given operating system without
9480building anything.
9481
cf4a9129
LC
9482@item --image-size=@var{size}
9483For the @code{vm-image} and @code{disk-image} actions, create an image
9484of the given @var{size}. @var{size} may be a number of bytes, or it may
4a44d7bb
LC
9485include a unit as a suffix (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,,
9486coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
db030303
LC
9487
9488@item --on-error=@var{strategy}
9489Apply @var{strategy} when an error occurs when reading @var{file}.
9490@var{strategy} may be one of the following:
9491
9492@table @code
9493@item nothing-special
9494Report the error concisely and exit. This is the default strategy.
9495
9496@item backtrace
9497Likewise, but also display a backtrace.
9498
9499@item debug
9500Report the error and enter Guile's debugger. From there, you can run
9501commands such as @code{,bt} to get a backtrace, @code{,locals} to
9502display local variable values, and more generally inspect the program's
9503state. @xref{Debug Commands,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
9504a list of available debugging commands.
9505@end table
113daf62 9506@end table
113daf62 9507
cf4a9129
LC
9508Note that all the actions above, except @code{build} and @code{init},
9509rely on KVM support in the Linux-Libre kernel. Specifically, the
9510machine should have hardware virtualization support, the corresponding
9511KVM kernel module should be loaded, and the @file{/dev/kvm} device node
9512must exist and be readable and writable by the user and by the daemon's
9513build users.
8451a568 9514
65797bff
LC
9515Once you have built, configured, re-configured, and re-re-configured
9516your GuixSD installation, you may find it useful to list the operating
9517system generations available on disk---and that you can choose from the
9518GRUB boot menu:
9519
9520@table @code
9521
9522@item list-generations
9523List a summary of each generation of the operating system available on
9524disk, in a human-readable way. This is similar to the
9525@option{--list-generations} option of @command{guix package}
9526(@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
9527
9528Optionally, one can specify a pattern, with the same syntax that is used
9529in @command{guix package --list-generations}, to restrict the list of
9530generations displayed. For instance, the following command displays
9531generations up to 10-day old:
9532
9533@example
9534$ guix system list-generations 10d
9535@end example
9536
9537@end table
9538
d6c3267a
LC
9539The @command{guix system} command has even more to offer! The following
9540sub-commands allow you to visualize how your system services relate to
9541each other:
9542
9543@anchor{system-extension-graph}
9544@table @code
9545
9546@item extension-graph
9547Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{service
9548extension graph} of the operating system defined in @var{file}
9549(@pxref{Service Composition}, for more information on service
9550extensions.)
9551
9552The command:
9553
9554@example
9555$ guix system extension-graph @var{file} | dot -Tpdf > services.pdf
9556@end example
9557
9558produces a PDF file showing the extension relations among services.
9559
710fa231
AK
9560@anchor{system-shepherd-graph}
9561@item shepherd-graph
6f305ea5 9562Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{dependency
dd17bc38
AK
9563graph} of shepherd services of the operating system defined in
9564@var{file}. @xref{Shepherd Services}, for more information and for an
9565example graph.
6f305ea5 9566
d6c3267a
LC
9567@end table
9568
97d76250
LF
9569@node Running GuixSD in a VM
9570@subsection Running GuixSD in a virtual machine
9571
9572One way to run GuixSD in a virtual machine (VM) is to build a GuixSD
9573virtual machine image using @command{guix system vm-image}
9574(@pxref{Invoking guix system}). The returned image is in qcow2 format,
9575which the @uref{http://qemu.org/, QEMU emulator} can efficiently use.
9576
9577To run the image in QEMU, copy it out of the store (@pxref{The Store})
9578and give yourself permission to write to the copy. When invoking QEMU,
9579you must choose a system emulator that is suitable for your hardware
9580platform. Here is a minimal QEMU invocation that will boot the result
9581of @command{guix system vm-image} on x86_64 hardware:
9582
9583@example
9584$ qemu-system-x86_64 \
9585 -net user -net nic,model=virtio \
9586 -enable-kvm -m 256 /tmp/qemu-image
9587@end example
9588
9589Here is what each of these options means:
9590
9591@table @code
9592@item qemu-system-x86_64
9593This specifies the hardware platform to emulate. This should match the
9594host.
9595
9596@item -net user
9597Enable the unprivileged user-mode network stack. The guest OS can
9598access the host but not vice versa. This is the simplest way to get the
9599guest OS online. If you don't choose a network stack, the boot will
9600fail.
9601
9602@item -net nic,model=virtio
9603You must create a network interface of a given model. If you don't
9604create a NIC, the boot will fail. Assuming your hardware platform is
9605x86_64, you can get a list of available NIC models by running
9606@command{qemu-system-x86_64 -net nic,model=help}.
9607
9608@item -enable-kvm
9609If your system has hardware virtualization extensions, enabling the
9610Linux kernel's virtual machine support (KVM) will make things run
9611faster.
9612
9613@item -m 256
9614RAM available to the guest OS, in mebibytes. Defaults to 128@tie{}MiB,
9615which may be insufficent for some operations.
9616
9617@item /tmp/qemu-image
9618The file name of the qcow2 image.
9619@end table
d6c3267a 9620
cf4a9129
LC
9621@node Defining Services
9622@subsection Defining Services
8451a568 9623
eb524192 9624The previous sections show the available services and how one can combine
0adfe95a
LC
9625them in an @code{operating-system} declaration. But how do we define
9626them in the first place? And what is a service anyway?
8451a568 9627
0adfe95a
LC
9628@menu
9629* Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
9630* Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
9631* Service Reference:: API reference.
dd17bc38 9632* Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
0adfe95a
LC
9633@end menu
9634
9635@node Service Composition
9636@subsubsection Service Composition
9637
9638@cindex services
9639@cindex daemons
9640Here we define a @dfn{service} as, broadly, something that extends the
9641operating system's functionality. Often a service is a process---a
9642@dfn{daemon}---started when the system boots: a secure shell server, a
9643Web server, the Guix build daemon, etc. Sometimes a service is a daemon
9644whose execution can be triggered by another daemon---e.g., an FTP server
9645started by @command{inetd} or a D-Bus service activated by
9646@command{dbus-daemon}. Occasionally, a service does not map to a
9647daemon. For instance, the ``account'' service collects user accounts
9648and makes sure they exist when the system runs; the ``udev'' service
9649collects device management rules and makes them available to the eudev
9650daemon; the @file{/etc} service populates the system's @file{/etc}
9651directory.
9652
d6c3267a 9653@cindex service extensions
0adfe95a 9654GuixSD services are connected by @dfn{extensions}. For instance, the
dd17bc38
AK
9655secure shell service @emph{extends} the Shepherd---GuixSD's
9656initialization system, running as PID@tie{}1---by giving it the command
9657lines to start and stop the secure shell daemon (@pxref{Networking
9658Services, @code{lsh-service}}); the UPower service extends the D-Bus
9659service by passing it its @file{.service} specification, and extends the
9660udev service by passing it device management rules (@pxref{Desktop
9661Services, @code{upower-service}}); the Guix daemon service extends the
9662Shepherd by passing it the command lines to start and stop the daemon,
9663and extends the account service by passing it a list of required build
9664user accounts (@pxref{Base Services}).
0adfe95a
LC
9665
9666All in all, services and their ``extends'' relations form a directed
9667acyclic graph (DAG). If we represent services as boxes and extensions
9668as arrows, a typical system might provide something like this:
9669
9670@image{images/service-graph,,5in,Typical service extension graph.}
9671
d62e201c
LC
9672@cindex system service
9673At the bottom, we see the @dfn{system service}, which produces the
9674directory containing everything to run and boot the system, as returned
9675by the @command{guix system build} command. @xref{Service Reference},
9676to learn about the other service types shown here.
d6c3267a
LC
9677@xref{system-extension-graph, the @command{guix system extension-graph}
9678command}, for information on how to generate this representation for a
9679particular operating system definition.
0adfe95a
LC
9680
9681@cindex service types
9682Technically, developers can define @dfn{service types} to express these
9683relations. There can be any number of services of a given type on the
9684system---for instance, a system running two instances of the GNU secure
9685shell server (lsh) has two instances of @var{lsh-service-type}, with
9686different parameters.
9687
9688The following section describes the programming interface for service
9689types and services.
9690
9691@node Service Types and Services
9692@subsubsection Service Types and Services
9693
9694A @dfn{service type} is a node in the DAG described above. Let us start
9695with a simple example, the service type for the Guix build daemon
9696(@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}):
9697
9698@example
9699(define guix-service-type
9700 (service-type
9701 (name 'guix)
9702 (extensions
d4053c71 9703 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type guix-shepherd-service)
0adfe95a
LC
9704 (service-extension account-service-type guix-accounts)
9705 (service-extension activation-service-type guix-activation)))))
9706@end example
8451a568 9707
cf4a9129 9708@noindent
0adfe95a
LC
9709It defines a two things:
9710
9711@enumerate
9712@item
9713A name, whose sole purpose is to make inspection and debugging easier.
9714
9715@item
9716A list of @dfn{service extensions}, where each extension designates the
9717target service type and a procedure that, given the service's
9718parameters, returns a list of object to extend the service of that type.
9719
9720Every service type has at least one service extension. The only
9721exception is the @dfn{boot service type}, which is the ultimate service.
9722@end enumerate
9723
9724In this example, @var{guix-service-type} extends three services:
9725
9726@table @var
d4053c71
AK
9727@item shepherd-root-service-type
9728The @var{guix-shepherd-service} procedure defines how the Shepherd
9729service is extended. Namely, it returns a @code{<shepherd-service>}
9730object that defines how @command{guix-daemon} is started and stopped
9731(@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
0adfe95a
LC
9732
9733@item account-service-type
9734This extension for this service is computed by @var{guix-accounts},
9735which returns a list of @code{user-group} and @code{user-account}
9736objects representing the build user accounts (@pxref{Invoking
9737guix-daemon}).
9738
9739@item activation-service-type
9740Here @var{guix-activation} is a procedure that returns a gexp, which is
9741a code snippet to run at ``activation time''---e.g., when the service is
9742booted.
9743@end table
9744
9745A service of this type is instantiated like this:
9746
9747@example
9748(service guix-service-type
9749 (guix-configuration
9750 (build-accounts 5)
9751 (use-substitutes? #f)))
9752@end example
9753
9754The second argument to the @code{service} form is a value representing
9755the parameters of this specific service instance.
9756@xref{guix-configuration-type, @code{guix-configuration}}, for
9757information about the @code{guix-configuration} data type.
9758
9759@var{guix-service-type} is quite simple because it extends other
9760services but is not extensible itself.
9761
9762@c @subsubsubsection Extensible Service Types
9763
9764The service type for an @emph{extensible} service looks like this:
9765
9766@example
9767(define udev-service-type
9768 (service-type (name 'udev)
9769 (extensions
d4053c71
AK
9770 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type
9771 udev-shepherd-service)))
0adfe95a
LC
9772
9773 (compose concatenate) ;concatenate the list of rules
9774 (extend (lambda (config rules)
9775 (match config
9776 (($ <udev-configuration> udev initial-rules)
9777 (udev-configuration
9778 (udev udev) ;the udev package to use
9779 (rules (append initial-rules rules)))))))))
9780@end example
9781
9782This is the service type for the
9783@uref{https://wiki.gentoo.org/wiki/Project:Eudev, eudev device
9784management daemon}. Compared to the previous example, in addition to an
d4053c71 9785extension of @var{shepherd-root-service-type}, we see two new fields:
0adfe95a
LC
9786
9787@table @code
9788@item compose
9789This is the procedure to @dfn{compose} the list of extensions to
9790services of this type.
9791
9792Services can extend the udev service by passing it lists of rules; we
9793compose those extensions simply by concatenating them.
9794
9795@item extend
9796This procedure defines how the service's value is @dfn{extended} with
9797the composition of the extensions.
9798
9799Udev extensions are composed into a list of rules, but the udev service
9800value is itself a @code{<udev-configuration>} record. So here, we
9801extend that record by appending the list of rules is contains to the
9802list of contributed rules.
9803@end table
9804
9805There can be only one instance of an extensible service type such as
9806@var{udev-service-type}. If there were more, the
9807@code{service-extension} specifications would be ambiguous.
9808
9809Still here? The next section provides a reference of the programming
9810interface for services.
9811
9812@node Service Reference
9813@subsubsection Service Reference
9814
9815We have seen an overview of service types (@pxref{Service Types and
9816Services}). This section provides a reference on how to manipulate
9817services and service types. This interface is provided by the
9818@code{(gnu services)} module.
9819
9820@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service @var{type} @var{value}
9821Return a new service of @var{type}, a @code{<service-type>} object (see
9822below.) @var{value} can be any object; it represents the parameters of
9823this particular service instance.
9824@end deffn
9825
9826@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service? @var{obj}
9827Return true if @var{obj} is a service.
9828@end deffn
8451a568 9829
0adfe95a
LC
9830@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-kind @var{service}
9831Return the type of @var{service}---i.e., a @code{<service-type>} object.
9832@end deffn
9833
9834@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-parameters @var{service}
9835Return the value associated with @var{service}. It represents its
9836parameters.
9837@end deffn
9838
9839Here is an example of how a service is created and manipulated:
9840
9841@example
9842(define s
9843 (service nginx-service-type
9844 (nginx-configuration
9845 (nginx nginx)
9846 (log-directory log-directory)
9847 (run-directory run-directory)
9848 (file config-file))))
9849
9850(service? s)
9851@result{} #t
9852
9853(eq? (service-kind s) nginx-service-type)
9854@result{} #t
9855@end example
9856
cd6f6c22
LC
9857The @code{modify-services} form provides a handy way to change the
9858parameters of some of the services of a list such as
9859@var{%base-services} (@pxref{Base Services, @code{%base-services}}). Of
9860course, you could always use standard list combinators such as
9861@code{map} and @code{fold} to do that (@pxref{SRFI-1, List Library,,
9862guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}); @code{modify-services} simply
9863provides a more concise form for this common pattern.
9864
9865@deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-services @var{services} @
9866 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body}) @dots{}
9867
9868Modify the services listed in @var{services} according to the given
9869clauses. Each clause has the form:
9870
9871@example
9872(@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body})
9873@end example
9874
9875where @var{type} is a service type, such as @var{guix-service-type}, and
9876@var{variable} is an identifier that is bound within @var{body} to the
9877value of the service of that @var{type}. @xref{Using the Configuration
9878System}, for an example.
9879
9880This is a shorthand for:
9881
9882@example
9883(map (lambda (service) @dots{}) @var{services})
9884@end example
9885@end deffn
9886
9887Next comes the programming interface for service types. This is
9888something you want to know when writing new service definitions, but not
9889necessarily when simply looking for ways to customize your
9890@code{operating-system} declaration.
9891
0adfe95a
LC
9892@deftp {Data Type} service-type
9893@cindex service type
9894This is the representation of a @dfn{service type} (@pxref{Service Types
9895and Services}).
9896
9897@table @asis
9898@item @code{name}
9899This is a symbol, used only to simplify inspection and debugging.
9900
9901@item @code{extensions}
9902A non-empty list of @code{<service-extension>} objects (see below.)
9903
9904@item @code{compose} (default: @code{#f})
9905If this is @code{#f}, then the service type denotes services that cannot
9906be extended---i.e., services that do not receive ``values'' from other
9907services.
9908
9909Otherwise, it must be a one-argument procedure. The procedure is called
9910by @code{fold-services} and is passed a list of values collected from
9911extensions. It must return a value that is a valid parameter value for
9912the service instance.
9913
9914@item @code{extend} (default: @code{#f})
9915If this is @code{#f}, services of this type cannot be extended.
9916
9917Otherwise, it must be a two-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
9918calls it, passing it the service's initial value as the first argument
9919and the result of applying @code{compose} to the extension values as the
9920second argument.
9921@end table
9922
9923@xref{Service Types and Services}, for examples.
9924@end deftp
9925
9926@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension @var{target-type} @
9927 @var{compute}
9928Return a new extension for services of type @var{target-type}.
9929@var{compute} must be a one-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
9930calls it, passing it the value associated with the service that provides
9931the extension; it must return a valid value for the target service.
9932@end deffn
9933
9934@deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension? @var{obj}
9935Return true if @var{obj} is a service extension.
9936@end deffn
9937
9938At the core of the service abstraction lies the @code{fold-services}
9939procedure, which is responsible for ``compiling'' a list of services
d62e201c
LC
9940down to a single directory that contains everything needed to boot and
9941run the system---the directory shown by the @command{guix system build}
9942command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). In essence, it propagates
9943service extensions down the service graph, updating each node parameters
9944on the way, until it reaches the root node.
0adfe95a
LC
9945
9946@deffn {Scheme Procedure} fold-services @var{services} @
d62e201c 9947 [#:target-type @var{system-service-type}]
0adfe95a
LC
9948Fold @var{services} by propagating their extensions down to the root of
9949type @var{target-type}; return the root service adjusted accordingly.
9950@end deffn
9951
9952Lastly, the @code{(gnu services)} module also defines several essential
9953service types, some of which are listed below.
9954
d62e201c
LC
9955@defvr {Scheme Variable} system-service-type
9956This is the root of the service graph. It produces the system directory
9957as returned by the @command{guix system build} command.
9958@end defvr
9959
0adfe95a 9960@defvr {Scheme Variable} boot-service-type
d62e201c
LC
9961The type of the ``boot service'', which produces the @dfn{boot script}.
9962The boot script is what the initial RAM disk runs when booting.
0adfe95a
LC
9963@end defvr
9964
9965@defvr {Scheme Variable} etc-service-type
9966The type of the @file{/etc} service. This service can be extended by
9967passing it name/file tuples such as:
9968
9969@example
9970(list `("issue" ,(plain-file "issue" "Welcome!\n")))
9971@end example
9972
9973In this example, the effect would be to add an @file{/etc/issue} file
9974pointing to the given file.
9975@end defvr
9976
9977@defvr {Scheme Variable} setuid-program-service-type
9978Type for the ``setuid-program service''. This service collects lists of
9979executable file names, passed as gexps, and adds them to the set of
9980setuid-root programs on the system (@pxref{Setuid Programs}).
9981@end defvr
9982
af4c3fd5
LC
9983@defvr {Scheme Variable} profile-service-type
9984Type of the service that populates the @dfn{system profile}---i.e., the
9985programs under @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Other services can
9986extend it by passing it lists of packages to add to the system profile.
9987@end defvr
9988
0adfe95a 9989
dd17bc38
AK
9990@node Shepherd Services
9991@subsubsection Shepherd Services
0adfe95a
LC
9992
9993@cindex PID 1
9994@cindex init system
0190c1c0
AK
9995The @code{(gnu services shepherd)} provides a way to define services
9996managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, which is GuixSD initialization
9997system---the first process that is started when the system boots,
9998aka. PID@tie{}1 (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd
9999Manual}).
6f305ea5 10000
dd17bc38
AK
10001Services in the Shepherd can depend on each other. For instance, the
10002SSH daemon may need to be started after the syslog daemon has been
10003started, which in turn can only happen once all the file systems have
10004been mounted. The simple operating system defined earlier (@pxref{Using
10005the Configuration System}) results in a service graph like this:
6f305ea5 10006
710fa231 10007@image{images/shepherd-graph,,5in,Typical shepherd service graph.}
6f305ea5
LC
10008
10009You can actually generate such a graph for any operating system
710fa231
AK
10010definition using the @command{guix system shepherd-graph} command
10011(@pxref{system-shepherd-graph, @command{guix system shepherd-graph}}).
6f305ea5 10012
d4053c71
AK
10013The @var{%shepherd-root-service} is a service object representing
10014PID@tie{}1, of type @var{shepherd-root-service-type}; it can be extended
10015by passing it lists of @code{<shepherd-service>} objects.
0adfe95a 10016
d4053c71 10017@deftp {Data Type} shepherd-service
dd17bc38 10018The data type representing a service managed by the Shepherd.
0adfe95a
LC
10019
10020@table @asis
10021@item @code{provision}
10022This is a list of symbols denoting what the service provides.
10023
dd17bc38
AK
10024These are the names that may be passed to @command{herd start},
10025@command{herd status}, and similar commands (@pxref{Invoking herd,,,
10026shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). @xref{Slots of services, the
10027@code{provides} slot,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for details.
0adfe95a
LC
10028
10029@item @code{requirements} (default: @code{'()})
dd17bc38 10030List of symbols denoting the Shepherd services this one depends on.
0adfe95a
LC
10031
10032@item @code{respawn?} (default: @code{#t})
10033Whether to restart the service when it stops, for instance when the
10034underlying process dies.
10035
10036@item @code{start}
10037@itemx @code{stop} (default: @code{#~(const #f)})
dd17bc38
AK
10038The @code{start} and @code{stop} fields refer to the Shepherd's
10039facilities to start and stop processes (@pxref{Service De- and
10040Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). They are given as
10041G-expressions that get expanded in the Shepherd configuration file
10042(@pxref{G-Expressions}).
0adfe95a
LC
10043
10044@item @code{documentation}
10045A documentation string, as shown when running:
10046
10047@example
dd17bc38 10048herd doc @var{service-name}
0adfe95a
LC
10049@end example
10050
10051where @var{service-name} is one of the symbols in @var{provision}
dd17bc38 10052(@pxref{Invoking herd,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
fae685b9
LC
10053
10054@item @code{modules} (default: @var{%default-modules})
10055This is the list of modules that must be in scope when @code{start} and
10056@code{stop} are evaluated.
10057
10058@item @code{imported-modules} (default: @var{%default-imported-modules})
10059This is the list of modules to import in the execution environment of
dd17bc38 10060the Shepherd.
fae685b9 10061
0adfe95a
LC
10062@end table
10063@end deftp
10064
d4053c71 10065@defvr {Scheme Variable} shepherd-root-service-type
dd17bc38 10066The service type for the Shepherd ``root service''---i.e., PID@tie{}1.
0adfe95a
LC
10067
10068This is the service type that extensions target when they want to create
dd17bc38 10069shepherd services (@pxref{Service Types and Services}, for an example).
d4053c71 10070Each extension must pass a list of @code{<shepherd-service>}.
0adfe95a
LC
10071@end defvr
10072
d4053c71 10073@defvr {Scheme Variable} %shepherd-root-service
0adfe95a
LC
10074This service represents PID@tie{}1.
10075@end defvr
8451a568 10076
8451a568 10077
cf4a9129
LC
10078@node Installing Debugging Files
10079@section Installing Debugging Files
8451a568 10080
cf4a9129
LC
10081@cindex debugging files
10082Program binaries, as produced by the GCC compilers for instance, are
10083typically written in the ELF format, with a section containing
10084@dfn{debugging information}. Debugging information is what allows the
10085debugger, GDB, to map binary code to source code; it is required to
10086debug a compiled program in good conditions.
8451a568 10087
cf4a9129
LC
10088The problem with debugging information is that is takes up a fair amount
10089of disk space. For example, debugging information for the GNU C Library
10090weighs in at more than 60 MiB. Thus, as a user, keeping all the
10091debugging info of all the installed programs is usually not an option.
10092Yet, space savings should not come at the cost of an impediment to
10093debugging---especially in the GNU system, which should make it easier
10094for users to exert their computing freedom (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
8451a568 10095
cf4a9129
LC
10096Thankfully, the GNU Binary Utilities (Binutils) and GDB provide a
10097mechanism that allows users to get the best of both worlds: debugging
10098information can be stripped from the binaries and stored in separate
10099files. GDB is then able to load debugging information from those files,
10100when they are available (@pxref{Separate Debug Files,,, gdb, Debugging
10101with GDB}).
8451a568 10102
cf4a9129
LC
10103The GNU distribution takes advantage of this by storing debugging
10104information in the @code{lib/debug} sub-directory of a separate package
10105output unimaginatively called @code{debug} (@pxref{Packages with
10106Multiple Outputs}). Users can choose to install the @code{debug} output
10107of a package when they need it. For instance, the following command
10108installs the debugging information for the GNU C Library and for GNU
10109Guile:
8451a568
LC
10110
10111@example
cf4a9129 10112guix package -i glibc:debug guile:debug
8451a568
LC
10113@end example
10114
cf4a9129
LC
10115GDB must then be told to look for debug files in the user's profile, by
10116setting the @code{debug-file-directory} variable (consider setting it
10117from the @file{~/.gdbinit} file, @pxref{Startup,,, gdb, Debugging with
10118GDB}):
8451a568 10119
cf4a9129
LC
10120@example
10121(gdb) set debug-file-directory ~/.guix-profile/lib/debug
10122@end example
8451a568 10123
cf4a9129
LC
10124From there on, GDB will pick up debugging information from the
10125@code{.debug} files under @file{~/.guix-profile/lib/debug}.
8451a568 10126
cf4a9129
LC
10127In addition, you will most likely want GDB to be able to show the source
10128code being debugged. To do that, you will have to unpack the source
10129code of the package of interest (obtained with @code{guix build
10130--source}, @pxref{Invoking guix build}), and to point GDB to that source
10131directory using the @code{directory} command (@pxref{Source Path,
10132@code{directory},, gdb, Debugging with GDB}).
8451a568 10133
cf4a9129
LC
10134@c XXX: keep me up-to-date
10135The @code{debug} output mechanism in Guix is implemented by the
10136@code{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems}). Currently, it is
10137opt-in---debugging information is available only for those packages
10138whose definition explicitly declares a @code{debug} output. This may be
10139changed to opt-out in the future, if our build farm servers can handle
10140the load. To check whether a package has a @code{debug} output, use
10141@command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
8451a568 10142
8451a568 10143
05962f29
LC
10144@node Security Updates
10145@section Security Updates
10146
843858b8
LC
10147@quotation Note
10148As of version @value{VERSION}, the feature described in this section is
10149experimental.
10150@end quotation
05962f29
LC
10151
10152@cindex security updates
10153Occasionally, important security vulnerabilities are discovered in core
10154software packages and must be patched. Guix follows a functional
10155package management discipline (@pxref{Introduction}), which implies
10156that, when a package is changed, @emph{every package that depends on it}
10157must be rebuilt. This can significantly slow down the deployment of
10158fixes in core packages such as libc or Bash, since basically the whole
10159distribution would need to be rebuilt. Using pre-built binaries helps
10160(@pxref{Substitutes}), but deployment may still take more time than
10161desired.
10162
10163@cindex grafts
10164To address that, Guix implements @dfn{grafts}, a mechanism that allows
10165for fast deployment of critical updates without the costs associated
10166with a whole-distribution rebuild. The idea is to rebuild only the
10167package that needs to be patched, and then to ``graft'' it onto packages
10168explicitly installed by the user and that were previously referring to
10169the original package. The cost of grafting is typically very low, and
10170order of magnitudes lower than a full rebuild of the dependency chain.
10171
10172@cindex replacements of packages, for grafts
10173For instance, suppose a security update needs to be applied to Bash.
10174Guix developers will provide a package definition for the ``fixed''
10175Bash, say @var{bash-fixed}, in the usual way (@pxref{Defining
10176Packages}). Then, the original package definition is augmented with a
10177@code{replacement} field pointing to the package containing the bug fix:
10178
10179@example
10180(define bash
10181 (package
10182 (name "bash")
10183 ;; @dots{}
10184 (replacement bash-fixed)))
10185@end example
10186
10187From there on, any package depending directly or indirectly on Bash that
10188is installed will automatically be ``rewritten'' to refer to
10189@var{bash-fixed} instead of @var{bash}. This grafting process takes
10190time proportional to the size of the package, but expect less than a
10191minute for an ``average'' package on a recent machine.
10192
10193Currently, the graft and the package it replaces (@var{bash-fixed} and
10194@var{bash} in the example above) must have the exact same @code{name}
10195and @code{version} fields. This restriction mostly comes from the fact
10196that grafting works by patching files, including binary files, directly.
10197Other restrictions may apply: for instance, when adding a graft to a
10198package providing a shared library, the original shared library and its
10199replacement must have the same @code{SONAME} and be binary-compatible.
10200
10201
cf4a9129
LC
10202@node Package Modules
10203@section Package Modules
8451a568 10204
cf4a9129
LC
10205From a programming viewpoint, the package definitions of the
10206GNU distribution are provided by Guile modules in the @code{(gnu packages
10207@dots{})} name space@footnote{Note that packages under the @code{(gnu
10208packages @dots{})} module name space are not necessarily ``GNU
10209packages''. This module naming scheme follows the usual Guile module
10210naming convention: @code{gnu} means that these modules are distributed
10211as part of the GNU system, and @code{packages} identifies modules that
10212define packages.} (@pxref{Modules, Guile modules,, guile, GNU Guile
10213Reference Manual}). For instance, the @code{(gnu packages emacs)}
10214module exports a variable named @code{emacs}, which is bound to a
10215@code{<package>} object (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
113daf62 10216
300868ba 10217The @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} module name space is
cf4a9129
LC
10218automatically scanned for packages by the command-line tools. For
10219instance, when running @code{guix package -i emacs}, all the @code{(gnu
10220packages @dots{})} modules are scanned until one that exports a package
10221object whose name is @code{emacs} is found. This package search
10222facility is implemented in the @code{(gnu packages)} module.
113daf62 10223
300868ba 10224@cindex customization, of packages
8689901f 10225@cindex package module search path
cf4a9129 10226Users can store package definitions in modules with different
60142854 10227names---e.g., @code{(my-packages emacs)}@footnote{Note that the file
c95ded7e
LC
10228name and module name must match. For instance, the @code{(my-packages
10229emacs)} module must be stored in a @file{my-packages/emacs.scm} file
10230relative to the load path specified with @option{--load-path} or
10231@code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}. @xref{Modules and the File System,,,
10232guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for details.}. These package definitions
300868ba
LC
10233will not be visible by default. Thus, users can invoke commands such as
10234@command{guix package} and @command{guix build} have to be used with the
c95ded7e
LC
10235@code{-e} option so that they know where to find the package. Better
10236yet, they can use the
300868ba 10237@code{-L} option of these commands to make those modules visible
8689901f
LC
10238(@pxref{Invoking guix build, @code{--load-path}}), or define the
10239@code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH} environment variable. This environment
10240variable makes it easy to extend or customize the distribution and is
10241honored by all the user interfaces.
10242
10243@defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
10244This is a colon-separated list of directories to search for package
10245modules. Directories listed in this variable take precedence over the
10246distribution's own modules.
10247@end defvr
ef5dd60a 10248
cf4a9129
LC
10249The distribution is fully @dfn{bootstrapped} and @dfn{self-contained}:
10250each package is built based solely on other packages in the
10251distribution. The root of this dependency graph is a small set of
10252@dfn{bootstrap binaries}, provided by the @code{(gnu packages
10253bootstrap)} module. For more information on bootstrapping,
081145cf 10254@pxref{Bootstrapping}.
ef5dd60a 10255
cf4a9129
LC
10256@node Packaging Guidelines
10257@section Packaging Guidelines
ef5dd60a 10258
cf4a9129
LC
10259The GNU distribution is nascent and may well lack some of your favorite
10260packages. This section describes how you can help make the distribution
10261grow. @xref{Contributing}, for additional information on how you can
10262help.
ef5dd60a 10263
cf4a9129
LC
10264Free software packages are usually distributed in the form of
10265@dfn{source code tarballs}---typically @file{tar.gz} files that contain
10266all the source files. Adding a package to the distribution means
10267essentially two things: adding a @dfn{recipe} that describes how to
10268build the package, including a list of other packages required to build
f97c9175 10269it, and adding @dfn{package metadata} along with that recipe, such as a
cf4a9129 10270description and licensing information.
ef5dd60a 10271
cf4a9129
LC
10272In Guix all this information is embodied in @dfn{package definitions}.
10273Package definitions provide a high-level view of the package. They are
10274written using the syntax of the Scheme programming language; in fact,
10275for each package we define a variable bound to the package definition,
10276and export that variable from a module (@pxref{Package Modules}).
10277However, in-depth Scheme knowledge is @emph{not} a prerequisite for
10278creating packages. For more information on package definitions,
081145cf 10279@pxref{Defining Packages}.
ef5dd60a 10280
cf4a9129
LC
10281Once a package definition is in place, stored in a file in the Guix
10282source tree, it can be tested using the @command{guix build} command
10283(@pxref{Invoking guix build}). For example, assuming the new package is
c71979f4
LC
10284called @code{gnew}, you may run this command from the Guix build tree
10285(@pxref{Running Guix Before It Is Installed}):
ef5dd60a
LC
10286
10287@example
cf4a9129 10288./pre-inst-env guix build gnew --keep-failed
ef5dd60a 10289@end example
ef5dd60a 10290
cf4a9129
LC
10291Using @code{--keep-failed} makes it easier to debug build failures since
10292it provides access to the failed build tree. Another useful
10293command-line option when debugging is @code{--log-file}, to access the
10294build log.
ef5dd60a 10295
cf4a9129
LC
10296If the package is unknown to the @command{guix} command, it may be that
10297the source file contains a syntax error, or lacks a @code{define-public}
10298clause to export the package variable. To figure it out, you may load
10299the module from Guile to get more information about the actual error:
ef5dd60a 10300
cf4a9129
LC
10301@example
10302./pre-inst-env guile -c '(use-modules (gnu packages gnew))'
10303@end example
ef5dd60a 10304
cf4a9129
LC
10305Once your package builds correctly, please send us a patch
10306(@pxref{Contributing}). Well, if you need help, we will be happy to
10307help you too. Once the patch is committed in the Guix repository, the
10308new package automatically gets built on the supported platforms by
2b1cee21 10309@url{http://hydra.gnu.org/jobset/gnu/master, our continuous integration
cf4a9129 10310system}.
ef5dd60a 10311
cf4a9129
LC
10312@cindex substituter
10313Users can obtain the new package definition simply by running
10314@command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). When
10315@code{hydra.gnu.org} is done building the package, installing the
10316package automatically downloads binaries from there
10317(@pxref{Substitutes}). The only place where human intervention is
10318needed is to review and apply the patch.
ef5dd60a 10319
ef5dd60a 10320
cf4a9129 10321@menu
ec0339cd
LC
10322* Software Freedom:: What may go into the distribution.
10323* Package Naming:: What's in a name?
10324* Version Numbers:: When the name is not enough.
cbd02397 10325* Synopses and Descriptions:: Helping users find the right package.
ec0339cd
LC
10326* Python Modules:: Taming the snake.
10327* Perl Modules:: Little pearls.
10328* Fonts:: Fond of fonts.
cf4a9129 10329@end menu
ef5dd60a 10330
cf4a9129
LC
10331@node Software Freedom
10332@subsection Software Freedom
ef5dd60a 10333
cf4a9129 10334@c Adapted from http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/philosophy.html.
c11a6eb1 10335
cf4a9129
LC
10336The GNU operating system has been developed so that users can have
10337freedom in their computing. GNU is @dfn{free software}, meaning that
10338users have the @url{http://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,four
10339essential freedoms}: to run the program, to study and change the program
10340in source code form, to redistribute exact copies, and to distribute
10341modified versions. Packages found in the GNU distribution provide only
10342software that conveys these four freedoms.
c11a6eb1 10343
cf4a9129
LC
10344In addition, the GNU distribution follow the
10345@url{http://www.gnu.org/distros/free-system-distribution-guidelines.html,free
10346software distribution guidelines}. Among other things, these guidelines
10347reject non-free firmware, recommendations of non-free software, and
10348discuss ways to deal with trademarks and patents.
ef5dd60a 10349
cf4a9129
LC
10350Some packages contain a small and optional subset that violates the
10351above guidelines, for instance because this subset is itself non-free
10352code. When that happens, the offending items are removed with
10353appropriate patches or code snippets in the package definition's
10354@code{origin} form (@pxref{Defining Packages}). That way, @code{guix
10355build --source} returns the ``freed'' source rather than the unmodified
10356upstream source.
ef5dd60a 10357
ef5dd60a 10358
cf4a9129
LC
10359@node Package Naming
10360@subsection Package Naming
ef5dd60a 10361
cf4a9129
LC
10362A package has actually two names associated with it:
10363First, there is the name of the @emph{Scheme variable}, the one following
10364@code{define-public}. By this name, the package can be made known in the
10365Scheme code, for instance as input to another package. Second, there is
10366the string in the @code{name} field of a package definition. This name
10367is used by package management commands such as
10368@command{guix package} and @command{guix build}.
ef5dd60a 10369
cf4a9129
LC
10370Both are usually the same and correspond to the lowercase conversion of
10371the project name chosen upstream, with underscores replaced with
10372hyphens. For instance, GNUnet is available as @code{gnunet}, and
10373SDL_net as @code{sdl-net}.
927097ef 10374
cf4a9129 10375We do not add @code{lib} prefixes for library packages, unless these are
081145cf 10376already part of the official project name. But @pxref{Python
cf4a9129
LC
10377Modules} and @ref{Perl Modules} for special rules concerning modules for
10378the Python and Perl languages.
927097ef 10379
1b366ee4 10380Font package names are handled differently, @pxref{Fonts}.
7fec52b7 10381
ef5dd60a 10382
cf4a9129
LC
10383@node Version Numbers
10384@subsection Version Numbers
ef5dd60a 10385
cf4a9129
LC
10386We usually package only the latest version of a given free software
10387project. But sometimes, for instance for incompatible library versions,
10388two (or more) versions of the same package are needed. These require
10389different Scheme variable names. We use the name as defined
10390in @ref{Package Naming}
10391for the most recent version; previous versions use the same name, suffixed
10392by @code{-} and the smallest prefix of the version number that may
10393distinguish the two versions.
ef5dd60a 10394
cf4a9129
LC
10395The name inside the package definition is the same for all versions of a
10396package and does not contain any version number.
ef5dd60a 10397
cf4a9129 10398For instance, the versions 2.24.20 and 3.9.12 of GTK+ may be packaged as follows:
ef5dd60a 10399
cf4a9129
LC
10400@example
10401(define-public gtk+
10402 (package
17d8e33f
ML
10403 (name "gtk+")
10404 (version "3.9.12")
10405 ...))
cf4a9129
LC
10406(define-public gtk+-2
10407 (package
17d8e33f
ML
10408 (name "gtk+")
10409 (version "2.24.20")
10410 ...))
cf4a9129
LC
10411@end example
10412If we also wanted GTK+ 3.8.2, this would be packaged as
10413@example
10414(define-public gtk+-3.8
10415 (package
17d8e33f
ML
10416 (name "gtk+")
10417 (version "3.8.2")
10418 ...))
cf4a9129 10419@end example
ef5dd60a 10420
880d647d
LC
10421@c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2016-01/msg00425.html>,
10422@c for a discussion of what follows.
10423@cindex version number, for VCS snapshots
10424Occasionally, we package snapshots of upstream's version control system
10425(VCS) instead of formal releases. This should remain exceptional,
10426because it is up to upstream developers to clarify what the stable
10427release is. Yet, it is sometimes necessary. So, what should we put in
10428the @code{version} field?
10429
10430Clearly, we need to make the commit identifier of the VCS snapshot
10431visible in the version string, but we also need to make sure that the
10432version string is monotonically increasing so that @command{guix package
10433--upgrade} can determine which version is newer. Since commit
10434identifiers, notably with Git, are not monotonically increasing, we add
10435a revision number that we increase each time we upgrade to a newer
10436snapshot. The resulting version string looks like this:
10437
10438@example
104392.0.11-3.cabba9e
10440 ^ ^ ^
10441 | | `-- upstream commit ID
10442 | |
10443 | `--- Guix package revision
10444 |
10445latest upstream version
10446@end example
10447
10448It is a good idea to strip commit identifiers in the @code{version}
10449field to, say, 7 digits. It avoids an aesthetic annoyance (assuming
10450aesthetics have a role to play here) as well as problems related to OS
10451limits such as the maximum shebang length (127 bytes for the Linux
10452kernel.) It is best to use the full commit identifiers in
10453@code{origin}s, though, to avoid ambiguities.
10454
cbd02397
LC
10455@node Synopses and Descriptions
10456@subsection Synopses and Descriptions
10457
10458As we have seen before, each package in GNU@tie{}Guix includes a
10459synopsis and a description (@pxref{Defining Packages}). Synopses and
10460descriptions are important: They are what @command{guix package
10461--search} searches, and a crucial piece of information to help users
10462determine whether a given package suits their needs. Consequently,
10463packagers should pay attention to what goes into them.
10464
10465Synopses must start with a capital letter and must not end with a
10466period. They must not start with ``a'' or ``the'', which usually does
10467not bring anything; for instance, prefer ``File-frobbing tool'' over ``A
10468tool that frobs files''. The synopsis should say what the package
10469is---e.g., ``Core GNU utilities (file, text, shell)''---or what it is
10470used for---e.g., the synopsis for GNU@tie{}grep is ``Print lines
10471matching a pattern''.
10472
10473Keep in mind that the synopsis must be meaningful for a very wide
10474audience. For example, ``Manipulate alignments in the SAM format''
10475might make sense for a seasoned bioinformatics researcher, but might be
10476fairly unhelpful or even misleading to a non-specialized audience. It
10477is a good idea to come up with a synopsis that gives an idea of the
10478application domain of the package. In this example, this might give
10479something like ``Manipulate nucleotide sequence alignments'', which
10480hopefully gives the user a better idea of whether this is what they are
10481looking for.
10482
10483@cindex Texinfo markup, in package descriptions
10484Descriptions should take between five and ten lines. Use full
10485sentences, and avoid using acronyms without first introducing them.
10486Descriptions can include Texinfo markup, which is useful to introduce
10487ornaments such as @code{@@code} or @code{@@dfn}, bullet lists, or
ba7d6c76
ML
10488hyperlinks (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). However you
10489should be careful when using some characters for example @samp{@@} and
10490curly braces which are the basic special characters in Texinfo
10491(@pxref{Special Characters,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). User interfaces
10492such as @command{guix package --show} take care of rendering it
10493appropriately.
cbd02397
LC
10494
10495Synopses and descriptions are translated by volunteers
10496@uref{http://translationproject.org/domain/guix-packages.html, at the
10497Translation Project} so that as many users as possible can read them in
10498their native language. User interfaces search them and display them in
10499the language specified by the current locale.
10500
10501Translation is a lot of work so, as a packager, please pay even more
10502attention to your synopses and descriptions as every change may entail
ba7d6c76 10503additional work for translators. In order to help them, it is possible
36743e71 10504to make recommendations or instructions visible to them by inserting
ba7d6c76
ML
10505special comments like this (@pxref{xgettext Invocation,,, gettext, GNU
10506Gettext}):
10507
10508@example
10509;; TRANSLATORS: "X11 resize-and-rotate" should not be translated.
10510(description "ARandR is designed to provide a simple visual front end
10511for the X11 resize-and-rotate (RandR) extension. @dots{}")
10512@end example
cbd02397 10513
ef5dd60a 10514
cf4a9129
LC
10515@node Python Modules
10516@subsection Python Modules
ef5dd60a 10517
cf4a9129
LC
10518We currently package Python 2 and Python 3, under the Scheme variable names
10519@code{python-2} and @code{python} as explained in @ref{Version Numbers}.
10520To avoid confusion and naming clashes with other programming languages, it
10521seems desirable that the name of a package for a Python module contains
10522the word @code{python}.
ef5dd60a 10523
cf4a9129
LC
10524Some modules are compatible with only one version of Python, others with both.
10525If the package Foo compiles only with Python 3, we name it
10526@code{python-foo}; if it compiles only with Python 2, we name it
10527@code{python2-foo}. If it is compatible with both versions, we create two
10528packages with the corresponding names.
ef5dd60a 10529
cf4a9129
LC
10530If a project already contains the word @code{python}, we drop this;
10531for instance, the module python-dateutil is packaged under the names
10532@code{python-dateutil} and @code{python2-dateutil}.
113daf62 10533
523e4896 10534
cf4a9129
LC
10535@node Perl Modules
10536@subsection Perl Modules
523e4896 10537
cf4a9129
LC
10538Perl programs standing for themselves are named as any other package,
10539using the lowercase upstream name.
10540For Perl packages containing a single class, we use the lowercase class name,
10541replace all occurrences of @code{::} by dashes and prepend the prefix
10542@code{perl-}.
10543So the class @code{XML::Parser} becomes @code{perl-xml-parser}.
10544Modules containing several classes keep their lowercase upstream name and
10545are also prepended by @code{perl-}. Such modules tend to have the word
10546@code{perl} somewhere in their name, which gets dropped in favor of the
10547prefix. For instance, @code{libwww-perl} becomes @code{perl-libwww}.
523e4896 10548
523e4896 10549
7fec52b7
AE
10550@node Fonts
10551@subsection Fonts
10552
10553For fonts that are in general not installed by a user for typesetting
10554purposes, or that are distributed as part of a larger software package,
10555we rely on the general packaging rules for software; for instance, this
10556applies to the fonts delivered as part of the X.Org system or fonts that
10557are part of TeX Live.
10558
10559To make it easier for a user to search for fonts, names for other packages
10560containing only fonts are constructed as follows, independently of the
10561upstream package name.
10562
10563The name of a package containing only one font family starts with
10564@code{font-}; it is followed by the foundry name and a dash @code{-}
10565if the foundry is known, and the font family name, in which spaces are
10566replaced by dashes (and as usual, all upper case letters are transformed
10567to lower case).
10568For example, the Gentium font family by SIL is packaged under the name
10569@code{font-sil-gentium}.
10570
10571For a package containing several font families, the name of the collection
10572is used in the place of the font family name.
10573For instance, the Liberation fonts consist of three families,
10574Liberation Sans, Liberation Serif and Liberation Mono.
10575These could be packaged separately under the names
10576@code{font-liberation-sans} and so on; but as they are distributed together
10577under a common name, we prefer to package them together as
10578@code{font-liberation}.
10579
10580In the case where several formats of the same font family or font collection
10581are packaged separately, a short form of the format, prepended by a dash,
10582is added to the package name. We use @code{-ttf} for TrueType fonts,
1b366ee4 10583@code{-otf} for OpenType fonts and @code{-type1} for PostScript Type 1
7fec52b7
AE
10584fonts.
10585
10586
b25937e3 10587
cf4a9129
LC
10588@node Bootstrapping
10589@section Bootstrapping
b25937e3 10590
cf4a9129 10591@c Adapted from the ELS 2013 paper.
b25937e3 10592
cf4a9129 10593@cindex bootstrapping
7889394e 10594
cf4a9129
LC
10595Bootstrapping in our context refers to how the distribution gets built
10596``from nothing''. Remember that the build environment of a derivation
10597contains nothing but its declared inputs (@pxref{Introduction}). So
10598there's an obvious chicken-and-egg problem: how does the first package
10599get built? How does the first compiler get compiled? Note that this is
10600a question of interest only to the curious hacker, not to the regular
10601user, so you can shamelessly skip this section if you consider yourself
10602a ``regular user''.
72b9d60d 10603
cf4a9129
LC
10604@cindex bootstrap binaries
10605The GNU system is primarily made of C code, with libc at its core. The
10606GNU build system itself assumes the availability of a Bourne shell and
10607command-line tools provided by GNU Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and
10608`grep'. Furthermore, build programs---programs that run
10609@code{./configure}, @code{make}, etc.---are written in Guile Scheme
10610(@pxref{Derivations}). Consequently, to be able to build anything at
10611all, from scratch, Guix relies on pre-built binaries of Guile, GCC,
10612Binutils, libc, and the other packages mentioned above---the
10613@dfn{bootstrap binaries}.
72b9d60d 10614
cf4a9129
LC
10615These bootstrap binaries are ``taken for granted'', though we can also
10616re-create them if needed (more on that later).
72b9d60d 10617
cf4a9129 10618@unnumberedsubsec Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
c79d54fe 10619
cf4a9129
LC
10620@c As of Emacs 24.3, Info-mode displays the image, but since it's a
10621@c large image, it's hard to scroll. Oh well.
10622@image{images/bootstrap-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the early bootstrap derivations}
523e4896 10623
cf4a9129
LC
10624The figure above shows the very beginning of the dependency graph of the
10625distribution, corresponding to the package definitions of the @code{(gnu
d33fa0c7
LC
10626packages bootstrap)} module. A similar figure can be generated with
10627@command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}), along the lines of:
10628
10629@example
10630guix graph -t derivation \
10631 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-gcc)' \
10632 | dot -Tps > t.ps
10633@end example
10634
10635At this level of detail, things are
cf4a9129
LC
10636slightly complex. First, Guile itself consists of an ELF executable,
10637along with many source and compiled Scheme files that are dynamically
10638loaded when it runs. This gets stored in the @file{guile-2.0.7.tar.xz}
10639tarball shown in this graph. This tarball is part of Guix's ``source''
10640distribution, and gets inserted into the store with @code{add-to-store}
10641(@pxref{The Store}).
2e7b5cea 10642
cf4a9129
LC
10643But how do we write a derivation that unpacks this tarball and adds it
10644to the store? To solve this problem, the @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv}
10645derivation---the first one that gets built---uses @code{bash} as its
10646builder, which runs @code{build-bootstrap-guile.sh}, which in turn calls
10647@code{tar} to unpack the tarball. Thus, @file{bash}, @file{tar},
10648@file{xz}, and @file{mkdir} are statically-linked binaries, also part of
10649the Guix source distribution, whose sole purpose is to allow the Guile
10650tarball to be unpacked.
fb729425 10651
cf4a9129
LC
10652Once @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv} is built, we have a functioning
10653Guile that can be used to run subsequent build programs. Its first task
10654is to download tarballs containing the other pre-built binaries---this
10655is what the @code{.tar.xz.drv} derivations do. Guix modules such as
10656@code{ftp-client.scm} are used for this purpose. The
10657@code{module-import.drv} derivations import those modules in a directory
10658in the store, using the original layout. The
10659@code{module-import-compiled.drv} derivations compile those modules, and
10660write them in an output directory with the right layout. This
10661corresponds to the @code{#:modules} argument of
10662@code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
fb729425 10663
cf4a9129
LC
10664Finally, the various tarballs are unpacked by the
10665derivations @code{gcc-bootstrap-0.drv}, @code{glibc-bootstrap-0.drv},
10666etc., at which point we have a working C tool chain.
fb729425 10667
fb729425 10668
cf4a9129 10669@unnumberedsubsec Building the Build Tools
523e4896 10670
cf4a9129
LC
10671Bootstrapping is complete when we have a full tool chain that does not
10672depend on the pre-built bootstrap tools discussed above. This
10673no-dependency requirement is verified by checking whether the files of
10674the final tool chain contain references to the @file{/gnu/store}
10675directories of the bootstrap inputs. The process that leads to this
10676``final'' tool chain is described by the package definitions found in
1f6f57df 10677the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module.
df2ce343 10678
d33fa0c7
LC
10679The @command{guix graph} command allows us to ``zoom out'' compared to
10680the graph above, by looking at the level of package objects instead of
10681individual derivations---remember that a package may translate to
10682several derivations, typically one derivation to download its source,
10683one to build the Guile modules it needs, and one to actually build the
10684package from source. The command:
10685
10686@example
10687guix graph -t bag \
10688 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement)
10689 glibc-final-with-bootstrap-bash)' | dot -Tps > t.ps
10690@end example
10691
10692@noindent
10693produces the dependency graph leading to the ``final'' C
10694library@footnote{You may notice the @code{glibc-intermediate} label,
10695suggesting that it is not @emph{quite} final, but as a good
10696approximation, we will consider it final.}, depicted below.
10697
10698@image{images/bootstrap-packages,6in,,Dependency graph of the early packages}
10699
cf4a9129
LC
10700@c See <http://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/gnu-system-discuss/2012-10/msg00000.html>.
10701The first tool that gets built with the bootstrap binaries is
d33fa0c7
LC
10702GNU@tie{}Make---noted @code{make-boot0} above---which is a prerequisite
10703for all the following packages. From there Findutils and Diffutils get
10704built.
523e4896 10705
cf4a9129
LC
10706Then come the first-stage Binutils and GCC, built as pseudo cross
10707tools---i.e., with @code{--target} equal to @code{--host}. They are
10708used to build libc. Thanks to this cross-build trick, this libc is
10709guaranteed not to hold any reference to the initial tool chain.
4af2447e 10710
d33fa0c7
LC
10711From there the final Binutils and GCC (not shown above) are built.
10712GCC uses @code{ld}
cf4a9129
LC
10713from the final Binutils, and links programs against the just-built libc.
10714This tool chain is used to build the other packages used by Guix and by
10715the GNU Build System: Guile, Bash, Coreutils, etc.
4af2447e 10716
cf4a9129
LC
10717And voilà! At this point we have the complete set of build tools that
10718the GNU Build System expects. These are in the @code{%final-inputs}
dd164244
MW
10719variable of the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module, and are
10720implicitly used by any package that uses @code{gnu-build-system}
1f6f57df 10721(@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
4af2447e 10722
4af2447e 10723
cf4a9129 10724@unnumberedsubsec Building the Bootstrap Binaries
4af2447e 10725
cf4a9129
LC
10726Because the final tool chain does not depend on the bootstrap binaries,
10727those rarely need to be updated. Nevertheless, it is useful to have an
10728automated way to produce them, should an update occur, and this is what
10729the @code{(gnu packages make-bootstrap)} module provides.
4af2447e 10730
cf4a9129
LC
10731The following command builds the tarballs containing the bootstrap
10732binaries (Guile, Binutils, GCC, libc, and a tarball containing a mixture
10733of Coreutils and other basic command-line tools):
4b2615e1 10734
cf4a9129
LC
10735@example
10736guix build bootstrap-tarballs
10737@end example
10738
10739The generated tarballs are those that should be referred to in the
10740@code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module mentioned at the beginning of
10741this section.
10742
10743Still here? Then perhaps by now you've started to wonder: when do we
10744reach a fixed point? That is an interesting question! The answer is
10745unknown, but if you would like to investigate further (and have
10746significant computational and storage resources to do so), then let us
10747know.
10748
10749@node Porting
10750@section Porting to a New Platform
10751
10752As discussed above, the GNU distribution is self-contained, and
10753self-containment is achieved by relying on pre-built ``bootstrap
10754binaries'' (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). These binaries are specific to an
10755operating system kernel, CPU architecture, and application binary
10756interface (ABI). Thus, to port the distribution to a platform that is
10757not yet supported, one must build those bootstrap binaries, and update
10758the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module to use them on that platform.
10759
10760Fortunately, Guix can @emph{cross compile} those bootstrap binaries.
10761When everything goes well, and assuming the GNU tool chain supports the
10762target platform, this can be as simple as running a command like this
10763one:
10764
10765@example
10766guix build --target=armv5tel-linux-gnueabi bootstrap-tarballs
10767@end example
10768
1c0c417d
LC
10769For this to work, the @code{glibc-dynamic-linker} procedure in
10770@code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} must be augmented to return the right
10771file name for libc's dynamic linker on that platform; likewise,
10772@code{system->linux-architecture} in @code{(gnu packages linux)} must be
10773taught about the new platform.
10774
cf4a9129 10775Once these are built, the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module needs
1c0c417d
LC
10776to be updated to refer to these binaries on the target platform. That
10777is, the hashes and URLs of the bootstrap tarballs for the new platform
10778must be added alongside those of the currently supported platforms. The
10779bootstrap Guile tarball is treated specially: it is expected to be
10780available locally, and @file{gnu-system.am} has rules do download it for
10781the supported architectures; a rule for the new platform must be added
10782as well.
cf4a9129
LC
10783
10784In practice, there may be some complications. First, it may be that the
10785extended GNU triplet that specifies an ABI (like the @code{eabi} suffix
10786above) is not recognized by all the GNU tools. Typically, glibc
10787recognizes some of these, whereas GCC uses an extra @code{--with-abi}
10788configure flag (see @code{gcc.scm} for examples of how to handle this).
10789Second, some of the required packages could fail to build for that
10790platform. Lastly, the generated binaries could be broken for some
10791reason.
4af2447e 10792
9bf3c1a7 10793@c *********************************************************************
8c01b9d0 10794@include contributing.texi
c78bd12b 10795
568717fd
LC
10796@c *********************************************************************
10797@node Acknowledgments
10798@chapter Acknowledgments
10799
136787cb
LC
10800Guix is based on the @uref{http://nixos.org/nix/, Nix package manager},
10801which was designed and
4c7ac9aa
LC
10802implemented by Eelco Dolstra, with contributions from other people (see
10803the @file{nix/AUTHORS} file in Guix.) Nix pioneered functional package
568717fd
LC
10804management, and promoted unprecedented features, such as transactional
10805package upgrades and rollbacks, per-user profiles, and referentially
10806transparent build processes. Without this work, Guix would not exist.
10807
10808The Nix-based software distributions, Nixpkgs and NixOS, have also been
10809an inspiration for Guix.
10810
4c7ac9aa
LC
10811GNU@tie{}Guix itself is a collective work with contributions from a
10812number of people. See the @file{AUTHORS} file in Guix for more
10813information on these fine people. The @file{THANKS} file lists people
10814who have helped by reporting bugs, taking care of the infrastructure,
10815providing artwork and themes, making suggestions, and more---thank you!
10816
10817
568717fd
LC
10818@c *********************************************************************
10819@node GNU Free Documentation License
10820@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
10821
10822@include fdl-1.3.texi
10823
10824@c *********************************************************************
10825@node Concept Index
10826@unnumbered Concept Index
10827@printindex cp
10828
a85b83d2
LC
10829@node Programming Index
10830@unnumbered Programming Index
10831@syncodeindex tp fn
10832@syncodeindex vr fn
568717fd
LC
10833@printindex fn
10834
10835@bye
10836
10837@c Local Variables:
10838@c ispell-local-dictionary: "american";
10839@c End: